physical and cultural flows of lake como, italy: cross-current studies in limnology ... · physical...
TRANSCRIPT
Physical and cultural flows of Lake Como, Italy:
Cross-current studies in Limnology and Anthropology
Sarah Laborde
D.I. (M.Eng.) Ecole Nationale Supérieure de Géologie, France
This thesis is presented for the degree of Doctor of Philosophy
of The University of Western Australia,
with joint enrolment in:
Water Research Engineering
Centre for Water Research
Social and Cultural Studies
Discipline of Anthropology
June 2012
ii
iii
A lake is the landscape's most beautiful
and expressive feature. It is earth’s eye;
looking into which the beholder measures
the depth of his own nature
Henry David Thoreau
iv
v
Abstract
What do anthropology and limnology have in common, and in what ways might the
social, natural and engineering sciences contribute to knowledge about the environment
of which humans are an intrinsic part? With Italy’s Lake Como at its centre, this thesis
explores the multiple ways a single environment can be known within and across
disciplinary fields, and social groups. The emergence and application of environmental
knowledge across scientific and social domains is thus examined, building on recent
developments in physical limnology and contemporary theories in anthropology.
Four original journal articles constitute the bulk of the thesis. Two of these are grounded
in the fields of physical limnology and anthropology respectively, while two canvass
both fields of inquiry. The articles are linked by a dialectical process across the
disciplines, which emerged as a result of a mixed methods approach. Integrated foci
include numerical analyses and modelling of the Lake’s hydrodynamics, ethnographic
work among the Lake’s drift-net fishers, comparative analysis of scientific and local
practices of lake knowledge, and the governance implications of disconnected technical
and local understandings of the Lake. Each article makes a contribution to knowledge
within its own discipline, and also constitutes data for a trans-disciplinary emphasis via
a range of epistemological concerns related to environmental knowledge.
Conclusions include that there is ample room to expand the intellectual and practical
application of a trans-disciplinary approach to support sustainable environments and
communities. In particular, I argue that the integration of scientific and local knowledge
can be pivotal in research focused on geophysical environments, yet it is a under-used
heuristic tool. This thesis shows how examining the emergence of diverse bodies of
knowledge and their relationship to places, both in the case of scientific and local
practices, supports the engagement of integrated, trans-disciplinary emphases, practice
and knowledge about the environment.
vi
vii
Contents
ABSTRACT ......................................................................................................................................... V
CONTENTS ...................................................................................................................................... VII
LIST OF FIGURES ................................................................................................................................. XI
LIST OF TABLES .................................................................................................................................. XV
LIST OF EQUATIONS .......................................................................................................................... XV
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS ................................................................................................................... XVII
PREFACE AND CANDIDATE STATEMENT ................................................................................. XXI
CHAPTER 1 THESIS PROBLEM AND THEORETICAL CONTEXT ........................................... 1
1.1 INTRODUCTORY EMPHASIS ............................................................................................................. 1 1.2 THE THESIS PROBLEM ..................................................................................................................... 3 1.3 DEFINITIONS AND THEORIES: UNTANGLING WORDS AND PRACTICES .............................................. 6
1.3.1 On the environment and knowledge ....................................................................................... 6 1.3.2 Scientific, local, traditional, indigenous knowledges ............................................................. 8
1.4 OVERVIEW OF THE ORIGINAL PAPERS (CHAPTERS 3 TO 6) ............................................................ 10 1.4.1 Paper 1: CHAPTER 3 .......................................................................................................... 10 1.4.2 Paper 2: CHAPTER 4 .......................................................................................................... 12 1.4.3 Paper 3: CHAPTER 5 .......................................................................................................... 15 1.4.4 Paper 4: CHAPTER 6 .......................................................................................................... 17
1.5 CONCLUDING REMARKS ............................................................................................................... 19 1.6 REFERENCES ................................................................................................................................. 20
CHAPTER 2 METHODOLOGIES, LITERATURE CONTEXT, AND INTRODUCTION TO
THE LAKE ........................................................................................................................................ 23
2.1 GENERAL APPROACH .................................................................................................................... 23 2.2 TERMINOLOGY: MANGLE OF PREFIXES.......................................................................................... 24 2.3 LAKE COMO AS A WATER BODY ................................................................................................... 28
2.3.1 The Lake ............................................................................................................................... 29 2.3.2 Data collection and analysis (relevant to Chapters 3, 4 and 5) ........................................... 31 2.3.3 Hydrodynamic modelling ..................................................................................................... 32
2.4 LAKE COMO AS A WATERSCAPE ................................................................................................... 34 2.4.1 The Lake ............................................................................................................................... 34
viii
2.4.2 Questionnaire, textual analysis (Chapter 4) ......................................................................... 37 2.4.3 Being there (Chapters 5 and 6): the Lake as a fishing – and ethnographic – taskscape ...... 38
2.5 REFLEXIVITY ................................................................................................................................ 40 2.5.1 Reflexive limnology .............................................................................................................. 40 2.5.2 Elements of reflexive ethnography ....................................................................................... 41 2.5.3 Translation: several voices in one ........................................................................................ 43
2.6 REFERENCES ................................................................................................................................. 45
CHAPTER 3 INFLOW INTRUSIONS AT MULTIPLE SCALES IN A LARGE TEMPERATE
LAKE ........................................................................................................................................ 49
3.1 ABSTRACT .................................................................................................................................... 49 3.2 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................. 49 3.3 METHODS...................................................................................................................................... 52
3.3.1 Field data ............................................................................................................................. 52 3.3.2 Scaling analysis .................................................................................................................... 53 3.3.3 Numerical model .................................................................................................................. 55
3.4 RESULTS ....................................................................................................................................... 56 3.4.1 Field data ............................................................................................................................. 56
3.4.1.1 Inflow regimes and fate of small inflows ...................................................................................... 56 3.4.1.2 Fate of large alpine inflows: interplay with upwelling and unsteadiness ...................................... 58 3.4.1.3 Effect of the Earth rotation: deflection and instabilities ............................................................... 63
3.5 NUMERICAL MODELLING .............................................................................................................. 64 3.5.1 Validation ............................................................................................................................. 64 3.5.2 Fate of large inflows- intrusion, deflection, instability ........................................................ 68 3.5.3 Fate of small inflows – intrusion, deflection, vertical mixing ............................................... 69
3.6 DISCUSSION .................................................................................................................................. 70 3.6.1 Intrusions interactions; effect on local flushing ................................................................... 70 3.6.2 Applications .......................................................................................................................... 72 3.6.3 Regional context ................................................................................................................... 73
3.7 ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS .................................................................................................................. 74 3.8 REFERENCES ................................................................................................................................. 74
CHAPTER 4 A WALL OUT OF PLACE: A HYDROLOGICAL AND SOCIO-CULTURAL
ANALYSIS OF PHYSICAL CHANGES TO THE LAKESHORE OF COMO, ITALY ............. 79
4.1 ABSTRACT .................................................................................................................................... 79 4.2 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................. 79
4.2.1 Definitions and theoretical framework ................................................................................. 81 4.2.2 Aim and overview of the article ............................................................................................ 83
4.3 FLOODS IN COMO: HYDROLOGICAL CONSIDERATIONS .................................................................. 83 4.3.1 Background .......................................................................................................................... 83
ix
4.3.2 Methods ................................................................................................................................ 84 4.3.3 Results .................................................................................................................................. 85
4.3.3.1 Long-term trends .......................................................................................................................... 85 4.3.3.2 Seasonal trends and water uses ..................................................................................................... 86 4.3.3.3 Extreme events ............................................................................................................................. 87 4.3.3.4 Flood mitigation ........................................................................................................................... 88
4.3.4 The flood defence project ..................................................................................................... 91 4.4 SOCIAL MOVEMENT AGAINST THE ‘WALL’: A SOCIO-CULTURAL ANALYSIS .................................. 93
4.4.1 Methods ................................................................................................................................ 93 4.4.1.1 Questionnaire ................................................................................................................................ 93 4.4.1.2 Public data .................................................................................................................................... 95
4.4.2 Results .................................................................................................................................. 96 4.4.2.1 A social movement grounded in a sense of injustice, community and place ................................ 96 4.4.2.2 ‘The rise of a wall that unites the people’: place-related emotion and engagement .................... 100
4.4.3 Limitations of the analysis ................................................................................................. 104 4.5 DISCUSSION ................................................................................................................................ 105
4.5.1 A case for integrated and adaptive catchment management .............................................. 105 4.5.2 Engaging the public around place attachments and meanings .......................................... 107
4.6 CONCLUSION .............................................................................................................................. 108 4.6.1 Place-based integration of technical and socio-cultural knowledge ................................. 108
4.7 ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS ............................................................................................................... 109 4.8 REFERENCES ............................................................................................................................... 110
CHAPTER 5 FISHING NETS AND DATA LOGGERS: CONTRIBUTIONS OF LOCAL
KNOWLEDGE TO PHYSICAL LIMNOLOGY ........................................................................... 119
5.1 ABSTRACT .................................................................................................................................. 119 5.2 INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................... 120
5.2.1 Lake Como (Lario) ............................................................................................................. 121 5.2.2 Fishers’ practices: free-drifting nets ................................................................................. 122
5.3 MATERIAL AND METHODS .......................................................................................................... 123 5.4 RESULTS ..................................................................................................................................... 126
5.4.1 Fishers’ knowledge of the lake’s seasons and dominant currents ..................................... 126 5.4.2 Observations of net drifting paths and cross-shore flow patterns ..................................... 129 5.4.3 Modelling results ............................................................................................................... 130
5.5 DISCUSSION ................................................................................................................................ 132 5.6 ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS ............................................................................................................... 133 5.7 REFERENCES ............................................................................................................................... 134
CHAPTER 6 THE MAKING AND MEANING OF ENVIRONMENTAL KNOWLEDGE: A
FISHERMAN, A LIMNOLOGIST, AND AN ITALIAN LAKE .................................................. 137
x
6.1 ABSTRACT .................................................................................................................................. 137 6.2 INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................... 138 6.3 THE LAKE ................................................................................................................................... 140
6.3.1 A waterscape ...................................................................................................................... 140 6.3.2 A body of water ................................................................................................................... 141
6.4 CROSS-CURRENT NARRATIVES: FISHING AND LIMNOLOGY IN PRACTICE ...................................... 143 6.4.1 A note about context and methods ...................................................................................... 143 6.4.2 Fishing the Lake ................................................................................................................. 143 6.4.3 Modelling the Lake ............................................................................................................. 148
6.5 COMPARATIVE ANALYSIS ........................................................................................................... 151 6.5.1 Attention, embodiment and the flows of practice ................................................................ 151 6.5.2 Heterotopias of environmental science .............................................................................. 154
6.6 CONCLUSION ............................................................................................................................... 156 6.7 ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS: .............................................................................................................. 158 6.8 REFERENCES ............................................................................................................................... 158
CHAPTER 7 DISCUSSION .............................................................................................................. 163
7.1 A FEW STEPS BACK TO START WITH… ......................................................................................... 163 7.2 USEFUL KNOWLEDGE – THE POINT IS FOR WHOM, AND HOW? ..................................................... 165
7.2.1 The grammar and the practice: environmental science and local knowledge .................... 174 7.2.2 Anthropologists and scientists across traditions of knowledge, within their own, and ‘in
place’ ............................................................................................................................................ 177 7.3 LIMITATIONS AND FUTURE WORK ............................................................................................... 180 7.4 REFERENCES ............................................................................................................................... 182
CHAPTER 8 CONCLUSIONS, AND A STATEMENT ABOUT HOW AND WHY THIS
THESIS MIGHT HAVE BEEN DIFFERENT … .......................................................................... 185
8.1 A PROCESS-FOCUSED CONTRIBUTION TO PHYSICAL LIMNOLOGY ................................................ 185 8.2 AN IN-DEPTH ETHNOGRAPHIC INQUIRY INTO PEOPLE’S RELATIONSHIPS TO LAKE COMO ............ 187 8.3 MORE THAN THE SUM OF ITS PARTS? ........................................................................................... 188 8.4 REFERENCES ............................................................................................................................... 191
COMPLETE BIBLIOGRAPHY ........................................................................................................... 193
APPENDIX A (CHAPTER 4) ............................................................................................................... 213
APPENDIX B (CHAPTER 4) ................................................................................................................ 214
xi
List of figures
Figure 1. ‘Table of contents’ image of Paper 1. (source: the model impression on the top left is from the
CWR website)................................................................................................................................... 12
Figure 2. ‘Table of contents’ image of Paper 2. (source: the picture on the bottom left is my own, the
poster on the bottom right was to announce the first public manifestation in response to the
structure). .......................................................................................................................................... 14
Figure 3. ‘Table of contents’ image of Paper 3. In the centre is a graphic impression of a drift-net in the
water. (source: pictures are my own, taken during ethnographic fieldwork. They relate to the
practice of drift-net fishing through time). ....................................................................................... 17
Figure 4. ‘Table of contents’ image of Paper 4. (source: pictures are my own, taken during ethnographic
fieldwork). ........................................................................................................................................ 19
Figure 5: M.C. Escher. Drawing Hands, 1948. (Permission for reproduction was requested) ................... 26
Figure 6: Summary of methods used in the different thesis chapters, and their location on the research
spectrum from quantitative to qualitative research ........................................................................... 27
Figure 7. Lake Como – Left: geographical context. Right: detail of the catchment ................................... 30
Figure 8. Bathymetry of Lake Como with depth contour lines of 100 m and 20 m for the main map and
the zoomed map around T1, respectively; locations of measurement stations (Conductivity,
Temperature, Depth (CTD) transects C1, C2, and F-Probe transects F1, F2). Ai=Adda inflow,
Ao=Adda outflow, C=Cosia inflow, B=Breggia inflow, M=Mera inflow ....................................... 50
Figure 9. A) Annual stratification in Lake Como in 2007: depths of 0.25 isotherms were averaged
between T2 and T3, over a sliding window of 5 days. B) Temperature and C) salinity of the Adda
(A), Mera (M), Cosia (C), and Breggia (B) Rivers, for the year 2006. Markers indicate
measurements, dotted lines are linear interpolations. D) Daily Adda flow rate for the year 2007. .. 51
Figure 10: In-lake salinity data corresponding to autumnal transects F1, F2 (October 2006), C1 and C2
(October 2007). Dashed vertical lines indicate the profiles locations; values are linearly interpolated
between profiles. ............................................................................................................................... 57
Figure : 11: Average seasonal water column temperature and inflows depths of intrusion. Depths of
isotherms 0.1ºC apart were averaged to obtain seasonal profiles at T1 (black line) and T2 (grey
line); W (winter), ES (early spring), and LS (late spring) are data from 2007 and S (summer), EA
(early autumn), and LA (late autumn) from 2008 because of gaps in data. T2 profiles (N) were used
to compute the regimes of the Adda and Mera Rivers, and T1 profiles (SW) were used for the Cosia
xii
and Breggia Rivers. Dashed lines: Adda (black) and Mera (grey); dotted lines: Cosia (black) and
Bregga (grey). ................................................................................................................................... 58
Figure 12. Thermal structure of the water column at stations T2 (N), T1 (SW), and T3 (SE) over the
summer 2008. Data points are separated by 4.5 hours. Arrows on top panel indicate major
upwelling events referred to in the text. ............................................................................................ 59
Figure 13. Differences between temperatures (ºC) measured at two T-chain locations after filtering by the
fundamental seiche period Ti for each season. A) Differences between southwestern (T1) and
northern (T2) stations. B) Differences between southeastern (T3) and northern (T2) stations. White
bands are gaps in data. Black lines indicate seasonal split: W, ES, LS 2007 and S, EA, LA 2008.
(a), (b) and (c) are referred to in the text. .......................................................................................... 60
Figure 14. All wind speeds and directions for the year 2007, at the three stations. Shading represent the
wind speed in m s-1, and the length of the 10 degrees bins represents the probability of occurrence
of the respective direction. ................................................................................................................ 61
Figure 15. A) Wind speed at T2 (UT2: black line) filtered over Ti/4 (Stevens and Lawrence 1997) and
stage of the Adda River near the mouth (H*, detrended: grey line). B) Log plot of the Wedderburn
number (W: black solid line) computed with average characteristics of the water column (g’=0.016
and h=10) and UT2; and temperature anomaly between T1 and T2 at 10 m after filtering by Ti (ΔT:
black dotted line). Triangles mark events referred to in the text. ...................................................... 62
Figure 16: A) satellite image of the northern arm of Lake Como; summer 2001 (reproduced with
permission - Copyright 2009 TerraMetrics). B) Model reproduction of the phenomena: velocity
vectors at 10 m depth. ‘Ar’ and ’Mr’, respectively indicate the Adda and Mera Rivers. .................. 64
Figure 17. A) water column temperature as measured by T2 sub sampled every hour; B) as simulated by
ELCOM, plotted every hour. Isotherm spacing is 1oC. Black isotherm is 13oC and represents the
thermocline. C) Time series of 13oC isotherm depth as measured in the field (black) and simulated
by ELCOM (grey). ............................................................................................................................ 66
Figure 18: Simulated salinity field corresponding to transects F1, F2, C1, and C2. Dashed lines indicate
the profiles locations; values are linearly interpolated between profiles. Corresponding field profiles
are in Fig. 10. .................................................................................................................................... 67
Figure 19: Left panel: location of transects A and B on the map of Lake Como. (A) north-south
component of the velocity for transect A (positive towards south), base of the surface layer (thin
dashed white line) and thermocline (thick dashed white line). (B) Same as A for transect B. (C)
Contours of the tracer from the Cosia River (grey) and Adda River (black) for transect A. (D) Same
as (C) for transect B. ......................................................................................................................... 68
xiii
Figure 20. Longitudinal transects along the Cosia intrusion, from Como up to 6 km into the southwestern
arm and as simulated by the model. Isotherm 15 (dashed white line) represents the base of surface
layer. isotherm 13 (dashed white line) represents the thermocline. Shadings are Cosia and Breggia
tracer concentration in log scale (log10 [TR]). Black contours are Adda tracer concentrations in log
scale.A) Downwelling and B) upwelling are apart in time of Ti/2. Tracers were initialised at 1 in
both rivers. ........................................................................................................................................ 70
Figure 21. A) Wind speed (grey line) and direction (black dots) at T1. B) Cumulative mass of Adda tracer
(TRA, grey) and Cosia tracer (TRC, black) across the transect B (see location on map Fig. 19). C)
Same as B) across transect A (see location on map Fig. 19). B) and C) are numerical results.
Tracers were initialised at 1 in both rivers. Plain lines represent the base case; dotted lines represent
the numerical scenario (no northern inflows). .................................................................................. 72
Figure 22: Right: map of Lake Como and its catchment, and bottom: schematic drawing of the catchment
system. Left: zoom - the city of Como, and top frame: photographs representing the ‘wall’ as seen
from the footpath through a window in a wooden fence (taken by first author in Oct 2009) ........... 80
Figure 23: Maximum (red dots), mean (black dots) and minimum (blue dots) annual lake levels since
1845 (original data: Consorzio dell’Adda); and elevation of Piazza Cavour (grey dots, Comerci et
al. 2007). Vertical red lines indicate the positive difference between maximum lake level and
elevation of Piazza Cavour (e.g. flooding). The black line on the right represents the regulation
range. ................................................................................................................................................ 86
Figure 24: Average number of days per month when lake levels were higher than 198.51 m ASL
(corresponding to the lowest point of Piazza Cavour: Comerci et al. 2007) and 199.22 m ASL
(corresponding to significant floods with more than 1.5 hectares of the city flooded: Gastine 2006,
unpublished thesis). Data are averaged over the period [1965 – 2007]. ........................................... 87
Figure 25: A - Maximum daily rainfall observed in Bormio [1951-2005] (upper Adda catchment, blue
line) and Olginate [1961-2007] (Southeast of the lake, cyan line) and fitted linear trends (data:
Consorzio dell’ Adda). B – Highest and lowest total lake inflow calculated for the years 1946 to
2007 and fitted linear trends (data: Consorzio dell ‘Adda; atmospheric fluxes are included). ......... 88
Figure 26: Daily data of outflow discharge (m3s-1) plotted against lake level (m ASL) from 1946 to 1990
(light gray) and from 1991 to 2007 (dark gray, covers some light gray data points); dashed black
line: rating curve for Lake Como in natural conditions (before construction of the dam in 1946);
plain black line: rating curve for Lake Como in regulated conditions, all dam gates open (free
regime); dotted red lines: regulation range; plain red line: lowest elevation of Piazza Cavour
measured in 1997 (Comerci et al. 2007). Rating curves were elaborated by the Hydrographic Office
of the Po River and reported by Moisello and Vullo (2011)............................................................. 89
xiv
Figure 27: A – Lake levels corresponding to different catchment management scenarios for the flood of
November 2002. B – Water volume reserved in the upstream reservoirs in the base case and the
management scenario. ....................................................................................................................... 91
Figure 28: Theme frequency plot for online discussion platform. Horizontal axis is the item number;
items were plotted in chronological order (intervals within grey lines represent one day), vertical
axis is the count frequency for each theme (moving average over 30 items centred on item i). Lines
are best-fit linear trends for different themes. Vertical grey line represents one day. ..................... 103
Figure 29: Thermal structure of Lake Como and displacement of fishing nets due to internal motions (a)
1-day moving average of water column temperature (shading) in Lake Como averaged across
thermistor chains T1 (SW), T2 (N) and T3 (SE) throughout the year 2007; depth of isotherms 12
and 16 (blue lines) representing the preferred habitat of whitefish caught with oltane (b) schematic
drawing (section view) of the displacements of two types of drift nets (pendenti for the capture of
shad - red nets - and oltane for whitefish - blue nets), due to a wind-driven internal seiche (the
dashed line represents the density interface – black at the lower time bound and grey at the upper
time bound); top and bottom panels are separated in time by half the wave period. (c) Schematic
drawing (map view) of the displacements of nets (oltane) due to gyres and return flows. ............. 123
Figure 30: Comparison of qualitative map and model results of nightly patterns of metalimnetic motions.
(a) Qualitative map of water currents inferred by the displacements of oltane nets, overnight, during
the stratified period and in ‘common’ wind conditions (daily alternation of Tivano and Breva):
composite of individual maps obtained from interviews and participatory mapping with
professional fishermen. (b) Central map: records of wind speed and direction at stations T2 (N), T3
(SE) and T1 (SW) for July 12-17 2007; green and red shadings pertain to the regular winds called
Tivano (northerly) and Breva (southerly). Frames: model results of velocities in the metalimnion for
July 12 – 17 2007, output every 0.5 m (depth) and 15 min (time), then averaged overnight (7pm –
4am) and depth (12m - 21m). Return flows are highlighted in black. Blue lines are nightly (7pm –
4am) paths of constant-depth numerical sail drifters (one path per night between July 12 -17) set in
the lower metalimnion (12m - 21m). Each green cross is the start of a path, each red circle its end.
Frame locations are in (a). ............................................................................................................... 132
Figure 31: Map of Lake Como. Left: regional context (northern Italy and the Alps); right: outline of the
Lake, the name of the localities correspond to the place where I interviewed one or more local
fishers (apart from Como) ............................................................................................................... 142
Figure 32: 1. Schematic of nets (pendenti: A and oltane: B) in different currents; 2. Drawing from
notebook (27 Oct 2010) of a view across the nets (approximate east–west cut) that explains the
strategy of removing one float to obtain net rotation; 3. Alessandro setting the nets (picture taken on
27 Oct 2010); 4. Schematic of the net rotation crafted using the differential currents. ................... 147
xv
Figure 33. Example of data plot of temperature structure at one location in the Lake, through depth and
time; 2. the Lake’s bathymetry; 3. Extract of model log. ............................................................... 150
List of tables
Table 1. Fundamental seiche period for each season computed with the two-layer case formula and
evaluated using power spectra of isotherm displacements. Data correspond to 2007 measurements
for W, ES, and LS, and 2008 for S, EA, and LA. ............................................................................. 60
Table 2: Velocity scales for the northern plume in summer 2008 as estimated using Eqs. 2, 3 and as
inferred from field data. .................................................................................................................... 63
Table 3: Root mean square error, I1 and I2 norms of the thermal structure of the water column, as
measured and simulated. The analysis covers the whole simulation period from 30 September to 16
October 2007 included. ..................................................................................................................... 67
Table 4: PCA loadings for questionnaire items after rotation (Varimax with Kaiser normalization);
questionnaire statements were translated from Italian ...................................................................... 97
Table 5: Differences in vA, vS and vP scores for different protest groups ................................................ 98
Table 6: Differences in vA, vS and vP scores for different groups of lakeshore users ............................ 101
Table 7: Set of model performance statistics proposed by Willmott (1982) – Mean absolute error (MAE),
Root mean square error (RMSE) and normalised index of model performance (d2) for model output
and data at T1 (15 depths), T2 (13 depths) and T3 (8 depths) ........................................................ 125
Table 8: Hydrodynamic processes (bold) and corresponding fishers’ heuristics or practices .................. 128
Table 9: Possible research outcomes for each of the papers constitutive of the thesis, from the
perspectives of a) an environmental scientist/engineer, b) an environmental manager, c) a local
knowledge holder, d) an environmental anthropologist. ................................................................. 170
List of equations
Eq. 1
W =g'h2
u*2L .....................................................................................................................................
54
Eq. 2 U ~ NH he ..................................................................................................................................... 54
xvi
Eq. 3
U ~ Qig'd
1/ 3
................................................................................................................................ 54
Eq. 4
R0 = Ufd
.................................................................................................................................... 55
Eq. 5
I1 =Fn − Snn=1
Nmax∑Snn=1
Nmax∑ .................................................................................................................... 56
Eq. 6
I2 =(Fn − Sn )2
n=1
Nmax∑Sn( )2
n=1
Nmax∑ ............................................................................................................ 56
Eq. 7
RMSE =(Fn − Sn )2
n=1
Nmax∑Nmax ......................................................................................................
56
Eq. 8
TD
TI
= f ((WP −WE )2) .............................................................................................................
174
xvii
Acknowledgments
A work is never completed except by some accident such
as weariness, satisfaction, the need to deliver, or death:
for, in relation to who or what is making it, it can only be
one stage in a series of inner transformations.
Paul Valery
Inner transformations emerge from encounters and events that accumulate, combine and
mature at unpredictable times. I cannot therefore recall all that has influenced the
writing of this work, and it is impossible to acknowledge all the people who have
contributed to it. Some, however, have played defining roles in the learning process
from which this thesis came forth: this section is to thank them for their variety of
influences on my thinking, doing and, thus, being over the last four years.
At school, I was never really able to express preference between scientific and
humanistic topics, for I was enthusiastic about them all. Now, 10 years out of school, I
still cannot decide, but fortunately I am no longer being asked to. I am most grateful to
all the persons who have allowed this PhD to develop in an equal engagement with the
fields of environmental engineering and anthropology, and to those who have
supported, and also challenged, these cross-current studies.
My first thanks go to my supervisors Jörg Imberger and Sandy Toussaint, for their
belief that I could make contributions within and beyond their disciplines of expertise.
My individual thanks to each of them and others follow, along a rough chronological
thread. Acknowledgements specific to each paper, including related to funding, are
respectively included in Chapters 3 to 6 – after completion of the papers I benefited
from a SIRF and a Completion scholarship from The University of Western Australia
(UWA) to finalise this thesis.
I first want to thank Jörg Imberger for seeing a potential PhD student in me after a
chance encounter at World Water Week in August 2007 in Stockholm, and for inspiring
xviii
me to apply for a scholarship to study at UWA. I also thank him for introducing me to
the research and people at the Centre for Water Research (CWR), where I started my
PhD later that year under his supervision and that of Jason Antenucci (CWR) and Sandy
Toussaint (Anthropology), whose influence on me and my work I address below. I
acknowledge Jörg for his often challenging, always thought-provoking supervision,
through which I learnt much, including about myself.
I acknowledge all CWR students and staff members for their help through the
sometimes difficult, often fun and always interesting times I had researching, learning
and writing about lake hydrodynamics. I would like to extend particular thanks to the
people who are behind much of the administrative and technical work that supported my
research there, especially Greg Attwater, Carol Lam, Casper Boon and Chris Dallimore
for their prodigious work with data and models. I also acknowledge Diego Copetti,
Nicolas Guyennon, Margherita Canepa and Sabrina Zaffaroni for their help from Italy,
particularly with data. I am very grateful to Jason Antenucci for his availability and
acute advice, as he co-supervised my work up until early 2010. I also thank my CWR
officemate Daniel Machado, and fellow students Sebastian Morillo, Ryan Alexander,
Kenji Shimizu and, especially, Patricia Okely for their friendly assistance at various
stages of my studies, which took many different and always helpful forms.
As months went by I became more and more interested in combining the science of
water bodies developed at CWR with analyses of their meanings as places where life
unfolds, a topic that is addressed by (among others) the field of environmental
anthropology to which I was introduced by my supervisor Sandy Toussaint. I was
excited by the possibility to work across these different traditions of knowledge and,
with the support of UWA, I jointly enrolled in Anthropology early in 2010. I am
grateful to the Graduate Research School of UWA for facilitating this process, and I
want to thank Sandy for seeing in me the potential to contribute relevant
anthropological inquiries and analyses when all the credentials I had were keen
enthusiasm and intellectual curiosity. I am grateful for her patient guidance as I learnt to
navigate this new field, and for her unwavering support through many periods of doubt.
I also extend my thanks to the School of Social and Cultural Studies and the Discipline
of Anthropology, especially Nick Harney, for trusting her and welcoming me as a
student.
xix
My experience with anthropology would have remained theoretical without data and
thus, without the people who shared their words, work and stories with me. I first thank
all Como residents who responded to my questions about their Lake, directly and
through the questionnaire that La Provincia di Como helpfully circulated. Second, I
acknowledge all the people who have engaged with me while I was conducting
ethnographic fieldwork by and on the Lake, including those who do not appear in this
dissertation, for they nonetheless contributed to defining my work. Finally, I am
particularly grateful to Massimo Pirovano, and to the Lake’s fishers who shared some of
their experiences of the Lake and allowed me to write about them: thank you, especially
the Sala family, for taking me on board, for your time, your trust and your stories. I
extend loving thanks to Laura, Lorenzo and Francesca for providing the emotional and
culinary support of a family, away from my French and Australian homes.
Beyond the context of my studies but relevantly to them, I thank Keith Frost (and
human & equine associates) for giving me the best way to put the bumpy ride of a PhD
into perspective. To my friends overseas, especially the Musketeers, thank you for
continuing to support and inspire me despite years without a word (and thank you
Chiara for being worse than me at that). To my friends in Perth, especially Robi, thank
you for putting up with my frustrations and sharing the rest - for your comforting
presence, on and off campus. Finally, I cannot thank enough my family, for their
unconditional trust in me and my choices, including those that take me far away from
them; and Sean for his overwhelming resilience and support - ‘on my team’ every day
of these four years.
xx
xxi
Preface and candidate statement
This thesis has been completed during the course of studies and research towards the
degree of Doctor of Philosophy at The University of Western Australia (UWA), with a
joint-enrolment between the Centre for Water Research (CWR) and the Discipline of
Anthropology. This work and has not previously been accepted for a degree at this or
another institution.
Four papers (Chapters 3-6), written for journal publication, formed the result of this
research across several academic fields. Each chapter links into the main argument of
the thesis, but may also be read as a standalone manuscript that includes an abstract,
literature review, methods, results, discussion, conclusions, and references. Two of the
papers are strongly polarised in what is usually thought of as opposite edges of the
academic research spectrum: the physical geosciences (Chapter 3) and the humanities
(Chapter 6). The other two papers attempt to bridge these fields and address a broader
audience (Chapters 4 and 5).
Chapter 1 is introductory and presents the thesis problem, the motivation for the study
and a literature review that locates the thesis within its academic context. This chapter
also provides a thesis outline and a summary of each paper, together with an overview
of its contributions within the field for which it was written, as well as broader thesis
content. Each summary aims to link the individual papers with each other, and guide the
reader through the disciplinary assumptions in each paper.
Chapter 2 presents an explanation of methods, linking the methodologies used in each
paper to emphasise the chronological evolution of how the research was undertaken.
Chapter 7 presents my interpretation of the integrated results from Chapters 3 to 6, and a
reflection about the process and aims of an integrated approach to environmental
research. Chapter 8 discloses thesis conclusions and implications.
This thesis is entirely based on my own original research, although I was guided by my
supervisors at UWA: Jörg Imberger (Chapters 3 and 4) from CWR, and Sandy
Toussaint (Chapters 4, 5 and 6) from the Discipline of Anthropology and the Centre of
Excellence for Natural Resource Management. Chapter 3 consists of a paper that is also
xxii
co-authored by Jason Antenucci who was, at the time, my co-supervisor at CWR; and
by Diego Copetti from the Istituto di Ricerche sulle Acque (IRSA) in Brugherio (Italy),
who contributed data and ideas to the study. I conducted the analyses and wrote the
paper, with the aforementioned co-authors and Jörg Imberger providing edits. Each
paper has also benefited from the valuable comments provided by anonymous
reviewers. Three of the papers are published (Laborde et al. 2010 [Chapter 3], Laborde
et al. 2012 [Chapter 4]) and Laborde et al. 2012 [Chapter 5]) the last one is being
revised for resubmission to the journal where it was first submitted1 (Chapter 6).
Permission has been granted by all co-authors to include the research in this thesis.
Sarah Laborde Prof. Sandy Toussaint Prof. Jörg Imberger
1 Chapters 3, 4 and 5 might bear minor differences with the corresponding journal articles that were published respectively in Limnology and Oceanography, Ecology and Society and Proceedings of the National Academy of Sciences of the USA– this is because the pre-publication editorial changes to the manuscripts proofs were not integrated to the thesis chapters.
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
1
Chapter 1 Thesis problem and theoretical context
1.1 Introductory emphasis
This chapter presents the thesis problem and it provides a plan of the thesis with a
summary of the four papers that constitute its core. To start with, consider the following
extract from a text written by Giovanni Bertacchi, who was a poet and also a fisherman,
about Lake Como, or Lario, as my field site is known locally:
And this is how I fed in my heart the passion for the Lake, exercised from day to day and from use to use. This arm of the Lario little by little was mine, and I was his, seduced by the slow charms of a current so gentle. So, when the heavy rain fell onto my home, I found myself with the senses ready and the heart prepared, poet of my lake and fisherman. (...) In this long custom of humble and calm things I solitary measured life on immutable paths. I rowed for years, and for years I fished, re-travelling hour by hour the distances covered, jointly with the water and the aerial string of my memories and of the tirlindana2. (…) I saw these things without looking at them. These slow scenes entered in my senses unnoticed, as I was going about rowing and fishing, and they became love. (Giovanni Bertacchi ‘Quel ramo del Lago di Como’, cited in Brembilla and Valpolini 1999: 38 - my translation)
2 The tirlindana is a piece of fishing equipment composed of a long string on which several hooks are attached
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
2
Bertacchi’s poem, which was too long to include here in its entirety, expresses his way
of relating to, and knowing, Lake Como: through perceptions, thoughts and emotions
generated by his frequent use of the Lake when rowing and fishing there. Such
experiential knowledge crystallises a way of understanding and knowing the Lake that
is shared by many of the Lake Como fishers among whom I conducted research. Such
practical knowingness and familiarity may be, in many ways, associated with what has
been described as a love of place, or to the notion of ‘topophilia’, as highlighted by
geographer Yi-Fu Tuan (1974). It is situated, embodied, and can generally be contrasted
with another form of lake knowledge evident in the quote below, which was extracted
from my own work published in Limnology and Oceanography (Chapter 3):
Lake Como is large (50 km long), deep (425 m), narrow, and elongated, extending in the north–south direction (Fig. 1). A seasonal thermocline develops in the lake from midspring (Fig. 2A) with the increasing solar radiation and subsequent aggregation of diurnal thermoclines. The seasonal thermocline then deepens to reach 40 m in late autumn as the surface cooling and wind speeds progressively increase (Laborde et al. 2010: 1).
This description expresses a different way of understanding Lake Como. The text is
necessarily scientific and based on an accumulation of impersonal claims about the
Lake’s physical characteristics. The information is quantified and in the paper it is
associated with a map showing the Lake’s outline, its depth contours, orientation and
latitude. The technical words and the type of detail presented ensure that the information
is limited to a readership of experts in a particular field.
Both statements assert knowledge about the same lake. Their juxtaposition raises an
emphasis that is the premise of this thesis, which is that knowledge of an environment
can be expressed in a variety of ways. Starting from this point, this thesis explores the
space that lies at the intersection between ways of knowing a lake environment as a
scientist, and as an anthropologist who works as an interlocutor with local people.
Because the thesis spans across disciplines that are usually considered to be in
opposition, and because is it constituted of four original papers, content might at times
appear fragmented. In this introduction, I therefore aim to bring the reader’s attention to
the unifying analytical themes. Each study emerged from my engagement with the same
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
3
environmental system (Lake Como) and the four papers address the same overarching
notion of environmental knowledge and the question of its emergence in different
contexts, albeit from the perspective of various disciplines. Not only were these
inquiries relevant to both environmental and social sciences, but also to the application
of diverse understandings of environmental systems more broadly, such as in
environmental management.
1.2 The thesis problem
Few themes are as prominent in contemporary political, scientific and every day socio-
cultural discourses as the many ways of knowing, using, transforming or conserving
‘natural’ environments. At a local level, people who live in natural environments
throughout the world have developed ways to find resources (such as food, water,
shelter) and to avoid hazards (such as floods or fires), which are specific to the
particular environment they live in (Morán 2008). Today however, most people live in
concentrated urban settings3, physically remote from the land and water-scapes that
produce the resources they use. In this context the responsibility of environmental
management is often delegated to experts. In the environmental field experts are
generally considered to be environmental scientists who work at describing and
predicting environmental systems, or environmental engineers who design and
implement modifications to these, often in response to objectives defined by
environmental managers (yet another kind of environmental expert) who work at the
intersection of political, governmental and scientific domains.
Environmental systems thus provide a nexus of complex interactions, and sometimes
contests, over development, resources and livelihood, as different social groups hold
distinct understandings, meanings, interests, and uses for the land and water they rely on
for resources. Such friction, documented by Toussaint (2008) for water places in
Australia exists practically everywhere in the world and across scales (Tsing 2005)
varying from the local (e.g. conflicts over the use of a stream’s water) to the global (e.g.
3 In 2010, the proportion of urban dwellers reached more than 50% of people on Earth (UN-Habitat 2010)
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
4
regulations on carbon emissions), and its occurrence between technical experts and local
inhabitants of environments has been emphasised (Orlove 1991; Devine Wright and
Howes 2010).
To these issues, environmental science and engineering contribute knowledge of
environmental systems dynamics, and ultimately ways to alter them to optimise
resource use and/or hazard prevention for the benefit of various social groups. The
aspects that are sought to be optimised are often called ecosystem services or functions
in this context (e.g. Bennett et al. 2009). The marks of such work on society at large are
seen through the shaping of environmental decision-making and policy. This approach
provides a way, through standards, scaling and modelling, to compare processes for
systems of the same class (such as flow rate patterns for a river, storage volumes for a
reservoir etc.) and thus to learn from what has happened in other systems and at other
times. It also reveals specific aspects and patterns across time and space scales that may
not be observed directly at the scale of a human life, provided there are relevant data to
analyse (such as 100 year flood records or nutrient fluxes in the hypolimnion of a deep
lake), and it leads to increasingly sophisticated, partly mobile knowledge of the
relationships and feedback mechanisms between components of environmental systems.
For these reasons, studies of environmental science and engineering appear instrumental
for the constant development of sustainable livelihoods.
However, the contribution of environmental science and engineering to these issues is
limited by a focus on the biophysical dimensions of environments while often assuming
that the objectives to target are relatively straightforward. In other words, taking for
granted the idea that what should be achieved is material progress and growth, for it is
generally associated with social progress (or at least that material wellbeing is what
science and engineering are about, and that its connection with social progress should be
addressed by others, such as politicians). However, as noted previously, environmental
systems are often relevant to the livelihood of social groups with various interests,
knowledges and values. The functions or services that such systems provide then take
various forms depending on the perspective they are judged from, and conflicts may
result. More than biogeophysical insight is thus needed to achieve environmentally and
socially sustainable livelihoods: research focusing on the socio-cultural and historical
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
5
dimensions of what constitutes ‘environments’, in other words people, their
relationships with each other and the world around them, is also relevant.
To reflect on these issues, a range of academic disciplines and practices has developed a
focus on environmental knowledge beyond its technical dimension. It has become, for
instance, an important field of inquiry in the humanities and social sciences (for
example through environmental anthropology, philosophy, history, art and ecocriticism)
and the behavioural and political sciences (environmental psychology, sociology,
policy, economics etc.). As a result, and mirroring the diversity of environmental
perceptions and values in socio-cultural life, the environment has become central to
various academic lines of thought, definitions, understandings and implications, a point
I return to in the data and methods section. Among these, environmental anthropology
has addressed a range of relevant topics since the early 20th century, inquiring into
human-environment interactions through a variety of socio-cultural contexts from
indigenous environmental knowledge to western scientific standpoints. A major focus
of the field has been the power relations embedded in such different traditions of
environmental knowledge and their social, cultural and political implications (e.g.
Escobar 1999; Williams 2000; Strang 2009).
Overall, while a great deal of academic research effort has been devoted to producing
new environmental knowledge (e.g. in natural science, environmental engineering) to
interpreting the knowledge of various social groups (for instance through ethnoscience)
and to analyse complex situations where environmental knowledge is interwoven with
power struggles (environmental anthropology and sociology), less attention has been
paid to investigating the nature of environmental knowledge in multiple forms across
disciplines.
This thesis explores this issue via the study site of Lake Como, through an argument
intertwined around the following questions:
• What kind of environmental knowledge emerges from techno-scientific analyses
of an environmental system, and how does it differ from the experiential knowledge
of its local inhabitants?
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
6
• On which epistemological grounds can these bodies of knowledge be treated as
complementary, or even be integrated (and what is the difference)?
• How is the concept of ‘place’ relevant to multilayered exploration of environmental knowledge production? And
• How can an emphasis on concepts of place and theories about practice support the integration of diverse bodies of knowledge about the environment?
I describe the processes and outcomes of an inter-disciplinary dialogue between
anthropology and environmental science and engineering around these questions, an
interaction between and among fields that could have taken place in a pluri-disciplinary
team open to a mixed methods emphasis and a reflexive approach. Concrete research
projects in limnology and anthropology, all focused on Lake Como, are presented,
analysed and eventually integrated, a point I return to in the Methods section below.
1.3 Definitions and theories: untangling words and practices
1.3.1 On the environment and knowledge
Certain notions used throughout the thesis require clarification. It is the case first of the
term ‘environment’, which may be interpreted in various ways. A first sense of the term
is relative to one particular organism and it describes its direct surrounding, what affects
its individual existence. This emphasis continues to be used but it has been superseded,
especially in political discourses, by a more general sense referring to ‘the natural world
or physical surroundings in general, either as a whole or within a particular geographical
area, especially as affected by human activity’ (Oxford English Dictionary [OED]
online 2011). In other words, ‘nature’ and its non-human components - land, water, air,
plants and animals – become, as parts of environments or environmental systems,
objects of study and, in relation to my focus, interventions for environmental scientists
and engineers.
In practice, these two definitions coalesce in many instances. Messages that embody
scientific facts and concerns for the ‘global environment’ have permeated various socio-
cultural contexts, individual lives and identities. Similarly, all discourses surrounding a
‘global environment’ are informed by their subjectivity, a matter dealt with extensively
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
7
in anthropology (Escobar 1998; Harper 2001). One’s definition of a lake environment,
for instance, will flow from their previous phenomenological and/or imagined
experiences of lakes, depending on the context in which such knowledge has emerged.
Mindful of these ambiguities, I return to the multiple senses of the term and their
implications in more depth in Chapter 6. To start with, however, and consistent with the
chronological evolution of this thesis, I apply the definition that is in agreement with a
basic and tacit assumption of environmental science and engineering, that a natural
environment is a biogeophysical system that does not originate from (but may have
been transformed by to a certain extent) human activity, and is defined in relation to the
socio-cultural groups for whom it is relevant. I use the notion of ‘environmental system’
to emphasise the relationships and connectedness of various elements of an environment
(such as the physics, ecology and fish productivity of a lake).
Other nuances that ought to be clarified are between the academic fields of
environmental science and engineering, which largely overlap. I am an environmental
engineer by qualification and experience and my engagement in relation to the scientific
study of Lake Como was with the Centre for Water Research (CWR), which conducts
research in ‘natural systems engineering’ (CWR Website > About CWR). However, the
outcomes of this part of my PhD study, especially as reported in Chapter 3, pertained
more to environmental science. The distinction, as I understand and apply it in this
thesis, is that environmental science is more focused on increasing understanding of
processes in natural systems, while environmental engineering is more committed to
enhancing these environments for societal benefits, thus conducting research that has
relatively direct and concrete applications. There is nevertheless no clear-cut boundary
between science and engineering in this context, and some aspects of my research were
still clearly inscribed in an engineering approach. This is true for instance of the use of
numerical modelling, especially of numerical approximations to solve systems of
equations with no exact solutions (such as the Navier-Stokes equations, system of
nonlinear partial differential equations solved by ELCOM). When the perspective that
emerged from this hybrid science-engineering engagement is compared to that which
came forth through my engagement with the social sciences, I simply refer to
‘environmental science and engineering’ as a combination of fields studying
environmental systems with the aim to understand, predict and/or modify them.
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
8
Finally, I consider in this thesis that knowledge, following Barth, is ‘what a person
employs to interpret and act on the world’ (2002:1) and that it comes in various kinds
(Turnbull 2003). This might be illustrated by the example of the influence of the earth’s
gravity on motion, which, on the one hand humans and animals learn about through
experience (by learning to move, jump, fall, carry things etc.), and on the other may be
described in a quantified and formalised way in classical mechanics through for instance
Newton’s law of gravitation: both are forms of knowledge of the same phenomenon.
I am thus not concerned here about notions of absolute truth wth regards to knowledge,
but rather about accuracy, knowledge that is consistent with empirical observations and
that ‘works’ in the context of its usage. In the natural sciences such an epistemological
position is shared by researchers who function in a positivist framework but reject
scientific realism and in anthropology, with scholars like Escobar (1999) who navigate
somewhere between the epistemological extremes of realism and relativism.
Environmental knowledge thus encompasses here, among other ways of knowing, the
understandings produced by environmental science and engineering as well as
experiential, practical ways of knowing environments and anthropological knowledge
derived from these. Also, and like Russell (1948), Barth (2002) includes in the
definition of knowledge the notion of inference that is what we learn from others
outside of our own direct experience – this is important for scientific knowledge, which
grows from the formulations and descriptions that the previous generations made of the
world, and for local knowledge, which also relies on learning from previous generations
through socialisation and education, but also tools and artefacts.
1.3.2 Scientific, local, traditional, indigenous knowledges
A mix of terms has been used to distinguish the various traditions of knowledge, and a
scholastic debate has been underway for several decades (Kuper 2003; Raymond et al.
2010). Here I clarify my usage of some of this terminology, starting with scientific
knowledge. This might seem counterintuitive and somewhat symptomatic of the way
local knowledge is being addressed now in academic discourse (in relation and
secondary to scientific knowledge), but it is simply to reflect my own chronological
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
9
experience with ‘knowing the Lake’ and the evolution in my thinking throughout the
doctoral research process.
The question of what defines scientific knowledge is contentious (Nader 1996);
however in the context of this thesis the term ‘science’ designates the commonality in
notions of science that are embedded in the natural science and engineering teachings of
most universities around the World4: science is a particular tradition of knowledge that
emphasise the systematic study of the natural world through the development of
hypotheses and tests, with the aim to develop general principles about the world. The
term ‘knowledge’ is used here more generally, as defined in the previous section. In this
context, it is widely agreed that science is a form of knowledge that is recorded through
time and based on systematic measurement and experiment to formulate and test
hypotheses (OED 2011). It is largely founded on the existence and promotion of
standards (procedures, units, forms of communication), which makes it highly mobile
(O'Connell 1993). Local knowledge in turn is generally defined in contrast to scientific
knowledge, to highlight a way of knowing a local environment that has not been
formalised or generalised. It is embedded in the practices of local inhabitants of this
environment, their stories and artefacts. Local and scientific knowledge often operate on
different scales, both temporal and spatial, a point that has been emphasised as a major
angle of interest for their integration (Robertson and McGee 2003; Gagnon and
Berteaux 2009).
Many scholars who have studied science in the making would argue here that scientific
knowledge is also produced in local, specific places (Latour and Woolgar 1986;
Turnbull 2003) through specific practices that include a tacit component (Polanyi 1969).
The same can be argued for traditional knowledge, often regarded as being embedded in
socio-cultural contexts, spanning across many generations and in constant evolution.
This definition also has parallels with both scientific and local knowledge (Agrawal
1995; Pickering 1992; Latour 2005). Mindful of possible ambiguities in my use of this
4 The term ‘western science’ often used by anthropologists to characterise what I call here ‘academic science’, seemed particularly inappropriate in my case as I dealt with comparisons between different forms of knowledge in Italy. The concept of ‘western science’ is nebulous: it most often designates the type of science that evolved from the so-called ’scientific revolution’ in Western Europe during the Renaissance, of which Italy was an important part.
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
10
terminology, I nevertheless use the term ‘local knowledge’ as distinct from academic
science because I wish to emphasize the spatial dimension of multiple ways of knowing
environmental systems. Such usage does not indicate that I consider the fishers’
knowledge as immobile and isolated from scientific knowledge. Likewise, this
terminological distinction is not a claim that scientific knowledge is disembedded from
the arrays of local contexts, practices and social networks within which it is produced.
The complexities of these epistemological-spatial questions are further explored in
Chapter 6.
The concept of ‘place’ is prominent throughout most thesis chapters, introduced from
several disciplinary angles via notions of spatiality, practice and knowledge-production
that are theorized and reflected upon in Chapters 6 and 7. In many ways, ‘place’ acts as
an additional, unifying thread, crystallising a reflection on the practices of knowledge
production that, I argue, presents an opportunity to integrate local and scientific
knowledge.
An introduction to each of the four papers that constitute the core of this thesis follows.
It provides the specifics of each paper, the context of its production, its thesis
contribution. A ‘table of contents’ illustration aimed at giving the reader a quick visual
impression of the content of each paper, without providing specific results (hence the
scales and legends do not appear on these illustrations, while they appear in the figures
of the paper itself) has also been included.
1.4 Overview of the original papers (Chapters 3 to 6)
1.4.1 Paper 1: CHAPTER 3
• Authors: Sarah Laborde, Jason Antenucci, Diego Copetti and Jörg Imberger
• Title: Inflow intrusions at multiple scales in a large temperate lake
• Journal: Limnology and Oceanography
• Status: Published in 2010, 55(3): 1301–1312
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
11
• Personal contribution: Conducted analyses and modelling, wrote the paper
The first paper is fully grounded in the field of physical limnology. It assumes that the
reader has a background in environmental fluid dynamics and a familiarity with the
relevant literature. It is the result of work that I conducted between January 2008 and
November 2009, as an environmental engineering student at CWR at The University of
Western Australia (UWA) in Perth, Australia, under the supervision of Jörg Imberger
and Jason Antenucci. It was dominated by numerical data analysis (predominantly using
the software MATLAB®) and numerical modelling with the Estuary Lake and Coastal
Ocean Model (ELCOM), to examine the basin-scale circulation and fate of inflow
intrusions in Lake Como. The paper was well received and published in Limnology and
Oceanography in 2010. Its contribution to my thesis is threefold and described below.
First, it is what it appears to be: a stand-alone physical limnology paper focused on the
interplay between different scales of inflows to Lake Como and other forcings on the
flow field such as the morphology of the basin and the wind patterns. As such, it is a
contribution to the scientific knowledge of lakes as it provides new insights on the fate
of inflows in a large temperate lake. This is relevant to lake ecology since the material
drained from the catchment and contained in river and stream inflows may be a source
of nutrients that foster production in the Lake, and/or of pollutants that may affect it.
The paper suggests that more attention should be given to the possible consequences of
changes in inflow regimes for lake hydrodynamics and thereby lake metabolism – an
issue that is very relevant in the current context of climate change.
Second, the work carried out for this paper was the basis for the research question that
led, a year later, to the study reported in Chapter 5 (Fishing nets and data loggers:
contributions of local knowledge to physical limnology) where I explored the local
socio-cultural relevance, and knowledge, of the Lake’s hydrodynamics.
Third, material documenting the research period that led to this paper was then used in
turn as ethnographic (and auto-ethnographic) data to support the reflection presented in
Chapter 6 (The making and meaning of environmental knowledge: a fisherman, a
limnologist and an Italian lake).
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
12
Figure 1. ‘Table of contents’ image of Paper 1. (source: the model impression on the top left is from the
CWR website).
1.4.2 Paper 2: CHAPTER 4
• Authors: Sarah Laborde, Jörg Imberger and Sandy Toussaint
• Title: A wall out of place: a hydrological and socio-cultural analysis of physical
changes to the lakeshore of Como, Italy
• Journal: Ecology and Society
Status: Published in 2012, 17(1): 33. Open access: http://dx.doi.org/10.5751/ES-04610-170133
• Personal contribution: Designed and conducted socio-cultural data collection,
conducted all data analyses, wrote the paper
This paper was conceptualised and written for the most part in 2010 immediately after
the physical limnology study from which the first paper emerged. It is concerned with
catchment hydrology, flood risk in Como and people’s relationship to the lakeshore, and
it is based on a failed engineering intervention on the lakeshore that led to a social
movement. It was my first attempt to link the physical sciences (in this case hydrology)
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
13
and the social sciences (environmental psychology and anthropology) in a standalone
study. It is thus the first paper of my thesis to include analyses from the social sciences,
marking a turning point in the work carried out throughout my PhD candidature.
Its thematic focus somewhat casts it away from the three other papers that are focused
on the Lake’s internal hydrodynamics. However, I chose to include it in the thesis and
leave it in second position because it marks both a trajectory and transition between the
natural sciences and the anthropological analyses carried out, in particular, in Chapter 6.
In this second paper I address a socio-cultural dimension of an engineering intervention
related to lake flooding, although mainly with remote techniques (quantitative, through
a web questionnaire and qualitative, through textual analysis). The idea for this study
came from an event I witnessed when I was in Como for some exploratory fieldwork in
October 2009. A public protest took place because a flood protection structure that was
being built on the city’s lakeshore obscured views of the Lake. The structure was
eventually dismantled (early 2010), and the case seemed to me of particular interest
because it mixed issues pertaining to hydrology (the frequency of flood events, changes
in the catchment’s hydrological cycle), water management (flood prevention choices,
nexus of water uses in the catchment affecting the flood regime, such as hydropower
production and irrigation) and people’s relationship with the Lake and its city shoreline
(that had obviously played a role in the citizens’ reaction to the structure).
I had been thinking of the relevance of the notion of ‘place’ for a while and had started
exploring the literature related to attachments to place (‘sense of place’), because it
seemed like an obvious link between the technical and socio-cultural dimensions of
environmental studies. I thus decided to seize the opportunity of this event and to use it
as a focus for investigating the delicate interplay of technical and cultural matters in
environmental policy - in this case catchment management and flood prevention. The
contributions of this paper to the thesis are twofold and described below.
First, it articulates a methodological transition between the natural and the social
sciences. Socio-cultural analyses are conducted remotely based on letters and web-
questionnaire responses, as well as, to some extent, recollections and field notes from
two weeks on site as I became aware of the issue and started exploring its implications.
Realisation of the limitations of this mainly ‘out of place’ approach encouraged me to
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
14
undertake ethnographic fieldwork for the last two studies of this thesis.
Second, it shows the complementary nature of the physical and social sciences in a
context of environmental policy. This is an important dimension of environmental
knowledge, since environmental policy strives to articulate bridges between different
traditions of knowledge, different ‘rationalities’ (Fisher 2000).
Figure 2. ‘Table of contents’ image of Paper 2. (source: the picture on the bottom left is my own, the
poster on the bottom right was to announce the first public manifestation in response to the structure).
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
15
1.4.3 Paper 3: CHAPTER 5
• Authors: Sarah Laborde, Jörg Imberger and Sandy Toussaint
• Title: Fishing nets and data loggers: contributions of local knowledge to physical
limnology
• Journal: Proceedings of the National Academy of Science of the USA
• Status: Published in 2012: 109(17): 6441
• Personal contribution: Designed study, conducted socio-cultural data collection,
conducted all data analyses and modelling, wrote the paper
This third paper is shorter than the other three. Written soon after returning from
ethnographic fieldwork with the fishers of Lake Como (August to November 2011), it
addresses the potential contributions of local knowledge to the physical geosciences,
through the example of Lake Como’s hydrodynamics. It is written mainly for
environmental scientists, although it is intelligible to a much broader scientific audience
than the first paper, as it does not assume prior familiarity with the physical limnology
literature. It does however assume some familiarity with basic notions of environmental
fluid dynamics.
The study looks at the potential benefits of local knowledge from the perspective of
environmental science. It is not intended to raise epistemological questions and does not
question the relative place of local knowledge with regard to scientific knowledge or the
natural science framework and classical approach to problem solving (hypothesis
building, hypothesis testing). Instead, it aims to show environmental scientists that
within the framework of knowledge production they are familiar with, local knowledge
may be very useful even for geophysical systems (this emphasis is common for
ecological systems [Haggan et al. 2007], but rare in discussions about their physical
dimension).
The paper opens with some background on the limnology of Lake Como. It then
presents some of the fishers’ practices and rules of thumbs that reveal sophisticated
knowledge of hydrodynamic processes in the Lake. It then turns to using some of the
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
16
qualitative interview and participatory mapping data gathered with the fishers to build a
hypothesis with regards to mid-scale horizontal processes in the superficial layers of the
Lake. The hypothesis is then verified using numerical modelling, and the paper
concludes that local knowledge may be a source of valuable data for environmental
scientists, especially as its typical scales (spatial and temporal) differ from the usual
scientific monitoring scales. The contributions of this paper in the context of the thesis
are threefold and described below.
First, it describes and documents fishers’ knowledge of lake hydrodynamics,
particularly longitudinal internal wave and gyres. Local knowledge of such processes
has not been documented elsewhere in the literature, to the best of my knowledge.
Second, it provides an empirical case of integration of local and scientific knowledge
and, third, it triggered the concerns that led to the reflection at the origin of the fourth
paper: The making and meaning of environmental knowledge: A fisherman, a
limnologist and an Italian lake (Chapter 6). Indeed, while Paper 3 showed that local and
scientific environmental knowledge could be usefully integrated, a number of
epistemological concerns emerged regarding the adoption of a scientific framework and
the knowledge it generated.
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
17
Figure 3. ‘Table of contents’ image of Paper 3. In the centre is a graphic impression of a drift-net in the
water. (source: pictures are my own, taken during ethnographic fieldwork. They relate to the practice of
drift-net fishing through time).
1.4.4 Paper 4: CHAPTER 6
• Authors: Sarah Laborde
• Title: The making and meaning of environmental knowledge: a fisherman, a
limnologist and an Italian lake
• Journal: American Anthropologist
• Status: In revision for resubmission to American Anthropologist
• Personal contribution: Designed and conducted all data collection and analyses,
wrote the paper
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
18
This study is written mainly for anthropologists. The work assumes a familiarity with
anthropological concepts and literature, in particular Ingold’s theoretical frameworks
(2000, 2011). The dual engagement with traditions of knowledge of the Lake’s
hydrodynamics was drawn on to ruminate the nature of environmental knowledge itself.
This paper explores claims made by Ingold and others that there is no epistemological
boundary between science and other forms of knowing: forms of knowledge all emerge,
and are instantiated, through practical engagement with a given field of practice or
taskscape. This paper also argues for a pluralistic view of environmental knowledge that
is based on situated practices – a way to engage scientists and local knowledge holders
around places of interest and to support mutual intelligibility of bodies of knowledge.
I first use references about practice theory to show how the production of lake
knowledge in the contexts of academic environmental science and professional lake
fishing may be seen as the product of practical enskillment processes. Such processes
attune the senses and the mind to the environment, as it is known by them. This point is
nicely expressed in the fisherman’s poem that opens this chapter. Such knowledge is of
equal epistemological value in both cases, although they relate to very different
taskscapes. In this sense I draw from Ingold’s helpful definition of taskscapes as fields
of practice embedded in one’s direct environment (biophysical, social). I also emphasise
the difference in these taskscapes as that which leads ultimately to different kinds of
knowledge (scientific, local). I use the concept of ‘heterotopia’ defined by Foucault as
‘localised utopias … counter-places designed to erase, compensate, neutralise and
purify other places’ (Foucault 1966 [Radio Feature, 7 December 1966]). This concept is
applied as an analytical means to discuss the fields of practice of environmental
scientists and engineers in the context of remote, numerical studies. These today are
often conducted in university offices, via computers that ‘process’ data from many other
places. Through comparison with knowledge produced in local place-based
circumstances, one of my concerns is to query the relationship that the producers of
remote scientific knowledge hold with the physical places they aim to describe or
represent (here the lake).
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
19
Figure 4. ‘Table of contents’ image of Paper 4. (source: pictures are my own, taken during ethnographic
fieldwork).
1.5 Concluding remarks
This chapter has developed the thesis problem, its relevance and literature context. I
have clarified my use of the key terms of environment, knowledge, and the distinction I
adopt between notions of scientific and local knowledge. Finally, I have outlined each
of the original papers. The core of this thesis constituted by Chapters 3 to 6. Chapter 2
reflects on the methodologies adopted throughout my research, and Chapter 7 discusses
its outcomes. Chapter 8 presents conclusions of the analysis.
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
20
1.6 References
Agrawal, A. 1995. Dismantling the divide between indigenous and scientific
knowledge. Development and Change 26:413-439
Barth, F. 2002. An Anthropology of knowledge. Current Anthropology 43(1):1-18
Bennett, E. M., G. D. Peterson and L. J. Gordon. 2009. Understanding relationships
among multiple ecosystem services Ecology Letters 12:1394–1404
Brembilla, G. and A. Valpolini. 1999. Breva e Tivano Motori Naturali. Associazione
culturale L. Scanagatta: Varenna [Italian]
Centre for Water Research (CWR) [online] URL: http://www.cwr.uwa.edu.au
Devine-Wright, P. and Y. Howes. 2010. Disruption to place attachment and the
protection of restorative environments: A wind energy case study. Journal of
Environmental Psychology 30(3) 271–280
Escobar, A. 1998. Whose knowledge, whose nature? Biodiversity, conservation, and the
political ecology of social movements. Journal of political ecology 5
Escobar, A. 1999 After Nature - Steps to an anti-essentialist political ecology. Current
Anthropology: 40 (1)
Fisher, F. 2000. Citizens, Experts and the environment: The politics of local knowledge.
Duke University Press: USA
Foucault, M. 1966. ‘Les hétérotopies’ - Radio conference, France culture: Culture
Française (December 7, 1966)
Gagnon, C. A. and D. Berteaux. 2009. Integrating traditional ecological knowledge and
ecological science: a question of scale. Ecology and Society 14(2): 19. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol14/iss2/art19/
Haggan, N., B. Neis and I. G. Baird (Eds.). 2007. Fishers’ knowledge in fisheries
science and management. Edited by Coastal Management Sourcebooks - UNESCO
Publishing: Paris
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
21
Harper, K. M. 2001. Introduction: The environment as master narrative: discourse and
identity in environmental problems. Anthropological Quarterly 74.3
Ingold, T. 2000 The perception of the environment: essays on livelihood, dwelling and
skill. Routledge: London
Ingold, T. 2011 Being Alive. Routledge: London
Kuper, A. 2003. The return of the native. Current Anthropology 44, 389-402.
Laborde, S., J. Antenucci, D. Copetti and J. Imberger. 2010. Inflow intrusions at
multiple scales in a large temperate lake. Limnology and Oceanography 55(3): 1301–
1312 (Chapter 3 of this thesis)
Latour, B. 2005 [1987] La science en action. Introduction à la sociologie des sciences,
La Découverte, La Découverte-poche. Sciences humaines et sociales [French]
Latour, B. and S. Woolgar. 1986 [1979]. Laboratory Life: the construction of scientific
facts. Princeton University Press, c1986: Princeton, N.J
Morán, E. F. 2008. Human adaptability: an introduction to ecological anthropology –
3rd Ed. Westview Press: Boulder, CO
Nader, L. (Ed.) 1996. Naked science: anthropological inquiry into boundaries, power,
and knowledge. Routledge: New York
O'Connell, J. 1993. Metrology: The creation of universality by the circulation of
particulars. Social Studies of Science. 23 (1): 129-173
Okely, P. N. 2010. Interplay of lake motions and processes affecting horizontal
transport in a range of water bodies. PhD Thesis University of Western Australia,
CWR
Orlove, B. 1991. Mapping reeds and reading maps: The politics of representation in
Lake Titicaca American Ethnologist 18(1):3-38
Oxford English Dictionary [OED]. 2011. [online] URL: http://www.oed.com
CHAPTER 1. Introduction
22
Pickering, A. (Ed.) 1992. Science as Practice and Culture. Chicago University Press:
Chicago
Polanyi, M. 1969. Knowing and being. University of Chicago Press: Chicago
Raymond, C. M., I. Fazey, M. S. Reed, L. C. Stringer, G. M. Robinson and A. C. Evely.
2010. Integrating local and scientific knowledge for environmental management.
Journal of Environmental Management 91:1766-1777
Robertson, H. A. and T. K. McGee. 2003. Applying local knowledge: the contribution
of oral history to wetland rehabilitation at Kanyapella Basin, Australia. Journal of
Environmental Management 69:275-287.
Russell, B. 1948. Human knowledge – its scope and limits. Simon and Schuster: New
York
Strang, V. 2009. Gardening the world - Agency, identity, and the ownership of water.
Berghahn Books: New York
Toussaint, S. 2008. Kimberley friction: Complex attachments to water-places in
northern Australia. Oceania 78:46-61
Tsing, A. 2005. Friction: An ethnography of global connection. Princeton University
Press: Princeton
Tuan, Y-F. 1974. Topophilia: a study of environmental perception, attitudes, and
values. Prentice-Hall, Englewood Cliffs, NJ
Turnbull, D. 2003 [2000] Masons, tricksters and cartographers: comparative studies in
the sociology of scientific and indigenous knowledge. Routledge: London
UN-Habitat. 2010. State of the World cities 2010/2011. [online] URL:
http://www.unhabitat.org/documents/SOWC10/R7.pdf
Williams, D-M. 2000. Representations of nature on the Mongolian steppe: An
investigation of scientific knowledge construction. American Anthropologist
102(3):503-519
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
23
Chapter 2 Methodologies, Literature context, and
introduction to the Lake
Every idea is like a place you visit. You may arrive there along
one or several paths, and linger for a while before moving on,
perhaps to circle around and return later. Each time you revisit
the idea it is a little different, enriched by the memories and
experience of your previous stays.
(Ingold and Hallam 2011:8)
2.1 General approach
As stated in the Introduction, a characteristic of my work was to approach the same
environment (in my case, Lake Como) via the vantage point of different disciplines.
Pluri-disciplinarity is here both a means and an end: a way to develop insights about a
water system, and also a goal in and of itself, I was interested in adopting a mixed
methods approach. Some people might ask why and how did an environmental engineer
become interested in the social sciences? It is a question I have often been asked, and it
is one I have often asked myself. There is no simple answer of course, as countless
factors have influenced this evolution in my thinking. One of them was the awareness
that there is a plurality of ways to know the world around us (Turnbull 2003). Another
was a form of frustration with the self-imposed limits of most academic fields, which, as
some may argue, have evolved for a reason and serve a particular purpose, but others
may argue, offer opportunities for inter-disciplinary explorations (e.g. Robinson 2008).
It seemed to me that a PhD was a unique opportunity to probe these options.
In this chapter about data and methods, I discuss how I went about this project. I start by
disentangling various concepts related to working across the disciplines and clarifying
how I use terms such as cross-disciplinary, pluri-disciplinary and trans-disciplinary. I
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
24
then present the study-site first as a water body, a term and perspective often adopted by
environmental scientists and engineers, and I then describe features of the Lake as a
waterscape, which according to Orlove and Caton is a ‘culturally meaningful,
sensorially active place in which humans interact with water and with each other’
(2010: 408). Interwoven in these descriptions are discussions about the methods I used
to access these interrelated conceptualisations of the Lake, from one paper to the next.
Because the use and relevance of each method emerged from the questions prompted by
the previous one, I discuss the methods in the chronological order of their use.
The methods used in the studies are detailed in each one of the relevant chapters. In
particular, specific methods pertaining to environmental fluid dynamics were used in
Chapter 3; while Chapters 4 and 5 were developed using mixed methods encompassing
both the environmental and social sciences, and Chapter 6 inscribed itself in a tradition
of anthropological practice. In the present chapter I am more concerned with the
transitions between these very distinct methodologies, their flow within the thesis, and
the epistemological grounds on which they stand.
2.2 Terminology: mangle of prefixes
There is a call worldwide for more inter-disciplinary academic and applied research. I
have aimed, through my doctoral study, to contribute to this growing emphasis. In
practice, work across various disciplinary boundaries is not new: it has occurred in the
past and its process and outcomes have been variously considered and applied (OECD
1972). The choice of terminology is itself delicate when undertaking work across
disciplines, whilst trying to maintain the integrity of each. Limnology for instance is a
pluri-disciplinary field: it combines the study of lake physics (climate, hydrodynamics),
chemistry, ecology and biology (among which studies of aquatic plants, bacteria,
phytoplankton, zooplankton and fish). This does not mean that physical and ecological
limnologists always work together – their sub-fields are simply encompassed by the
field of limnology. And if they were to work together on a common issue, say, the
relationship between rates of hydrodynamic dispersion and algal productivity in a lake,
they would be likely to reach quite rapidly a shared understanding of the issue to work
on, and then contribute different skills to it within a commonly-defined framework.
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
25
Working across the natural sciences and the humanities, however, takes another level of
difficulty as epistemological and methodological concerns emerge, which must be
addressed (Toussaint 2005; Jolly and Kavanagh 2009).
Terms formed with a prefix followed by the root word ‘disciplinary’ suggest different
ways to work with several disciplines and, while not clearly defined, these terms tend to
refer to different levels of integration. Multi-disciplinary and cross-disciplinary are the
terms most commonly used (Strathern 2007), involving several disciplines but not the
integration of vision or methods between them. Insights from different disciplines are
simply juxtaposed or, in the case of cross-disciplinary, examined through each other’s
lens. This is the approach adopted in Chapter 4: the work pertaining respectively to the
environmental and social sciences was conducted somewhat independently (although
this raises methodological concerns, addressed later in this chapter, because I was the
same researcher conducting the studies), and the outcomes were integrated in a
discussion of environmental planning. The methods were, however, inscribed in the
traditions of different fields, and they did not overlap.
A next level of integration is inter-disciplinarity (Strathern 2007; Jolly and Kavanagh
2009), which is exemplified in Chapter 5. In this paper, the results of the scientific study
presented in Chapter 3 first influenced the ethnographic fieldwork and the co-creation of
knowledge with the fishers about the Lake’s currents. Insights from the ethnographic
fieldwork in turn influenced the modelling study conducted. The final results,
combining participatory local-knowledge maps and scientific modelling outcomes, thus
constitute the result of a truly inter-disciplinary study where the methods and the aim
were co-defined, and the outcomes co-produced, incrementally across the
environmental and social sciences. The practices of each field thus shaped each other, in
a way that may be compared to Escher’s ‘drawing hands’ as reproduced below (Fig. 5).
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
26
Figure 5: M.C. Escher. Drawing Hands, 1948. Credits: all M.C. Escher works © 2012 The M.C. Escher
Company - the Netherlands. All rights reserved. Used by permission. www.mcescher.com
Finally, I define Chapter 6 as trans-disciplinary because it is a reflexive attempt to
discuss the nature and the organisation of knowledge produced by different (local and
remote scientific) communities (Lawrence and Després 2004). A summary of the
approach and methods used in each paper may be found in the figure below (Fig. 6).
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
27
Figure 6: Summary of methods used in the different thesis chapters, and their location on the research
spectrum from quantitative to qualitative research
Another productive way to look at work that engages several disciplines is using the
distinction proposed by Robinson (2008) between issue-based inter-disciplinarity and
discipline-based inter-disciplinarity. In the case he puts forward, the different papers
that comprise this thesis would address different angles: clearly Chapter 4 was issue-
based, as it took its inspiration from a real-life, complex and messy problem that
necessitated the triangulation of various data sources gathered overtime. On the other
hand, Chapters 5 and 6 were disciplinary-focused and the questions they address are not
at present crucial to practical, day-to-day life beyond academic settings. The issues
addressed by Chapter 5 are relative to the hydrodynamics of Lake Como and the results
of the study might be of interest, but will not be of any immediate use, to the fishers
who took part in the research: it contains knowledge that the fishers already have and
use in a practical sense in their daily lives, and it is written for scientific readers.
Chapter 6 is concerned with the nature of environmental knowledge, a question that I
treat as philosophical, as it interrogates human interactions with, and knowledge about,
natural environments – an emphasis that resonates with Ingold’s definition of
anthropological inquiry as ‘philosophy out of doors’ (2008: 83).
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
28
The different kinds of interactions between disciplinary lines of thought as evident in
readings of Chapters 3 to 6 thus emerged from a dialogue between elements of
environmental and social science that mutually defined, questioned and enriched each
other. These also corresponded to two initially distinct ways of conceptualising the
Lake. I introduce these below.
2.3 Lake Como as a water body
A lake may be considered as a natural system resulting from a combination of
biogeophysical processes that can be described, explained and predicted to some extent
by the standards and laws of science currently prevalent. From this perspective, a lake is
material, physical, well defined and bounded, although interacting with its surroundings.
It has an inner metabolism, influenced by its exchanges with the atmosphere above and
the land below and around it.
A mechanistic description of the workings of such a body of water may stand on a
realist approach to knowledge: one that assumes that the reality of the world transcends
differences in perception and thinking (and thus subjectivity), and that aims to describe
natural processes in a way that is objective, independent of the agent perceiving,
analysing and describing them. Or it may stand on a positivist view, which is not
necessarily concerned with reality as such, but with theories that are judged on their
ability to predict phenomena of the natural world. This is the paradigm within which I
worked in Chapter 3, and it may be argued that this epistemological stance is generally
implicitly adopted by scientists and engineers who apply Newtonian physics in their
work – for while classical mechanics provides empirically robust predictions of the
motion of bodies under various forcings and it is used in countless science and
engineering applications, from a theoretical point of view it has been superseded by
Einstein’s theory of relativity.
The scientific study of lakes and other bodies of fresh inland waters is addressed by the
field of limnology. My interest was in physical limnology, which is concerned with
water motions in lakes and other standing bodies of water, and rests on the theories and
tools of environmental fluid dynamics. These are based on the physical laws of
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
29
conservation of mass, linear momentum and energy. Fluid dynamics is a branch of
continuum mechanics (itself within classical mechanics), meaning that it assumes a
scale of study that considers the relevant material, in this case the water, as a continuous
medium rather than discrete particles. Under this general framework, the motions of
water in a lake may be studied and modelled accounting for the basin’s morphology and
the lake’s exchanges of water, heat and energy with its surroundings (Fischer et al
1979).
Physical limnology studies are based on the systematic monitoring and analysis of water
and atmosphere properties through time and space, at times and resolutions that may
vary greatly. This approach goes hand in hand with the definition of a domain and scale
of study, and thus the arbitrary definition of boundaries to the environment that will be
studied through the analysis of fluxes across these boundaries. Numerical data relevant
to the domain, today stored and handled with computers, are then examined and
transformed until making sense to the researcher and providing information that
increases understanding about particular processes occurring in the lake or other aquatic
environment. The focus is on processes, not places, and the resulting knowledge aims to
be ‘placeless’ in order to be generalised and transferable. It is developed and exchanged
through (conceptual, numerical and laboratory) models developed from many case
studies originating from different places. Therefore, much of the work may be carried
out remotely from the lake of concern, as long as the data travel from there to the
relevant researcher, and computer. The general approach of data collection and analysis
that was described above also applies to studies of catchment hydrology such as in
Chapter 4, where water fluxes through the Lake Como catchment are addressed based
on precipitations, river flow rates and lake level data.
2.3.1 The Lake
Italy’s Lake Como is of glacial origin and stretches 45 km between the mountain
regions of the Alps in the north and the agro-industrial plains of the Brianza in the
south, and running alongside the Swiss border to the west (Fig. 7). The Lake’s waters
are supplied by an alpine catchment with a peak inflow rate in late spring and early
summer due to snowmelt at high altitudes. The Lake is part of the drainage basin of the
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
30
Po River of which the Lake’s only outflow, the Adda River (exiting at Lecco at the
southeastern end of the Lake) is a tributary. The flow of water throughout the Adda
catchment is highly regulated, mainly due to of hydropower production and irrigation
for agriculture (Fig. 7).
Figure 7: Lake Como – Left: geographical context5. Right: detail of the catchment
The Lake is long and narrow (between 0.5 and 4.5 km in width), very deep (up to 425
m) and surrounded by mountains that channel regular winds. The Lake’s three arms
extend respectively north (Alto Lago), southeast (ramo di Lecco) and southwest (ramo
di Como), for a total surface of 146 km² and 170 km of intricate shoreline. It is a
temperate lake, and from spring to autumn its waters stratify as a seasonal thermocline
forms, which is a sharp water temperature and density gradient. Waves can run on the
thermocline just as they do at the density interface between air and water, and they
create currents. Because the water density is determined mainly by its temperature, in
stratified lakes vertical water motions can be tracked by monitoring the temperature
changes in the water column. To understand the causes of such motions one needs to
examine them in light of external constraints characterised by meteorological conditions
5 photo: NASA
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
31
(solar radiations, wind velocity and direction, air temperature and humidity), water
fluxes (inflows, outflows and water level) and the shape of the basin (bathymetry).
2.3.2 Data collection and analysis (relevant to Chapters 3, 4 and 5)
Lake Como was my field site for the study of such water motions in Chapter 3, with
data collection, storage and transfer technology allowing the work to be carried out from
the Perth-based UWA. A 5m-resolution bathymetry of the Lake was obtained through
the National Centre for Research in Italy (CNR), and subsequently digitised to produce
a bathymetric grid. I also obtained outflows, rainfall and water level data for the Lake
through the body responsible for the management of the water level in Lake Como, the
Consorzio dell’Adda. CWR installed three permanent monitoring stations in the Lake
between 2005 and 2007 (which was before I commenced doctoral research).
These stations, called Lake Diagnosis Systems (LDS), provided the main source of data
used in Chapters 3 and 5. They are composed of a steel frame supported by an
arrangement of floats that keep the station stable in windy and wavy conditions. A chain
of thermistors attached to the frame measures the temperature throughout the water
column at varying depth intervals (of the order of 1m for the Lake Como LDS) and
down to 150 m. Meteorological sensors are fitted on the emerged part of the frame and
measure air temperature, humidity, wind speed and direction, and solar global and net
radiations. These stations were located at strategic points, at the extremity of each end
of the Lake, to best document longitudinal internal waves. Data recorded with 1 min
resolution were transmitted via satellite in near real-time and imported into Matlab
format at CWR in Perth.
I took part in a one-day field-monitoring campaign in 2008 with a group of Italian
researchers from IRSA-Brugherio, which is a partner of CWR in the study of the Lake.
It consisted of taking water column profiles of temperature and conductivity (CTD
‘drop-in’ profiler), as well as biochemical variables such as pH, oxygen and chlorophyll
concentration (fluoroprobe), following a route (longitudinal and transversal profiles)
pre-established by the researcher responsible for the campaign, Dr. Diego Copetti, and
adjusted according to the real-time results of the measurements. I did not use these data
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
32
directly in my analysis but those from a prior campaign conducted similarly by the same
team, and it was thus useful to practically participate in that campaign.
I conducted most of the data analysis using the software Matlab, both for Chapters 3 and
4. Most datasets consisted in time series (temperature, meteorological variables, flow
rates, water levels) were checked for consistency and data gaps, then plotted, filtered,
examined to identify patterns or interesting features in the data series. For Chapter 3,
water motions in the Lake were tracked through the analysis of temperature differences
in depth and latitude in the Lake. A more technical description of the methods used may
be found in that chapter.
A very important aspect of data analysis in these contexts of hydrology and physical
limnology was the production and observation of graphs, corroborating the findings of
Latour and Woolgar (1986) who found that graphs, a large part of what they describe as
‘inscriptions’, were the main focus of activity in the laboratory where they conducted
ethnographic fieldwork. Graphs make available to the eye what is normally invisible,
whether it is patterns of lake level variations over centuries (Chapter 4) or some aspect
of the Lake’s subsurface thermal structure (Chapter 3). Much of my work was thus
geared toward the production of graphs, which ultimately constituted the backbones of
Chapter 3 and the hydrology section of Chapter 4. Most meetings with my
environmental engineering supervisors were based on graphs, too (see also Goodwin
1995), and at the early stages of hypothesis building, the ‘raw’ data appeared on these.
Later they displayed modelling results, or data that had been analysed and plotted in a
way to emphasise a particular feature. Graphs were critical to my physical limnology
studies to support learning, reasoning and argument building; later, they helped to raise
theoretical questions regarding how knowledge is constructed, analysed and applied
within system-specific information (Chapter 6; Latour 1990).
2.3.3 Hydrodynamic modelling
Since the hydro-meteorological data combined data sets with (a) high temporal
resolution at discrete spatial locations (permanent in-lake monitoring, river gauges); and
(b) with higher spatial resolutions at discrete times (boat sampling campaigns), I used a
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
33
numerical model (ELCOM: Hodges et al. 2000) to gain a better combined and three-
dimensional understanding of the transport and mixing processes in the Lake. The
modelling code, like the data-collection instrumentation and some of the processing
programs, was developed at CWR and used by many researchers before me. What was
needed was to set up the model and validate it for Lake Como, to be able to use it in an
exploratory manner with confidence in its ability to simulate the processes of interest in
the actual Lake. This type of numerical models used in physical limnology research and
applications are based on similar theoretical and computational techniques than those
used for weather forecasting. They rely on heavy computation in the case of consequent
domains of analyses, and computers were available at the research centre for the sole
purpose of modelling.
I used that model rather than another, primarily as a result of guidance from CWR
researchers who advised it would be appropriate for my study. It was also a decision of
convenience since it was developed locally and I had access to technical support in case
of a problem. In the end, the model that was developed most specifically to simulate
stratified bodies of water (like Lake Como in summer and autumn, my periods of
interest in Chapters 3 and 5), performed very well. More technical detail on the model
and its validation is provided the relevant Chapters 3 and 5.
Numerical models have a tremendous scaling power and can process extensive
information through a combination (by computation) of the formalised knowledge
embedded in the model, the tacit knowledge of the modeller and the data coming from
the probes; a trend that is increasing as computational power progresses. ELCOM for
instance can calculate and output properties of the water in each cell of the grid –
millions of locations in the virtual lake, for each (virtual) minute. Such numerical
models also facilitate shifts in context between theoretical knowledge and site-specific
data in a much more dramatic way than graphs do, by providing a ‘ready-made’
framework to operate such shifts (e.g. the theoretical knowledge in mathematical form
contained in the model is applied to the system in focus as the model is applied to that
system).
The result of using these methodologies was a vision of the Lake (see Chapter 3), which
was shaped by the cultural and academic practices of CWR (through instrumentation,
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
34
software, model, socialisation and guidance). It is a picture that aims to be generally
useful for a broad community of scientists and practitioners. The self-stated aim of my
study, which emerged during the process of data analysis, was to improve the
understanding of the fate of inflows to Lake Como, and other lakes to some extent, with
potential applications for management responses to both pollution and climate change
effects, especially relevant in the current context of climatic change (Laborde et al.
2010).
2.4 Lake Como as a waterscape
Lakes considered as water places make room for the subjectivity and situatedness
inherent to the human relationship with these places, which is generally and
purposefully absent from their scientific descriptions as water bodies. Water places are
relevant to socio-cultural life through productive water use (e.g. for agriculture), a
dimension that is at the core of the motivation for environmental engineering, but also
through their meanings and people’s emotions, reflections and day-to-day actions as
individuals or groups. These humanistic dimensions, interwoven with the material and
biophysical dimensions of water places, became central to my thinking and eventually
to this thesis. A description of the Lake that contextualises and encompasses these
dimensions is provided below.
2.4.1 The Lake
The Lake that is today known as Lake Como has another name, its most locally
grounded name: Lario, derived from its Latin name Larius. Populated at least since the
Bronze Age (3000 – 600 BC), it has since absorbed waste and provided food, water and
a route between the Alps to the Po Plain for the people inhabiting its shores. Soft hills
and sharp mountains surround it, and it is sufficiently narrow so that one standing on a
shore can always see the land across the Lake, except on the rare occasions in winter
when thick fog covers the water surface. The variation of light and colour, the shadows
of the mountains and the patterns made by the breeze onto the Lake create an ever-
changing landscape. The water is clear in winter and appears green and blurry in spring
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
35
and summer because of algae. The colours of the sky and mountain also vary with the
seasons and the weather: a day in October for instance, when the mountains start to
change from dark green to brown and red tones, may be clear and dry, with the
northerly wind blowing cold air from the snow-capped Alps that look almost purple in
the distance. Autumn also has dim and rainy days with little light; fog that deadens
sounds and ‘merges water and air [over the Lake], while the colours forget to separate
from grey’ (Gini 2000: 6).
The shape of the Lake is said to resemble an inverted ‘Y’, or a man with a foot at Como
and the other at Lecco6. The southeastern, Lecco arm – sometimes called Lecco Lake by
the people from its shores – is edged by sharp and high mountains that outline a ‘severe’
landscape contrasting with the ‘voluptuous Como arm’ (Stendhal 1939: 40). The
northern arm (Alto Lago), closer to the Alps and further from the southern cities, is
wider than the other two, more open and exposed to the winds.
The Lake landscape, at once infused of powerful and mysterious nature by the
proximity with the mountains and the depth of the Lake, and reassuring by the soft
bends in the shores, the villages, cultures and the ability of the eye to grasp both lake
and shore at any given time, has attracted many travellers, scholars and artists for
millennia. This was especially true for the Como arm because a road (Via Regina or Via
Regia) has been running along its western shore since the Roman times. In the Middle
ages (8th century), Paul the Deacon was already praising Lake Como in his poetry.
Many followed through history, and the Lake was particularly renowned as a place of
aesthetic contemplation during the romantic era (Dettamanti 2004). This was, maybe,
because western aesthetic sensibilities tended then to find pleasure in features that at
once evoked powerful nature and human control over it - as put by Tuan, because
‘wilderness elicited delight only when it no longer overwhelmed’ (1995: 60). Stendhal
for instance wrote about the Lake in ‘the charterhouse of Parma’: ‘Everything is noble
and tender, everything speaks of love (…) nothing else as beautiful is to be seen in the
world’ (1839: 24).
6 This is a popular saying (e.g Fieldwork 26 Oct. 2010)
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
36
Alongside this intellectual and artistic life, the Lake has been a place of arduous
physical work for many local families for whom fishing has been part of the local, rural
livelihood at least since the Roman times7. Other household-scale means of subsistence
have included logging, horticulture and husbandry of few farm animals, such as cows
and goats. Silk production was also an important part of the local economy from the 16th
through to the early 20th century; and so was the smuggling of contraband from
Switzerland, mainly for the villages along the western shore of the Lake, from the early
19th to the mid-20th century (Pensa 1981). The steel industry became prominent around
the Lake in the 20th century, while a more popular form of tourism has become a
primary source of revenue to the area in the recent decades, with a general focus on
holiday houses, campsites and water sports in the north, mountain-related activities in
the east, and culture and aesthetics in the southwestern and central zones of the Lake,
which shelter historical villas and luxury hotels.
Today, the cities and villages by the Lake, built on the shore or the steep mountainsides,
are home to over 180 000 people, about 130 000 of which live in the cities of Como and
Lecco, south of the Lake. In many regards, lakeshore communities are far from
homogeneous. While the Italian language is spoken and understood across generations,
local dialects varying in vocabulary and accent between neighbouring villages dominate
the villages around the Lake, especially among older generations. Beside local
attachment to each village’s uniqueness (e.g. Pensa 1981), there is what seems to be a
mutually acknowledged duality between the residents of the cities (Como/Lecco) and
the villages on the Lake: the ‘people from the Lake’ are referred to as laghee or laghisti,
by their urban neighbours with at times a hint of condescendence (Field notes 30 Aug.
2010), and by themselves with a bit of pride (e.g. Field notes 16 Sept. 2010). The closed
and mountainous landscape is locally thought to have shaped the mentalities and
attitudes of the laghee, described as strong-tempered people (Pensa 1981: 142). For the
people living by its shores, whether from the city of the villages, the Lake is a day-to-
day presence. This emphasis was conveyed to me by a local woman who observed that
Lake Como was like household ’furniture’, suggesting not only an intimacy in the
7 Fishing artefacts were found in a Roman grave in Colonno, including an item that is still used by lake fishers (Pirovano 2003)
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
37
people/lake relationship, but also a certain comfortableness and necessity of something
so familiar (Field notes 29 Sept. 2010).
2.4.2 Questionnaire, textual analysis (Chapter 4)
The methods used in Chapter 4 aimed to address the socio-cultural dimension of an
engineering intervention on the Como lakeshore. This research took place primarily
from my University in Perth since at that stage (after preliminary fieldwork where the
idea of that paper was born) I was not yet ready to undertake ethnographic research
(although I had commenced supervised study in anthropology).
The development of a web questionnaire for Chapter 4 was a very useful
methodological transition toward social science methods. It was also a useful technique
to acquire, with the help of CWR’s information systems manager at the time. The
treatment of questionnaire data through statistics (using the software PASW Statistics)
allowed a transition from quantitative methods applied to the environmental sciences
(Chapters 3 and 4), to quantitative methods applied to the social sciences, allowing me
to get exposed to new, complex and not totally quantifiable concepts while staying with
the initial comfort of numbers. The limitations of a quantitative method to address such
concepts led me to complement it, already in Chapter 4, with a textual analysis of letters
written by Como’s citizens about the intervention. I thus developed a form of
triangulation to canvass the socio-cultural aspect of the case study related to attachments
to place. This approach also allowed me to become familiar with the environmental
psychology literature on people’s relationships to environmental places (see literature
review in Chapter 4), an interesting complement to the anthropological literature on
these matters.
At a methodological level, Chapter 4 evolved into a substantial bridge as it encouraged
me to become aware of the interest of combining qualitative and quantitative datasets,
and environmental and social science perspectives on a real-world issue. It was a
difficult paper to write, because of the mixed methods used and also because I came to
realise that such a topic would have required being ‘in place’ to address the demands
and complexity of socio-cultural research more thoroughly. While I think the resulting
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
38
paper is valuable from a methodological perspective, I am also conscious that it
addresses only a narrow aspect of people’s reaction to the structure - that which could
be captured through the questionnaire and in letters. Nonetheless, what I considered to
be a limitation of that paper turned into a strong motivation to carry out ethnographic
research on site as I became increasingly curious about the social side of people’s lives,
everyday practices, cultural life and, in particular, local knowledge about the Lake. The
results of this work emerge in Chapters 5 and 6.
2.4.3 Being there (Chapters 5 and 6): the Lake as a fishing – and ethnographic – taskscape
I conducted ethnographic fieldwork over three months (mid-August to Mid-November
2010), which was concentrated on the Lake’s professional fishers and their
understandings of the Lake’s physical dimensions, in particular some of the processes
described scientifically in Chapter 3. The idea to work with the fishers emerged from
local encounters, in particular that with Massimo Pirovano, a local ethnographer and
historian who had worked with the Lake’s fishers in the 1990s (Pirovano 1996; 2003)
and from discussion about their knowledge of the currents in a limnology study from the
early 20th century (Monti 1924).
Sixty-nine professional fishers were licensed to operate on the Lake in 2010. While the
number of people who actually operated each day varied with the seasons (summer sees
more of them as the conditions are easier), about 30 men consistently fished throughout
the year. They belonged to two main age groups centred on 45 and 65 years old. They
all knew each other, especially the men fishing near each other, whether in the Como
arm, the Centro Lago, the Lecco arm or the Alto Lago. Amongst all the people of the
Lake, these men are probably the most laghisti of all, working long and physically
demanding hours in constant contact with the Lake, and it is their knowledge of the
Lake that helped put my scientific study in perspective.
Time in the field was informed by early discussions with Massimo Pirovano, and with
the councillors for fisheries in the provinces of Lecco and Como, in charge of the
regulation of the activity. These conversations encouraged me to consider how many
fishers were operating on the Lake, where and with which daily rhythm. These matters
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
39
were particularly useful because of the relatively short period of time I could spend in
the field. To encounter the fishers, I carried out qualitative participant-observation
research which usually involved being in and around the local harbour of lakeside
villages, or at fishing premises when applicable (usually near or within their house, near
the harbour), around 7 or 8 in the morning hoping to meet them as they returned from
retrieving the nets. It was easy to find the men as I asked around the various villages for
the ‘fisher(s)’s place’, known by all. The morning was the best time for interviews as
fishers usually slept during the early afternoon and were busy preparing and setting the
nets in the late afternoon. In the mornings I could arrange time to discuss with them
while they were cleaning, sometimes with their spouses and other family members, the
fish they had just caught. The timing of each interview varied between 30 minutes and 2
hours.
Fishers first considered me sceptically, an attitude that changed progressively as it
became clear I did not represent local governance institutions. They would then
sometimes direct me to other fishers they knew after I explained I was hoping to
interview people operating in various zones of the Lake. This method is usually referred
to as ‘snowballing’ in the literature. It was an effective tool for the circumstances within
which I worked.
The fact that I was a foreign woman helped make my enquiries non-threatening, as did
the topic of my main interest, the fishers’ relationship with the Lake’s physical
dimension. One of the fishermen’s wives confirmed that she felt this was the case,
noting that ‘[the water currents] are not a secret, they are not part of the work of the
fisher’. I found that an understanding of water currents was very much part of the
fishers’ work but, as revealed by this quote (and luckily for me considering my
relatively short time in the field), an understanding of the winds and lake currents was
not considered part of that sensitive body of knowledge, the techniques and tricks that
have to be kept concealed from other fishers (and sometimes administrators). This made
it a non-polemical argument and facilitated discussions that would then open onto other
topics.
I approached the way in which the fishers interacted with Lake Como via two entry
points. I first carried out a spatial survey with 22 fishers around the Lake, conducting
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
40
ethnographic interviewing and exploring the fishers’ relationship to the Lake by
canvassing details about their fishing practices, the fabric of their small community, the
tacit boundaries and links that exist between them on the Lake. I also undertook
mapping with them (on outlines of the Lake I had pre-drawn) so that we recorded the
winds and currents relevant to their activity. This facilitated the emergence of some
contextual knowledge of their work beliefs and practices, and of these aspects of their
taskscape I was most interested in. These data were emphasised in Chapter 5.
I also elicited and then integrated insights from a period of deeper involvement and
experience, via a deepened, singular participant observation working with of one of the
fishers in a zone where the water currents were particularly strong. I went on the boat
with the fisherman on several occasions to set and retrieve the nets, helped sort and
carry the nets, and helped process the fish. Living just by the small harbour I was able to
watch coloured lights of the nets overnight, and follow their paths. In Paper 4 (Chapter
6), I present narratives, images and sequences of events that illustrate these practices
and engagement with the water currents, collected on and off the fishing boat.
2.5 Reflexivity
2.5.1 Reflexive limnology
Alongside studying as a scientist and engineer via the work carried out throughout 2011
and reported in Chapter 5, the interest in social, cultural and environmental
anthropology I had by then developed assisted a process of reflexivity, and I started to
apply anthropological inquiry to my own scientific practice.8
I had accumulated social and cultural information since the beginning of my
engagement with the data and methods of physical limnology, which in hindsight I
realised constituted a rough basis for the collection of ethnographic material from three
8 An early interest in anthropology had led my supervisor Sandy Toussaint to introduce me to environmental anthropology literature, even as I was only enrolled in environmental engineering in 2008 and 2009. I enrolled in a third-year anthropology unit at Curtin University in 2009 and participated in a postgraduate anthropology-writing group from 2010 – all factors that played a role in the development of my interest for anthropology.
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
41
years of study as an environmental engineering student conducting research about the
Lake’s physics. Whilst not systematic, the data discerned from an analysis of emails,
and schedules, plans and notes concerning day-to-day actions, computing, programming
and modelling, writing an article for a limnology journal, and of course interacting with
other students and scholars.
As I started working toward Chapter 6, and in order to document and reflect on a
limnologist’s knowledge of water currents in the Lake, I relied on my own research
experience through this information related to my approach to the Lake as a physical
limnology student. It was a form of analytic auto-ethnography as Anderson (2006)
defined it, since I was a member of the research setting and social group I discuss (that
of academic research in physical limnology), I was identified in publications as
belonging to that research field (Chapter 3), and my aim was to reflect on this
experience to examine broader epistemological issues.
2.5.2 Elements of reflexive ethnography
I was also well aware during ethnographic fieldwork and the analysis that followed, that
the fishers’ knowledge I had documented, then called ‘local’ and compared to scientific
knowledge, was largely influenced by my own understanding of the Lake and, in
particular, that which I had acquired through my engagement with physical limnology.
It is this background that made me see some significant and new connections between
fishers’ stories of currents and scientists’ stories of lake stratification and internal waves
– a connection that an anthropologist with no physical limnology knowledge could not
have seen, and one that a physical limnologist with no interest in the fishers’ practical
knowledge could not have seen, either.
Of course this kind of tacit knowledge is always part of the way we do research,
whether it is in the natural sciences or in anthropology, across disciplines or not - a
point that was raised by Polanyi early on (1969). In my case, the approach of mapping
certain currents by drawing them with the fishers during the interview was clearly an
idea that emerged from my background in environmental science and my familiarity
with the outline of the Lake on paper and computer screens.
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
42
Some of the fishers found the exercise interesting, some were clearly uncomfortable
with it, preferring to show me the usual paths of their nets on the Lake from the boat or
the shore, or to talk about stories involving extraordinary nets paths and the names of
certain lake places. A fisherman from the older generation, for instance, refused to
participate at first in this mapping exercise, insisting for us to get out and have a look at
the Lake from the shore where he could ‘show’ me the pattern of the current he was
talking about – which was obvious for him based on the morphology of the shore.
That day, my socio-cultural sensitivity was not at its sharpest, maybe partly because the
scientist in me had already pictured the possibility of the study reported in Chapter 5
that was based on mapped information from the fishers. He got annoyed, repeating that
he did not understand why I wanted to draw something that I could see so well just from
the shore. In fact he could see what he was describing from the shore, but I could not, or
I could see it but not the information in it: my eye was educated to look at the Lake
vertically, not horizontally and from within the landscape, especially that particular lake
with its convoluted shores that, the first few days, seemed like a maze to me.
Revealingly, a few days after arriving in the field site I felt the need to hike up a
mountain in the north of the Lake. Looking down at the Lake and seeing its outline gave
me the comforting perspective I had been working with, indirectly, for years. This
experience and creation of the map made me reflect on my ethnographic practice. I
realised that I had been, in the words of Bourdieu:
unwittingly impos[ing] the scholastic viewpoint on [my informant], especially by [my] questions which incline[d] and encourage[d] them to adopt a theoretical viewpoint on their own practice (2000: 54).
It is unavoidable for a researcher to understand other people’s knowledge in their own
terms (for, even if these terms evolved, they would remain their own and distinct from
those of the people they work with), but it is possible to be cautiously reflexive about
how these translations are operated through the research and analysis process (West
2005), an issue I continue with below.
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
43
2.5.3 Translation: several voices in one
I encountered issues related to translation in different forms. First my mother tongue is
French, my PhD was conceptualised and written in English, and the socio-cultural
research was conducted in Italian – translation was thus an omnipresent issue
underlying my research. Just as relevant was the need, familiar to all anthropologists, to
translate day-to-day language and events into theoretical writing, and in my case the
need to translate concepts between fields and to operate shifts between scientific
English (e.g. Chapter 3) and the completely different English language familiar to
anthropologists (e.g. Chapter 6, and to some extent Chapters 1, 2, 7 and 8 that are
reflexive and were written last).
I could barely understand, and not speak, Italian when I started my PhD, and the first
time I went to Como as a scientist to conduct fieldwork in limnology with colleagues
from the research institute IRSA, our exchanges were in English. I tried taking Italian
classes upon my return at UWA, but gave up very quickly as these were designed for
native English speakers and the emphases were not really helpful for my Latin-language
background (I could speak Spanish and had learnt Latin for a few years at school). I
then picked an Italian grammar book at the library and looked at it from time to time, an
approach that seemes natural as the French educational system does (or at least did 10
years ago) strongly emphasise grammar as the entry point to learning languages,
somewhat revealing a view of languages as static, mechanistic systems of words and
rules. Mid-2009 I still had great difficulties having a conversation in Italian.
When I started planning a return to the Lake for ethnographic fieldwork in 2010, I
changed my approach and started listening to podcasts from the Italian National Radio,
every day in public transport on my way to University. While at first I understood
nothing – which was daunting – I persisted for a few weeks, and little by little things
started to make sense as I got used to the patterns and the flow of the language. After
three months, I was able to have long conversations in Italian, and this was also when
the grammatical foundations I had acquired through the book finally took all their sense,
as they became alive in my use of the language. While my Italian was clearly not that of
a native speaker, in the field I was able to conduct interviews and function socially in an
Italian setting – an ease that grew while I was there. Interestingly, for the argument that
follows, since I speak Italian fluently I cannot speak Spanish anymore without great
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
44
concentration and effort.
The reason why I provided so much detail on the way I let the Italian language become
a daily part of my thinking and acting (and somewhat dislodge another language from it,
at least superficially), is because I found it very similar to the way different academic
fields became part of my thinking. I remember reading an anthropology article at the
very beginning of my engagement with anthropology, and finding it quite unintelligible
despite great focus, highlighting and dictionary assistance (it was a text by Escobar). I
was used to the sort of English written in Chapter 3, but as I persisted and kept reading
texts written by anthropologists, philosophers and social scientists, more and more
things started to make sense and my writing took a turn more characteristic of these
fields. This was in the second half of my candidature, and now as I write the thesis’
introductory and discussion chapters, I find it quite difficult to write for scientists again,
such as I did in Chapter 3.
It will be clear to the reader that there is a tremendous change in the English language
used in Chapter 3 and that in Chapter 6. Each of these styles might flow for some
readers and put others off, seeming overly complicated or too dry. It is proving very
difficult for me to write about concepts of anthropology and limnology in a clear and
simple way that would be intelligible to scholars from both scholastic traditions. As
stated by Turnbull: ‘it is extremely difficult to move outside your own knowledge space
in the same way that it is extremely difficult to become as fluent in another language as
a native speaker’ (2003: 227). There is another great difficulty staying attuned, even in
part, to different knowledge spaces at the same time and to articulate a dialogue
between them because it involves an effort in shifting perspectives and making our way
through ‘epistemological bridges’ (Toussaint 2005) that are required, not just to
convince others in inter-disciplinary teamwork, but to convince ourselves in a personal
inter-disciplinary dialogue as well.
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
45
2.6 References
Anderson, L. 2006. Analytic autoethnography. Journal of Contemporary Ethnography.
35 (4):373-395
Bourdieu, P. 2000 [1997] Pascalian meditations. Stanford University Press: Stanford
Dettamanti, P. 2004. Viaggiatori stranieri nel territorio lecchese. In Perego, N. and M.
Pirovano (Eds.) – Patrimoni culturali, ricerce storiche, memorie collettive: Brianza e
Lecchese. Ricerche di Etnografia e Storia 11:183-196. Cattaneo: Oggiono (Lc) [Italian]
Fischer, H. B., E. G. List, R. C. Y. Koh, J. Imberger and N. H Brooks. 1979 Mixing in
Inland and coastal waters. Academic Press.
Gini, G. 2000. Centro Lago e altri racconti. Giorgio Fiocchi: Milano [Italian]
Goodwin, C. 1995. Seeing in depth. Social Studies of Science 25:237-274.
Hodges, B. R., J. Imberger, A. Saggio, and K. B. Winters. 2000. Modelling basin-scale
internal waves in a stratified lake. Limnology and Oceanography 45:1603-1620.
Ingold, T. 2008. Anthropology is not ethnography. Proceedings of the British Academy 154:69-92
Ingold, T., and E. Hallam. 2011. Creativity and cultural improvisation: an introduction.
In Hallam, E. and T. Ingold (Eds.) 2007. Creativity and cultural improvisation. Berg:
Oxford
Jolly, L. and L. Kavanagh. 2009. Working out and working in critical interdisciplinarity.
20th Australasian Association for Engineering Education Conference University of
Adelaide, 6-9 December 2009:709-714
Laborde, S., Antenucci, J., Copetti, D. and J. Imberger. 2010. Inflow intrusions at
multiple scales in a large temperate lake. Limnology and Oceanography 55(3):1301–
1312
Latour, B. 1990. Drawing things together. In Lynch, M. and Woolgar, S. (Eds),
Representation in scientific practice, MIT Press: Cambridge, Mass.
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
46
Latour, B. and S. Woolgar. 1986 [1979]. Laboratory Life: the construction of scientific
facts. Princeton University Press, c1986: Princeton, N.J
Lawrence, R. J. and C. Després. 2004. Introduction: Futures of transdisciplinarity
Futures 36:397–405
Monti, R. 1924. La limnologia del Lario in relazione al ripopolamento delle acque ed
alla pesca. Studi fati sotto la direzione della Prof. Rina Monti. Ministero dell’economia
nazionale. tipografia coop. ‘Luigi Luzzatti’: Roma [Italian]
OECD. 1972. Interdisciplinarity: problems of teaching and research in universities,
OECD: Paris
Orlove, B. and S. C. Caton. 2010. Water sustainability: Anthropological approaches and
prospects. Annual Review of Anthropology 39:401–15
Pensa, P. 1981. Noi gente del Lario. Pietro Cairoli Ed.: Como [Italian]
Pirovano, M. 1996. Pescatori di lago. Storia, lavoro, cultura sui laghi della Brianza e sul
Lario. Ricerche di etnografia e storia , Nr. 5: Cattaneo [Italian]
Pirovano, M. 2003. Vita da pescatori sulla costa sud-occidentale del Lario. Tesori di
Lombardia – Bellavite [Italian]
Polanyi, M. 1969. Knowing and being. University of Chicago Press: Chicago
Robinson J. 2008. Being undisciplined: Transgressions and intersections in academia
and beyond. Futures 40:70–86
Strathern, M. 2007. Experiments in interdisciplinarity. Social Anthropology 13(1):75-90
Stendhal. 1839. La Chartreuse de Parme, tome premier. Société belge de librairie -
Hauman et Cie: Bruxelles [French]
Toussaint, S. 2005. Building an epistemological bridge: Coeval integrated practice in
Studies of human/environmental relationships, Sustainable communities, sustainable
environments: potential dialogues between anthropologists, scientists and managers 21:
19-15: Melbourne
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
47
Tuan, Y-F. 1995 [1993]. Passing strange and wonderful: aesthetics, nature, and culture
Kodansha International: New York
Turnbull, D. 2003 [2000]. Masons, tricksters and cartographers: Comparative studies
in the sociology of scientific and indigenous knowledge. Routledge: London
West, P. 2005. Translation, value, and space: Theorising an ethnographic and engaged
environmental anthropology. American Anthropologist 107(4):632–642
CHAPTER 2. Methodologies
48
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
49
Chapter 3 Inflow intrusions at multiple scales in a large
temperate lake
S. Laborde, J. P. Antenucci, D. Copetti, and J. Imberger.
3.1 Abstract
Lake Como receives inflows of vastly varying scales. The majority of the Lake’s water
comes from the alpine inflows to the north, and much smaller inflows supply large
amounts of pollutants in the south. We combined various data sets with a three-
dimensional hydrodynamic model to investigate the processes affecting the fate of these
inflows with potential applications for management responses to both pollution and
climate change effects. During the stratified period inflow waters from the northern
alpine sources intrude in the metalimnion, undergo a deflection due to the Earth’s
rotation, and subsequently affect local flushing in a semi-closed embayment receiving
the shallower intrusions of the small, polluted inflows.
3.2 Introduction
Inflows to lakes and reservoirs have been shown to influence the vertical and horizontal
distribution of salinity (Dallimore et al. 2001), suspended solids (De Cesare et al. 2006),
inorganic pollutants (Morillo et al. 2008), and biochemical material such as nutrients,
dissolved oxygen, and biomass (Fischer and Smith 1983; Brookes et al. 2004; Botelho
and Imberger 2007). Large inflows, relative to the lake volume, may also influence, or
even dominate, the basin scale circulation (Carmack 1978; Killworth and Carmack
1979).
A river flowing into a lake penetrates the Lake basin until the river momentum is
balanced by the buoyancy force, whereupon one of the following regimes forms
(Simpson 1987): 1) if the inflowing water is less dense than the ambient water the river
water forms a surface buoyant plume; 2) if the inflowing river water is denser than the
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
50
surface ambient lake water, a plunge point forms and the river water underflows along
the river valley bottom, entraining ambient water as it goes, until it reaches a level of
neutral buoyancy; and 3) if the level of neutral buoyancy is deeper than the maximum
depth of the lake, the underflow will fill the Lake from the bottom up. On the other
hand, if the level of neutral buoyancy occurs at depth in the metalimnion or the
hypolimnion, an intrusion forms that propagates horizontally into the Lake (for a review
see Imberger and Patterson 1990). The effects of relative buoyancy, discharge and bed
roughness on these regimes have been documented in both the laboratory (Alavian
1986; Maxworthy et al. 2002; Fernandez and Imberger 2008a) and natural systems
(Hebbert et al. 1979; Ford and Johnson 1983; Alavian et al. 1992). Here we describe the
role of inflows in connecting regional and local flow paths within a large lake (Carmack
1978; Morillo et al. 2008).
To investigate the interflow process and water connectivity, field and numerical
experiments were conducted in Lake Como, which is located in the pre-alpine region of
Italy. Lake Como is large (50 km long), deep (425 m), narrow, and elongated, extending
in the north-south direction (Fig. 8).
Figure 8. Bathymetry of Lake Como
with depth contour lines of 100 m and
20 m for the main map and the zoomed
map around T1, respectively; locations
of measurement stations (Conductivity,
Temperature, Depth (CTD) transects
C1, C2, and F-Probe transects F1, F2).
Ai=Adda inflow, Ao=Adda outflow,
C=Cosia inflow, B=Breggia inflow,
M=Mera inflow
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
51
A seasonal thermocline develops in the Lake from mid-spring (Fig. 9 A) with the
increasing solar radiation and subsequent aggregation of diurnal thermoclines. The
seasonal thermocline then deepens to reach 40 m in late autumn as the surface cooling
and wind speeds progressively increase. The Adda and Mera Rivers contribute the
majority of water to the Lake (together 70% of the annual total inflow to the Lake
(Copetti and Salerno 2006)), and enter at the northern end (Fig. 8), with the peak flow
rate reaching 300 m3 s-1 during the summer months due to snowmelt (Fig. 9 D). A
number of smaller inflows enter the Lake at its southwestern arm after flowing through
urban areas: the Breggia River that enters the Lake three kilometres north of the city of
Como and the Cosia River that enters at the city of Como. These flows are much
smaller than the Adda (1- 3 m3 s-1), and have higher temperatures (Fig. 9 B), salinity
(Fig. 9 C), and nutrient concentrations (Copetti et al. 2008).
Figure 9. A) Annual stratification in
Lake Como in 2007: depths of 0.25
isotherms were averaged between T2
and T3, over a sliding window of 5
days. B) Temperature and C) salinity of
the Adda (A), Mera (M), Cosia (C),
and Breggia (B) Rivers, for the year
2006. Markers indicate measurements,
dotted lines are linear interpolations.
D) Daily Adda flow rate for the year
2007.
Due to the strong contrast between the large snowmelt supply in the north and the local
point source pollution in the south, Lake Como represents an excellent field site for the
study of the interaction of inflows of different magnitude and their influence on the
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
52
connectivity of water in different geographical locations in the Lake. The objective of
this study was therefore to describe 1) how inflows of different magnitudes are routed
through Lake Como, 2) how these flow paths interplay with wind driven dynamics, and
3) how these inflows influence local residence time in the southwestern end of the Lake,
which is a polluted area.
This paper is structured as follows: 1) we describe the field data and the process-based
hydrodynamic model used in the study; 2) we apply a scaling analysis to the data,
leading to insights and hypotheses on the circulation of riverine waters through the
Lake; 3) we use modelling to put the data sets in a dynamic context and confirm the
results of the scaling analysis; and 4) we discuss implications of the results for water
quality management in Lake Como and other sub-alpine lakes.
3.3 Methods
3.3.1 Field data
Meteorological data including wind speed and direction, relative humidity, air
temperature, short wave radiation, and net radiation were measured at two in-lake
stations located at the end of the southwestern (SW) and northern (N) arms, T1 and T2
(Fig. 8), respectively deployed since autumn 2004 (T1) and autumn 2006 (T2). Wind
speed and direction were also recorded at T3, located at the end of the southeastern (SE)
arm (Fig. 8). Water column temperature data were recorded, from the water surface to a
depth of 150 m, also from late 2006 until 2009 and at T1, T2, and T3 locations (Fig. 8).
Thermistors were distributed along the three chains with spacing increasing from 0.25
m near the surface to 20 m in the deep hypolimnion, and the sampling interval was 20 s.
This allowed a long term, fine resolution documentation of the Lake’s thermal structure
(e.g., Fig. 9 A). Historical records (older than 2006) for wind speed and direction, air
temperature, rainfall, and solar radiation were obtained through the regional Agency for
Environmental Protection (ARPA Lombardia).
All long-term information about temperature and salinity for the Adda, Mera, Cosia,
and Breggia Rivers consisted of instantaneous ‘spot’ measurements carried out every
month by ARPA in 2005 and 2006 (Fig. 9 B, C). From July 2007 onwards, temperature
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
53
data for the Cosia and Breggia Rivers were recorded every 10 minutes by gauges
installed by the Water Research Institute of the National Research Council (IRSA -
CNR). The daily flow rate of the Adda (Fig. 9 D) was provided by the Adda River
Consortium (Consorzio dell’Adda), as well as the bi-hourly measurements of stage of
the Adda at Colico.
In-lake salinity profiles were collected in the Como embayment in October 2006 with a
vertical resolution of approximately 1 cm (Morillo et al. 2009) (Fig. 8, transects F1 and
F2). Salinity data over a broader horizontal scale, covering the southwestern arm, were
collected in October 2007 with a vertical resolution of 50 cm (Copetti et al. 2008): (Fig.
8 transects C1 and C2). Finally, satellite images of the northern part of Lake Como
taken during a turbid flood event provided additional information about spatial
heterogeneity in the Lake and the flow path of the northern inflows (TerraMetrics).
3.3.2 Scaling analysis
Inflow behavior was calculated for the Adda, Mera, Breggia, and Cosia Rivers using the
algorithms developed by Dallimore et al. (2001); these allowed determination of the
entrainment in the downflow phase and the insertion depth based on properties of the
inflows, water column, and lake bed. Bottom slope angles were estimated at 1, 1, 7, and
14 degrees from the 5 x 5 m bathymetry of the Lake, respectively for the Adda, Mera,
Cosia, and Breggia thalwegs. The bottom drag coefficient was set to 0.005 based on a
study from Vezzoli and Facchinetti (2006), who found a combination of 80% silt - 10%
clay - 10% sand for Lake Como’s sediment bed.
The effect of the strong northerly winds, causing upwelling and a changing stratification
was parameterised by calculating the Wedderburn number (Thompson and Imberger
1980):
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
54
W =g'h2
u*2L
Eq. 1
where 'g represents the reduced gravity between the two layers and equals0ρρ∆g , h is
the depth of the interface defined as the depth of maximum buoyancy frequency
obtained after averaging the depth of each 0.1ºC isotherm (from 6 ºC to 30ºC) spatially
over the three thermistor chains and temporally for the period considered, *u is the
surface shear velocity of the water and L is the fetch length. The influence of bottom
slopes on W was negligible because the Lake is very long, deep, and steep sided. This
justified a simple formulation of W with an average h. W may be interpreted as the ratio
of the baroclinic to wind forces; W < 1 indicates that the surface stress force prevails
and therefore upwelling is likely (Stevens and Lawrence 1997).
The river intrusion speed for the Adda plume was calculated by cross-correlating the
stage of the Adda River with the temperature at T2 at the depth of the inflow; this time
lag was then divided into the distance travelled to yield the intrusion speed. We
compared this intrusion velocity scale with analytical values yielded by two different
arguments:
U ~ NH he
Eq. 2
where NH is the buoyancy frequency at the depth of the intrusion and he is the intrusion
thickness;
U ~ Qig'd
1/ 3
Eq. 3
where Qi is the intrusion mass influx, 'g is the relative gravity of the plume with regards
to the ambient water, and d is a width length scale for the basin (Killworth and Carmack
1979).
We estimated the influence of the Earth rotation on the flow path of the northern
intrusion by calculating the Rossby number of the intrusion:
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
55
R0 = Ufd
Eq. 4
where U is the velocity scale of the flow, f is the Coriolis parameter at 46o N and d is the
typical width of the northern arm of the Lake. R0 < 1 indicates a significant contribution
of the Earth’s rotation to the motion (Gill 1982).
Throughout the study, we refer to the depth of maximum buoyancy frequency (Nmax) as
the thermocline, and to the intermediate layer of large density gradients encompassing
the thermocline as the metalimnion. The upper limit of the metalimnion is the base of
the surface mixed layer, defined here as the depth at which the temperature was 0.2°C
less than the surface temperature, which corresponded for an autumnal stratification in
Lake Como to an approximate buoyancy frequency threshold of 0.01 rad.s-1. We
represent these concepts graphically by plotting the corresponding isotherms.
3.3.3 Numerical model
To complement the scaling analysis, the finite difference Estuary Lake and Coastal
Ocean Model (ELCOM) was applied to Lake Como. ELCOM solves the Reynolds-
averaged Navier-Stokes equations and scalar transport equations with the hydrostatic
and Boussinesq approximations to simulate the velocity, temperature and salinity fields
of the three-dimensional (3D) domain in space and time. Hodges et al. (2000) provide a
detailed description of the model structure and numerical algorithms.
The model was previously used in Lake Como by Morillo et al. (2009). Due to the
different focus of this investigation, the grid was modified to give a horizontal
resolution of 20 x 200 m with the finest resolution in the Cosia embayment, and a
vertical grid ranging from 0.5 to 50 m, with the finest resolution in the surface and
thermocline regions and the coarsest resolution in the deep hypolimnion.
The performance of the model was quantified using the modelling error measures
defined by Rueda and Schladow (2003), I1, I2 norms and root mean square error
(RMSE), as:
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
56
I1 =Fn − Snn=1
Nmax∑Snn=1
Nmax∑ Eq. 5
I2 =(Fn − Sn )2
n=1
Nmax∑Sn( )2
n=1
Nmax∑ Eq. 6
RMSE =(Fn − Sn )2
n=1
Nmax∑Nmax
Eq. 7
where Fn are temperatures measured in the field, Sn the corresponding simulated
temperatures and Nmax is the number of values compared. These three error measures
allowed a comparison of the model performance with other 3D modelling studies
published in the literature (Rueda and Schladow 2003; Morillo et al. 2009).
3.4 Results
3.4.1 Field data
3.4.1.1 Inflow regimes and fate of small inflows
Salinity data from the two autumn surveys showed distinctive horizontal gradients and
vertical layering both along and across the north-southwest axis of the basin (Fig. 10 F1,
F2, C1, C2). The saline intrusion at the southwestern end was from the Cosia River
(Fig. 10 F1, F2) (Morillo et al. 2009). Copetti et al. (2008) identified the fresh intrusion
at the northern end as originating from the Adda and Mera Rivers (Fig. 10 C1), and the
saline intrusion west of transect C2 as the Breggia River inflow (Fig. 10 C2).
At the beginning of October 2006, the Cosia intruded at a depth of ~10 m (Fig. 10 F1,
F2), this depth corresponding to the base of the surface layer. In October 2007, the
signature of the Breggia was most intense at ~15 m (Fig. 10 C2), which was also the
base of the surface layer at that period. The Adda-Mera plume intruded between 15 and
25 m, just above the depth of the seasonal thermocline (Nmax = 0.034 rad s-1) that was
located at 25 m at the date of the profiles (16 October 2007; Fig. 10 C1, C2).
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
57
We calculated expected intrusion depths for the Cosia, Breggia, Adda, and Mera at
times corresponding to the two field experiments, based on typical characteristics for
these inflows (Fig. 9 B, C) and accounting for entrainment during the downflow phase
(Dallimore et al. 2001). This yielded 10.1 m, 16.2 m, 26.5 m, and 21.6 m, respectively,
confirming the riverine origin of the saline and fresh intrusions captured by the two data
sets (Fig. 10).
Figure 10: In-lake salinity data corresponding to autumnal transects F1, F2 (October 2006), C1 and C2
(October 2007). Dashed vertical lines indicate the profiles locations; values are linearly interpolated
between profiles.
To understand the seasonal variation of the intrusion dynamics we split the year into
winter (W), early spring (ES), late spring (LS), summer (S), early autumn (EA), and late
autumn (LA) on the basis of previous studies of the dynamics of temperate lakes
(Carmack et al. 1986). The results showed three salient features. First, all four inflows
formed mid-level intrusions during most of the year (Fig. 11). Second, the southern
inflows, on average warmer than the northern alpine inflows (Fig. 9 B), generally
inserted at shallower depths (Fig. 11). Third, there was a strong correlation between the
depth of the thermocline, and the plumes insertion depths (Fig. 11).
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
58
Figure 11: Average seasonal water column temperature and inflows depths of intrusion. Depths of
isotherms 0.1ºC apart were averaged to obtain seasonal profiles at T1 (black line) and T2 (grey line); W
(winter), ES (early spring), and LS (late spring) are data from 2007 and S (summer), EA (early autumn),
and LA (late autumn) from 2008 because of gaps in data. T2 profiles (N) were used to compute the
regimes of the Adda and Mera Rivers, and T1 profiles (SW) were used for the Cosia and Breggia Rivers.
Dashed lines: Adda (black) and Mera (grey); dotted lines: Cosia (black) and Bregga (grey).
As the Cosia and Breggia Rivers intrude in the surface layer for most of the year, these
inflows are regularly mixed up by wind events. Morillo et al. (2009) document an
episode of mixing and redistribution of the Cosia River waters from a depth of 10 m up
into the surface layer, subsequent to a northerly wind event with speeds of 10 m s-1.
3.4.1.2 Fate of large alpine inflows: interplay with upwelling and unsteadiness
Lake Como is stratified for most of the year (Fig. 9 A), and therefore internal waves
propagate in the metalimnion as a result of wind forcing. The internal wave regime is
relevant to the flow paths of the alpine inflows because we established that they intrude
at or near the thermocline depth. In this long and narrow basin the vertical mode 1
internal seiche appears most prominent in the temperature records, with the southern
branches in phase (Fig. 12 T1, T3), together in antiphase with the northern branch (Fig.
12 T2).
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
59
Figure 12. Thermal structure of the
water column at stations T2 (N), T1
(SW), and T3 (SE) over the summer
2008. Data points are separated by 4.5
hours. Arrows on top panel indicate
major upwelling events referred to in
the text.
On examining the Adda-Mera intrusions as evidenced in the temperature records
measured at T2, it was noticed that the internal oscillations heaved the inflows up and
down. Therefore, a spectral analysis was used to isolate the dominant period Ti (Table
1) and this was removed by low pass filtering the isotherm depths. The filtered isotherm
displacements at T2 (N, see location in Fig. 8) were then compared to those filtered
records at T1 (SW: Fig. 13 A), and T3 (SE: Fig. 13 B). These north-south gradients of
water column temperature (Fig. 13 A, B) showed a distinct seasonal variability and a
clear correspondence with the depth of the seasonal thermocline (Figs. 9, 11 A, B),
which was also the depth of intrusion of the northern inflows (Fig. 11).
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
60
Table 1. Fundamental seiche period for each season computed with the two-layer case formula and
evaluated using power spectra of isotherm displacements. Data correspond to 2007 measurements for W,
ES, and LS, and 2008 for S, EA, and LA.
Interface depth (m) and Ti (days) W ES LS S EA LA
Interface depth (m) 44.5 13.25 13.5 10.25 23 34
Ti, two-layer case (days) 9.1 7.9 4.7 4.2 3 2.8
Ti, spectra (days) 8 7.4 4.8 4.7 4.4 4.6
In winter, the riverine layer was not very prominent as this corresponded to the smallest
inflow rates of the Adda and Mera (Fig. 9 D). The intrusion was located at an
approximate depth of 50 m and was about 1 degree colder at the northern thermistor
chain than at each of the southern stations (Fig. 13 A: W). In early spring the rivers
warmed faster than the Lake and a layer of warmer water could be observed in the north
(negative
∆T) from 50 m to the surface as the river water progressively warmed (Fig. 13
A: ES and see point (a) in Fig. 13 B). With the approach of summer the surface waters
of Lake Como rapidly warmed, a seasonal thermocline developed (Fig. 9 A) and the
river inflows intruded at a depth of 10 m in summer (Fig. 13 A: S and see point (b) in
Fig. 13 B) and reaching 30 to 40 m in late autumn (Fig. 13 A: LA and see point (c) in
Fig. 13 B).
Figure 13. Differences between
temperatures (ºC) measured at two T-
chain locations after filtering by the
fundamental seiche period Ti for each
season. A) Differences between
southwestern (T1) and northern (T2)
stations. B) Differences between
southeastern (T3) and northern (T2)
stations. White bands are gaps in data.
Black lines indicate seasonal split: W,
ES, LS 2007 and S, EA, LA 2008. (a),
(b) and (c) are referred to in the text.
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
61
Fig. 13 shows evidence of pulses of colder water at the northern intrusion depth in
summer (Fig. 13 A: S and see point (b) in Fig. 13 B). They had a periodicity of
approximately 9 days and were preceded by storm events with heavy rainfall and strong
northerly winds. To understand the connection between the storm events and the cold
water pulses, the data from summer 2008 were used to calculate a time series of the
Wedderburn number. Because the basin is narrow and the winds were channelised by
the surrounding hills (Fig. 14), only winds with a northerly component may be expected
to induce large displacements of the interface in the north, and this was particularly true
for the three peaks in the wind speed marked as a, b, c in Fig. 15 A (black line)
corresponding to northeasterly events.
Figure 14. All wind speeds and
directions for the year 2007, at the
three stations. Shading represent
the wind speed in m s-1, and the
length of the 10 degrees bins
represents the probability of
occurrence of the respective
direction.
The major peaks in the temperature anomaly (Fig. 15 B peaks 2, 3, 5) resulted from
strong upwelling, with W<1 and high river flow rate for peaks 2 and 5. The three
upwelling events (marked as 2, 3 and 5 in Fig. 15 B) may also be reflected in the
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
62
isotherm contours shown in the top panel in Fig. 12 (T2). The downwelling resulting
from these wind events at the southern stations is seen in the middle and bottom panels
of Fig 12 (T1 and T3).
Figure 15. A) Wind speed at T2 (UT2:
black line) filtered over Ti/4 (Stevens and
Lawrence 1997) and stage of the Adda
River near the mouth (H*, detrended: grey
line). B) Log plot of the Wedderburn
number (W: black solid line) computed
with average characteristics of the water
column (g’=0.016 and h=10) and UT2; and
temperature anomaly between T1 and T2
at 10 m after filtering by Ti (ΔT: black
dotted line). Triangles mark events
referred to in the text.
The anomalies, marked by 1, 4, and 6 in Fig. 15 B, occurred during calm conditions and
were thus independent of upwelling events; they had their origin in inflow peaks as
shown in Fig. 15 A (grey line). There was a time lag between the inflow peaks and the
anomalies: a cross-correlation analysis between the stage of the Adda and the
temperature anomaly at the depth of the intrusion (correlation coefficient: 0.85) yielded
a phase lag of 10 hours implying an intrusion speed of 0.11 m s-1, which compares well
to the theoretical scale values computed with average lake and intrusion variables for
summer 2008 (Table 2).
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
63
Table 2: Velocity scales for the northern plume in summer 2008 as estimated using Eqs. 2, 3 and as
inferred from field data.
3.4.1.3 Effect of the Earth rotation: deflection and instabilities
Using Eq. 4 with the above determined intrusion speed and a typical width of 1700 m
for the northern arm of the basin, we obtained a Rossby number of 0.62 for the
buoyancy-driven flow. R0 < 1 and therefore the Adda-Mera inflow is expected to be
deflected towards the western bank of the Lake. Similar deflections were identified by
Hamblin and Carmack (1978) for the Thompson River inflow in Kamloops Lake and by
Serruya (1974) for the Jordan River in Lake Kinneret.
Satellite imagery documents a turbid flood event that occurred in summer 2001 (Fig. 16
A); it confirms that the waters originating from the Adda and Mera Rivers (high
turbidity waters, appearing clearer on the image) flowed as a boundary current along the
western shore of the Lake. Inflows in a rotating basin were investigated in the
laboratory by Griffiths and Linden (1981) who showed that buoyant overflows or
submerged intrusions are inherently unstable as revealed in this case by the eddy in the
lower left of Fig 16 A. The morphometry of the basin may have acted as a trigger for
this instability, which then developed drawing both on kinetic energy from the
horizontal shear and potential energy from the stratification (Gill 1982). Its diameter
relative to the Lake width scale d should scale with R0 (Griffiths and Linden 1981;
Summer 2008
Variables Velocity scale
Eq. 2 NH = 0.03 rad s-1 he = 5 m 0.15 m s-1
Eq. 3
Qi = 200 m3 s-1 g’= 6.1 x 10-3 m s-2
d = 1700 m 0.09 m s-1
Field estimate T = 36,000 s L = 4000 m 0.11 m s-1
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
64
Killworth 1980), which is consistent with the size of the vortex on Fig. 16 A. Such
structures are similar to those observed on the continental shelves of oceans after
episodes of differential cooling (Maxworthy 1997). They have been documented in
Lake Superior (Chen et al. 2002) and Lake Biwa (Akimoto et al. 2004), however, in
both cases the buoyancy fluxes inducing the vortices originated from surface exchanges
and, as far as we are aware, their occurrence on the edge of riverine currents in lakes has
not been studied.
Figure 16: A) satellite image of the northern arm of Lake Como; summer 2001 (reproduced with
permission - Copyright 2009 TerraMetrics). B) Model reproduction of the phenomena: velocity vectors at
10 m depth. ‘Ar’ and ’Mr’, respectively indicate the Adda and Mera Rivers.
3.5 Numerical Modelling
3.5.1 Validation
The model was validated for the two field experiments conducted during the following
periods: 24 September 2006 to 06 October 2006 included and 30 September 2007 to 16
October 2007 included. We validated the thermal structure against the temperature
records at the thermistor-chains. Salinity was used as a conservative tracer to further
validate the flow paths of the intrusions; its contribution to density was small compared
to that of temperature. The southern inflows (Cosia and Breggia) were saltier than the
Lake (Fig. 10 F1, F2, C2), and the northern inflows (Adda and Mera) were fresher (Fig.
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
65
10 C1, C2). For both validation periods, the model was started from rest, with
horizontal free surface and isopycnals, a horizontal temperature structure obtained by
averaging the isotherm depths from the available profiles measured at the thermistor-
chains locations and a uniform salinity of 0.1 g L-1. The inflows salinities were set from
the data reported on Fig. 9 C.
Wind forcing on the Lake’s surface was modelled by spatially variable wind fields
constructed from data at the three stations (T1, T2, T3) and the nautical map of Lake
Como (Istituto geografico de Agostini 1983) that provide a description of the main
winds and show that their directions between the three stations are constrained by the
shape of the basin. Wind speeds in each branch were as recorded at the corresponding
station in the branch (Fig. 14) and wind directions were oriented along the different axes
of the basin.
The period corresponding to the fine scale measurements of the Cosia River intrusion
was previously modeled by Morillo et al. (2009). The model response to the wind stress
was improved by applying a neutral wind drag coefficient of 1.5 x 10-3, which was
corrected at each time step to account for atmospheric stability (Imberger and Patterson
1990).
Fig. 17 shows time series of isotherm displacements as measured (Fig. 17 A) and
simulated (Fig. 17 B) at the station T2 from 30 September to 16 October 2007, the latest
date corresponding to the series of profiles documenting the Adda – Mera intrusion
(Fig. 10 C1, C2).
The difficulties to reproduce the motion in the first week was due to large internal
waves during the two weeks preceding the period simulated; the model, started from
rest, needed a week to adjust to the motion (Fig. 17 C). Later discrepancies in the
amplitude and phase of modelled interfacial displacement (Fig. 17 C) were attributed to
the imperfection of the interpolated wind field. Wind data were available only at the end
of the three arms of the Lake (Fig. 14), some 40 km apart and in different topographic
canyons. Despite the improvement made by aligning the wind directions with the
canyons, wind momentum may not be fully captured when such complex wind fields
are only measured at few discrete locations (Z. Zhang unpubl.).
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
66
Figure 17. A) water column
temperature as measured by T2 sub
sampled every hour; B) as simulated by
ELCOM, plotted every hour. Isotherm
spacing is 1oC. Black isotherm is 13oC
and represents the thermocline. C)
Time series of 13oC isotherm depth as
measured in the field (black) and
simulated by ELCOM (grey).
The results were good, despite some difficulties related with initial conditions or
complexity of the wind field. The error analysis is given in Table 3. It was conducted
over data points measured and simulated at the thermistors depths, down to 50 m and
distributed every hour through the simulated period. These results are comparable with
other numerical modelling studies (Rueda and Schladow 2003) and with the results
obtained by Morillo et al. (2009) (RMSE = 0.901, I1 = 0.034, I2 = 0.054)
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
67
Table 3: Root mean square error, I1 and I2 norms of the thermal structure of the water column, as
measured and simulated. The analysis covers the whole simulation period from 30 September to 16
October 2007 included.
T2 T3
Data points 5698 3663
RMSE 0.807 0.702
I1 0.056 0.057
I2 0.064 0.062
The depths of the intrusions were correctly reproduced by the model (Fig. 18 F1, F2,
C1, C2 to compare with the field data in Fig. 10 F1, F2, C1, C2), both for southern and
northern inflows. The model also captured the latitudinal displacement of the Cosia
waters towards the right of the basin (Fig. 18 F1, 12 B, D). Despite an underestimation
of the volume of the intrusions due to the start from rest with uniform salinity, these
results represent a good validation of the flow paths for two distinct periods, local and
regional intrusions scales, both along and across the axis of the basin.
Figure 18: Simulated salinity field corresponding to transects F1, F2, C1, and C2. Dashed lines indicate
the profiles locations; values are linearly interpolated between profiles. Corresponding field profiles are in
Fig. 10.
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
68
3.5.2 Fate of large inflows- intrusion, deflection, instability
To gain a three dimensional understanding of the flow paths, we plotted the averaged
north-south velocities across two west-east transects (Fig. 19 transects A and B) for the
last four days of the 2007 validation period (12 October 2007 to 16 October 2007). This
long spin-up time was to allow the northern inflows to reach the output points. Results
show a southward current dominating in the upper metalimnion for both transects, with
stronger velocities along the western shore of the Lake (Fig. 19 A, C). Numerical tracers
injected as passive scalars into the Adda and Mera inflows confirmed that this
southward current corresponded to the northern intrusion, confined in the upper
metalimnion by the stratification (Fig. 19 B, D: black contours; the Mera is not shown
here). These results verified the findings from the field observations and the scaling
analysis: northern inflows formed an intruding plume travelling south in the upper
metalimnion, mostly along the western shore of the basin. Numerical experiments
conducted by successively ignoring Coriolis and the wind stress in the computation
showed that this deflection was due to the Earth rotation combined with bathymetric
effects (not shown here).
Figure 19: Left panel: location of transects A and B on the map of Lake Como. (A) north-south
component of the velocity for transect A (positive towards south), base of the surface layer (thin dashed
white line) and thermocline (thick dashed white line). (B) Same as A for transect B. (C) Contours of the
tracer from the Cosia River (grey) and Adda River (black) for transect A. (D) Same as (C) for transect B.
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
69
Eddies similar to those observed by the satellite (Fig. 16 A) developed along the Adda-
Mera plume for both validation periods, at the depth of the northern intrusions. The
model was set-up in average summer conditions (Fig. 17, profiles ‘S’) ignoring surface
stress and surface heat fluxes in order to isolate the effect of the Earth rotation
combined with the morphometry of the basin. The main instability that appeared in the
satellite image (Fig. 16 A) was reproduced numerically; first the plume was deflected by
the Coriolis force along the western boundary of the Lake and second the horizontal
shear along the edge of the current fed an instability resulting in the vortex structure
(Fig. 16 B).
3.5.3 Fate of small inflows – intrusion, deflection, vertical mixing
Results showed a stronger concentration of the Cosia and Breggia tracers in the surface
layer and along the eastern shore of the arm (Fig. 19 B, D, grey contours; Breggia is not
shown here). This corresponded to a northward current across both transects, travelling
at the base of the surface layer (Fig. 19 A, C). Numerical results showed that the
deflection towards the east was due to the Earth rotation combined with bathymetric
effects (not shown here). As inferred from the field observations and the scaling
analysis, the relative buoyancy of the Breggia and Cosia plumes on the one hand and the
Earth rotation on the other, result in a main flow path that is clearly distinct from that of
the northern inflows, both vertically (shallower) and laterally (towards the east) (Fig. 19
B, D).
Internal wave motions affected these surface layer intrusions. Northerly winds blowing
during 11 October and 12 October 2007 set-up an internal seiche with a period of
approximately 4 days, and an amplitude of 7 m (Fig. 17 A, C). On 13 October 2007, the
interface was tilted up in the north (upwind; Fig. 17 A) and down in the south
(downwind; Fig. 20 A, isotherm 13); and the Cosia and Breggia waters formed an
interflow at a depth of 15 m corresponding to the base of surface layer (Fig. 20 A,
isotherm 15). Two days (~Ti/2) later on 15 October 2007, the interface was tilted up at
the southwestern end and the Cosia and Breggia waters appeared mixed up into the
surface layer and out toward the north (Fig. 20 B). Along the transect shown on Fig. 20,
and within the first 3 km from Como (up to the transect B on Fig. 19), 28% of the total
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
70
mass of tracer from the Cosia and Breggia Rivers was contained within the first 5 m of
the water column on 13 October (downwelling; Fig. 20 A), against 61% on 15 October
(upwelling; Fig. 20 B). The northern intrusion (Fig. 20 A, B, black contours) was
initially concentrated into the upper metalimnion (Fig. 20 A), and as the isotherms
relaxed upwards it penetrated further into the embayment and mixed up into the surface
layer (Fig. 20 B).
Figure 20. Longitudinal transects along
the Cosia intrusion, from Como up to 6
km into the southwestern arm and as
simulated by the model. Isotherm 15
(dashed white line) represents the base of
surface layer. isotherm 13 (dashed white
line) represents the thermocline.
Shadings are Cosia and Breggia tracer
concentration in log scale (log10 [TR]).
Black contours are Adda tracer
concentrations in log scale.A)
Downwelling and B) upwelling are apart
in time of Ti/2. Tracers were initialised at
1 in both rivers.
3.6 Discussion
3.6.1 Intrusions interactions; effect on local flushing
This study contributes to the understanding of the fate of catchment material of different
origins in Lake Como, with a focus on autumnal conditions. An important question for
management applications is whether the northward epilimnetic current and the regional
southward metalimnetic current identified (Fig. 19) are related, as this would suggest
that any local modification of the flow paths could have regional consequences.
We evaluated the fluxes of numerical tracers through the sections A and B (locations
shown in Fig. 19) under two different scenarios of alpine inflows for the 2007 validation
period. The first scenario used the measured inflow (base case, described previously);
whereas a second scenario assumed no inflows coming from the north. The outflow for
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
71
the second scenario was adjusted to balance the manipulated inflow. The two
simulations were identical in every regard apart from the presence or not of the northern
inflows, and the magnitude of the corresponding outflow. The conservative tracers were
injected as passive scalars respectively in the Cosia and the Adda Rivers, starting on 04
October 2007 and with a concentration of 1 kg m-3 for the two scenarios.
For each transect (A, B), we evaluated the fluxes of tracers through each cell at each
time step (tracer concentration in cell (kg m-3) x N-S component of the velocity in cell
(both transects are oriented E-W) (m s-1) x vertical section of cell (m2)); then aggregated
all transect cells and accumulated with time to obtain the total mass of tracer advected
through each transect, at each time step. These are compared in Fig. 21 B, C. The results
showed that, for the period simulated, the presence of the northern intrusions promoted
the flushing of the Cosia River waters out of the southwestern arm (Fig. 21 C) and to a
lesser extent out of the Como embayment (Fig. 21 B). At the end of the simulation (end
of 16 October 2007), the total mass of Cosia tracer flushed out of the southwestern arm
was 74% smaller in the ‘no northern inflows’ scenario than in the base case. This was 7
days after the northern intrusion had significantly penetrated into the southwestern arm
in the base case (Fig. 21 C, grey line). It was 19% smaller at the local scale of the Como
embayment, 3 days after a significant penetration of the northern intrusion into the
domain in the base case (Fig. 21 B). The divergence between the results of the two
scenarios was more and more marked as the northern intrusion penetrated into the
embayment (Fig. 21 C, grey line).
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
72
Figure 21. A) Wind speed (grey line)
and direction (black dots) at T1. B)
Cumulative mass of Adda tracer (TRA,
grey) and Cosia tracer (TRC, black)
across the transect B (see location on
map Fig. 19). C) Same as B) across
transect A (see location on map Fig.
19). B) and C) are numerical results.
Tracers were initialised at 1 in both
rivers. Plain lines represent the base
case; dotted lines represent the
numerical scenario (no northern
inflows).
Another salient feature was the influence of internal seiching on the exchange fluxes.
On 13 October 2007 the flushing of the Cosia out of the Como embayment was slowed
down and reached a minimum as the winds pushed the surface layer back towards the
southwest (Fig. 21 B, grey arrow; see also Fig. 20 A). This minimum affected first the
shallow southern intrusion (Fig. 21 B, grey arrow) and subsequently the deeper northern
intrusion as the pressure gradient built up at the southwestern end of the Lake (Fig. 21
C, grey arrow). As the isotherms relaxed, the exchange started again to reach a local
maximum on 15 October 2007 (Fig. 21 B, C; see also Fig. 20 B).
3.6.2 Applications
This numerical experiment showed that, for the period studied in autumn 2007, the
alpine intrusions to Lake Como promoted flushing of the southwestern arm and of the
semi-enclosed Como embayment. This result is important for water quality management
because it indicates that fluxes of polluted material out of the Como embayment and
arm will fluctuate with the properties of the northern inflows. These were shown to vary
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
73
seasonally (Fig. 17) and synoptically (Fig. 19). We also established the effect of wind-
driven internal motions on the flushing of the Como embayment, with periods ranging
from 2 to 4 days in stratified conditions.
The understanding of these time scales dependencies may allow a more effective
operation of an in-lake remediation technology such as that proposed by Morillo et al.
(2009), designed to alter the flow path of the Cosia River intrusion. Some relevant
processes remain to be studied, including for instance, the influence of the unsteady
flow rate and density of inflows on the dynamics described in this paper. This question
is potentially important in systems like Lake Como where inflows are very responsive
to rainfall and undergo sudden changes in flow rate on the one hand, and can vary in
density due to industrial discharges on the other (for the southern inflows). Future
research on this topic could build on the laboratory work carried out by Fernandez and
Imberger (2008b). Likewise, the seasonal variability of this process, including its
ecological consequences, deserves further study. Finally, the effects of baroclinic
instabilities on horizontal mixing in lakes also provide an opportunity for more research.
This process would be of major importance for the distribution of catchment material
across the axis of narrow basins like Lake Como, where the wind is channelised by the
surrounding topography (Fig. 20), the internal response to the surface stress is mostly
longitudinal (Fig. 18), and the northern plumes intrude in the metalimnion for most of
the year (Fig. 17).
3.6.3 Regional context
In the current context of climatic change, inflows of the southern Alps are
expected to undergo a significant decrease of mean annual discharge, particularly
an important decrease in summer and autumn flow rates (Horton et al. 2006). This
will affect the internal dynamics of Lake Como, and particularly the flushing of
the western arm during the stratified period. This may result in a longer residence
time in this arm for the polluted waters of the southern inflows, with potentially
consequences like algae blooms.
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
74
Finally, the findings of this study are relevant for other lakes. In the subalpine region
alone, all major lakes are supplied by alpine inflows and the dynamics described in this
paper may also apply to these systems (Lake Maggiore and the Ticino and Maggia
Rivers; Lake Lugano and the Cassarate River; Lake Iseo and the Oglio River; Lake
Garda and the Sarca River).
3.7 Acknowledgements
We thank Ryan Alexander, Sebastian Morillo, and Patricia Okely for constructive
discussions and comments during the study; and Alberto de la Fuente and Arnoldo
Valle-Levinson for critically reviewing the manuscript. The first author acknowledges
the financial support from the International Postgraduate Research Scholarship funded
by the Australian Government through the Department of Innovation, Industry, Science,
and Research, as well as the support of the Water Corporation of Western Australia and
CWR that provided a living allowance scholarship. This work was conducted in
conjunction with Consiglio Nazionale delle Ricerche - Istituto di Ricerca Sulle Acque
(CNR - IRSA) in Brugherio and we thank G. Tartari, N. Guyennon, and L. Valsecchi
for data collection. Data have been provided with the support of the West Arm
Exchange Enhancement System Project Stage 1 funded by Como Province, Como Town
Council, Como Chamber of Commerce, Cariplo Foundation, Banca Intesa - San Paolo
and Pliniana (Gruppo Petrolifera Italo Rumena), and coordinated by Centro di Cultura
Scientifica ‘A. Volta’. We also thank two anonymous reviewers whose comments
significantly improved the manuscript. This article forms Centre for Water Research
reference 2274 SL.
3.8 References
Akimoto, K., M. Kugori, and M. Kumagai. 2004. Numerical study of a thermally
induced gyre system in Lake Biwa. Limnology 5: 103-114.
Alavian, V. 1986. Behaviour of density currents on an incline. Journal of Hydraulic
Engineering 112: 27-42.
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
75
Alavian, V., G. H. Jirka, R. A. Denton, M. C. Johnson, and H. G. Stefan. 1992. Density
currents entering lakes and reservoirs. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering118: 1464-
1489.
Bothelo, D. A., and J. Imberger. 2007. Dissolved oxygen response to wind-inflow
interactions in a stratified reservoir. Limnology and Oceanography 52: 2027-2052.
Brookes, J. D., J. P. Antenucci, M. Hipsey, M. D. Burch, N. J. Ashbolt, and C.
Ferguson. 2004. Fate and transport of pathogens in lakes and reservoirs. Environment
International 30: 741-759.
Carmack, E. 1978. Combined influence of inflow and lake temperatures on spring
circulation in a riverine lake. Journal of Physical Oceanography 9: 442-434.
Carmack, E., R. C. Wiegand, R. J. Daley, C. B. Gray, S. Jasper, and C. H. Pharo.
1986. Mechanisms influencing the circulation and distribution of water mass in a
medium residence time lake. Limnology and Oceanography 31: 249-265.
Chen, C., J. Zhu, K. Y. Kang, H. D. Liu, E. Ralph, S. A. Green, and J. W. Budd.
2002. Cross-frontal transport along the Keweenaw coast in Lake Superior. Dynamics of
Atmospheres and Oceans 36: 83-102.
Copetti, D., N. Guyennon, L. Valsecchi, G. Tartari, J. Imberger, and J. P. Antenucci.
2008. Western arm exchange enhancement project. Centro Volta Como. Final Report I.
Copetti, D., and N. Salerno. 2006. Meteorology, hydrology and lake hydrodynamics, in
Centro Volta, Como. Rehabilitation of the water quality in Lake Como. Gruppo di
Lavoro Lago di Como. PLINIUS project. [In Italian]
Dallimore, C., J. Imberger, and T. Ishikawa. 2001. Entrainment and turbulence in saline
underflow in Lake Ogawara. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering 127: 937-948.
De Cesare, G., J-L. Boilat, and A. J. Schleiss. 2006. Circulation in stratified lakes due to
flood-induced turbidity currents. Journal of Environmental Engineering 132: 1508-
1517.
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
76
Fernandez, R. L., and J. Imberger. 2008a. Relative buoyancy dominates thermal-like
flow interaction along an incline. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering 134: 636-643.
Fernandez, R. L., and J. Imberger. 2008b. Time varying underflow into a continuous
stratification with bottom slope Journal of Hydraulic Engineering 134: 1191-1198.
Fischer, H. B., and R. D. Smith. 1983. Observations of transport to surface waters from
a plunging inflow to Lake Mead. Limnology and Oceanography 28: 258-272.
Ford, D. E., and M. C. Johnson. 1983. An assessment of reservoir density currents and
inflow processes. US Army Eng. Waterway Experiment stations. Technical Report E-
83-7.
Gill, A. E. 1982. Atmosphere – Ocean dynamics. International Geophysics Series, vol.
30. Academic.
Griffiths, R., and P. F. Linden. 1981. The stability of vortices in a rotating, stratified
fluid. Journal of Fluid Mechanics. 105: 283-316.
Hamblin, P., and P. E. Carmack. 1978. River-induced currents in a fjord lake. Journal of
Geophysical Research. 83: 885-899.
Hebbert, B., J. Patterson, I. Loh, and J. Imberger. 1979. Collie River underflow into the
Wellington Reservoir. Journal of the Hydraulics Division - ASCE 105: 533-545.
Hodges, B. R., J. Imberger, A. Saggio, and K. B. Winters. 2000. Modelling basin-scale
internal waves in a stratified lake. Limnology and Oceanography 45: 1603-1620.
Horton, P., B. Schaefli, A. Mezghani, B. Hingray, and A. Musy. 2006. Assessment of
climate-change impacts on alpine discharge regimes with climate model uncertainty.
Hydrolical Processes 20: 2091-2109.
Imberger, J., and J. C. Patterson. 1990. Physical limnology. Advances in Applied
Mechanics. 27: 303-473
Istituto geografico de Agostini, 1983. Nautical map of Lake Como (Lario), 2nd ed.
Novara.
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
77
Killworth, P. D. 1980. Barotropic and baroclinic instability in rotating, stratified fluids.
Dynamics of Atmospheres and Oceans 4: 143-184
Killworth, D. P., and E. C. Carmack. 1979. A filling box model of river dominated
lakes. Limnology and Oceanography 24: 201-217.
Maxworthy, T. 1997. Convection into domains with open boundaries. Annual Review of
Fluid Mechanics. 29: 327-371.
Maxworthy, T., J. Leilich, J. E. Simpson, and E. H. Meiburg. 2002. The propagation of
a gravity current into a linearly stratified fluid. Journal of Fluid Mechanics. 453: 371-
394.
Morillo, S., J. Imberger, J. P. Antenucci, and D. Copetti. 2009. Using impellers to
distribute local nutrient loadings in a stratified lake: Lake Como, Italy. J. Hydraulic
Engineering 135: 564-574.
Morillo, S., J. Imberger, J. P. Antenucci, and P. F. Woods. 2008. Influence of wind and
lake morphometry on the interaction between two rivers entering a stratified lake.
Journal of Hydraulic Engineering 134: 1579-1589.
Rueda, F. J., and S. G. Schladow. 2003. Dynamics of a large polymictic lake. II:
Numerical simulations. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering. 129: 92-101.
Serruya, S. 1974. The mixing patterns of the Jordan River in Lake Kinneret. Limnology
and Oceanography 19: 175-181.
Simpson, J. E. 1987. Gravity currents in the environment and the laboratory. Wiley.
Stevens, C. L., and G. Lawrence. 1997. Estimation of wind forced internal seiche
amplitudes in lakes and reservoirs, with data from British Columbia, Canada. Aquatic
Science 59: 115-134.
Thompson, R. and J. Imberger. 1980. Response of a numerical model of a stratified lake
to wind stress. Proc. 2nd Int. Symp. on Stratified Flow, Trondheim, Norway, 562-570.
CHAPTER 3. Basin-scale motions and inflow intrusions in Lake Como
78
Vezzoli L., and D. Facchinetti. 2006. Limnogeology of Lake Como, in Centro Volta
Como. Rehabilitation of the water quality in Lake Como. Gruppo di Lavoro Lago di
Como. PLINIUS project. [Italian]
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
79
Chapter 4 A wall out of place: a hydrological and socio-
cultural analysis of physical changes to the lakeshore of
Como, Italy
Laborde, S., Imberger, J. and S. Toussaint.
4.1 Abstract
The construction of a flood protection structure that obscured views of the Lake in
Como, northern Italy, led to unprecedented public protest in 2009-2010 and to the
eventual dismantlement of the structure. This provided a focus to investigate the
delicate interplay of technical and cultural matters in environmental policy - in this case
catchment management and flood prevention. This article shows how a focus on
hydrological control in isolation from the rest of the catchment and from the socio-
cultural context greatly contributed to the project’s failure. A key message of the article
is that data and analyses from the environmental and social sciences are both pivotal to
environmental planning, as they inform different yet interdependent components of a
single project. There is value in integrating technical and socio-cultural knowledge, both
at the academic level, as illustrated by the mixed-methods used in this article, and at the
policy level through management frameworks that emphasise cross-sectoral learning
and public participation. The analysis also reveals that the notion of ‘place’ has a central
role to play in this process of integration, both as a conceptual bridge between technical
and socio-cultural components of environmental studies, and as an emphasis in
environmental planning activities to foster the interest and engagement of communities.
4.2 Introduction
This paper is a reflection on the integration of technical and cultural components of
environmental management. It is based on an empirical analysis of a failed flood-
defence project – a structural intervention on the lakeshore of the Italian city of Como
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
80
(84,085 inhabitants: istat 2009) that was opposed by the local population during its
construction. It was subsequently dismantled.
The lakeshore of Como is a line of encounter between the city and Lake Como, a large
subalpine lake (Fig. 22). As such, it is physically shaped by the hydrology of the Lake
catchment, and it also constitutes an anthropological place in the sense defined by Augé
(2000 p. 100), because it is relevant to the contemporary lives and identities of the
citizens of Como, and it is charged with historical and social meanings (e.g. Turati and
Gentile 1858). The transformation of the lakeshore of Como via the construction of a
flood-defence structure therefore combined hydrological issues related to the dynamics
of the lake and its impacts on the city through the occurrence of floods; and socio-
cultural issues related to the relevance of the lakeshore as a meaningful place.
Figure 22: Right: map of Lake Como and its catchment, and bottom: schematic drawing of the catchment
system. Left: zoom - the city of Como, and top frame: photographs representing the ‘wall’ as seen from
the footpath through a window in a wooden fence (taken by first author in Oct 2009)
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
81
4.2.1 Definitions and theoretical framework
At the societal level, water systems such as lake catchments are broadly conceptualised
as a natural resource to be studied, modeled and controlled by experts in order to
support societal uses, including water supply, navigation and flood mitigation (for
example Lynch 2010: preface). This approach is grounded in the fields of economics
and engineering, and it has been labeled as ‘technocratic’ because of its historical
reliance on expert judgments and top-down procedures (Fischer 2000).
Meanwhile, at the individual and community levels, people have developed knowledge,
practices and values pertaining to their local environments by living and dwelling in
them (Ingold 2000). Meanings related to particular locations emerge from this process,
particularly in relation to water places (Strang 2004; Toussaint 2008). Place-based
meanings may evolve into attachment (Altman et al. 1992) and play a significant role in
one’s sense of self and sense of community (Milton 2005; Twigger-Ross and Uzzell
1996). In this paper, we use the concept of ‘place’ to embody the range of meanings and
emotions held by individuals or communities for a particular location: it is an explicitly
cultural concept, grounded in local human experience (Tuan 1977; Gieryn 2000;
Stedman 2002).
Environmental planning outcomes should meet acceptable balances between these
interrelated ways of conceptualising and relating to water bodies, which have been
associated with the notions of ‘technical’ and ‘cultural’ rationalities (Fischer 2000: 87).
Decisions that fail to do so, for instance by underrating the socio-cultural relevance of
environmental places, can lead to conflicts and project failures (Devine-Wright 2009;
Devine-Wright and Howes 2010).
Assessing and considering the perspectives of all groups affected by a management
decision, including citizens who hold meanings for a particular place (thereby
‘stakeholders’ of any decision affecting that place), has been encouraged by water
management frameworks in the last two to three decades through the implementation of
participatory processes under the general framework of integrated management (United
Nations 1992, Principle 10; EU 2000, Article 14; Creighton 2005). Integrated
management is based on the consideration of a water catchment in its hydrological and
social complexity, in contrast with traditional technocratic approaches that are often
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
82
based on static designs relying on historical analyses of isolated processes (Pahl-Wostl
2007).
The engagement of local communities has also been identified as a key component of
adaptive management for water resources and beyond (Pahl-Wostl et al. 2007; Huitema
et al. 2009), a complementary approach to integrated management that emphasises
continuous learning and experimentation between and amongst scientists, managers and
communities, in order to better handle the complexity and uncertainty inherent in social-
ecological systems (Tompkins and Adger 2004). Within these management frameworks,
public participation has been shown to improve relationships among stakeholders,
builds trust in institutions and fosters the development of environmental knowledge and
awareness (Beierle and Konisky 2001; Bijlsma et al. 2011).
The flood management literature echoes the developments in water management
outlined above. Scholars and institutions have stressed the value of catchment-
integrated approaches (Nunes Correia et al. 1998; EU 2007); adaptive non-structural
solutions have been seen as more fair and strategic than major engineering works (Vis et
al. 2003; Johnson et al. 2007); and public participation has been associated with better
decisions and greater chances of policy success (McDaniels et al. 1999).
However, while participatory processes are central to the transition in resources
management that is advocated in the academic literature (Pahl-Wostl et al. 2009 for a
summary), their practical implementation in the context of environmental planning has
proven difficult (Rydin and Pennington 2000). They may be judged as time-consuming
and costly by decision-makers (Irvin and Stansbury 2004), and the public may not trust
or be willing to engage in such processes (Barbier 2005). This is especially likely for
questions of flood mitigation that are associated with substantial uncertainty, and which
may be addressed a long time after the last flood hazard has passed (Godschalk et al.
2003). In Italy, it has been argued that the legacy of a technical, top-down management
structure is supported at the individual level by a general lack of interest in engaging
with traditional policy, a combination that tends to particularly hinder formal public
participation in environmental management (Massarutto et al. 2003).
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
83
4.2.2 Aim and overview of the article
Medema and colleagues (2008) expressed the need for more case studies documenting
the failures of traditional management practices in the water sector, in order to set a
stronger case for reforms toward integrated and adaptive management approaches. This
article proposes such a case study, as it emphasises aspects of a technocratic approach to
flood prevention that have led to policy failure, in particular a focus on hydrological
control in isolation from the rest of the catchment and the socio-cultural context. Our
objective was also to illustrate the methodological value of integrating insights from
technical and social analyses in environmental studies, and to show how a focus on the
notion of ‘place’ can facilitate such integration.
We use mixed methods across the environmental and social sciences to encompass
multiple components of the case study. We start here by presenting hydrological data
and analyses to assess the causes and risk of floods in Como, and to discuss the
engineering rationale behind the project. By way of environmental psychology and
anthropology we then turn to the socio-cultural evidence to examine reactions triggered
by the structure that became known in Como simply as ‘the wall’ (il muro). This
analysis was conducted by triangulating data from quantitative and qualitative sources
(Moran-Ellis et al. 2006). Finally, we discuss the relevance of our findings from the
practical perspective of environmental planning and management, and from a more
theoretical standpoint regarding the integration of insights from environmental and
social sciences.
4.3 Floods in Como: hydrological considerations
4.3.1 Background
Lake flooding has always been part of the history of Como, as reported in the city
archives (Monti 1900), historical prints and engravings (Poggi and Cantù 2000), and
depicted physically on the city’s facades (Via Volta 54; personal observation, 22 Oct
2009). The Lake catchment extends north into the Alps, where snow serves as a natural
reservoir distributing some of the winter precipitation through spring and summer in the
form of snowmelt runoff. The main inflows to Lake Como are partly controlled by a
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
84
series of 20 upstream alpine reservoirs that were constructed throughout the 20th century
and are currently managed by private hydropower companies (Moisello and Vullo
2011); water is retained in spring and summer to be released in autumn and winter when
electricity demand is high. The outflow from Lake Como, and hence the lake levels,
have been managed since the construction of a dam near Lecco in 1946 for a consortium
of downstream water users (Consorzio dell’Adda 2010), with an aim to provide
hydropower in winter and irrigation water in summer; while moderating lake levels to
prevent flooding in Como at one extreme and very low lake levels at the other9.
Since 1975, the elevation of the city’s lowest point (198.51 m ASL – measured on the
lakeshore by Piazza Cavour in 1997: Comerci et al. 2007) was practically reached every
year by the lake, although the peak levels were contained in most years to that limit.
However, on 10 occasions the Lake caused significant flooding in the city despite the
regulation, flooding an area of more than 1.5 hectares. The area susceptible to flooding
is composed mainly of parks and commercial activities, and the consequences impact
mainly on structural integrity (of historical buildings in some cases) and economic
losses due to the suspension of activity (M. Gastine, unpublished thesis).
4.3.2 Methods
In this first section we aim to provide the hydrological background to the construction
of the anti-flood structure on the lakeshore. We provide an overview of the water level
changes in Lake Como, in response to both long term and seasonal weather patterns and
catchment management. The data used were provided by the Consorzio dell ‘Adda. It
included daily precipitation at two stations within the catchment (Bormio, north of the
catchment [1951-2005], and Olginate, southeast of the Lake [1961-2007]), as well as (1)
integrated volumes of weekly storage in the alpine reservoirs upstream of Lake Como
[1965-2007]; (2) daily lake outflow since 1946; (3) daily lake surface elevation since
1845; and (4) integrated total daily inflows and atmospheric fluxes (direct rainfall and
9 The Lake’s active storage volume of 254.3 x 106 m3 (Consorzio dell’Adda 2010)
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
85
evaporation) since 1946, calculated and used daily by the manager from a simple mass
balance equation (inflow and atmospheric fluxes = outflow + lake level variation).
We analyzed annual and seasonal trends of water balance in the catchment based on
these data. We also modeled the catchment’s water balance using MATLAB ®, which
allowed comparing management scenarios. The model was a simple water budget
relating the Lake levels to its total inflows - including atmospheric exchanges upstream
reservoirs storage - and outflow. Rating curves (Moisello and Vullo 2011) providing the
stage discharge relationships at the dam in ‘regulated open’ (all dam gates open) and
‘natural’ conditions (no upstream or downstream dams) allowed modifying the outflow
and lake levels in the scenario analysis, while the inflows were modified by changing
the volumes held in upstream reservoirs10.
4.3.3 Results
4.3.3.1 Long-term trends
Maximum lake levels have been generally decreasing and visibly bounded by the
regulation since the mid-1980s at an elevation corresponding to that of Piazza Cavour
(Fig. 23), with the exception of peak floods (e.g. in 1987, 1993, 1997, 2000, 2002).
Minimum lake levels also appear bounded, particularly since the mid-1990s, at a level
of ~197 m ASL. Mean annual lake levels have been decreasing since the mid-20th
century at a rate of ~1 cm y-1 (Fig. 23). The elevation of the city, and particularly that
of Piazza Cavour, has been decreasing through time due to geological subsidence
resulting from a combination of natural compaction of the unconsolidated glacial
sediments on which the town was built11, and human-induced subsidence12 following
the exploitation of the deep aquifer between 1950 and 1975. The current sinking rate,
10 The reservoirs’ total active volume is 514.9 x 106 m3 (Croce et al. 1987)
11 Sinking velocities ranging from 1 to 2.5 mm y-1 (Comerci et al. 2007)
12 Sinking velocities up to over 20 mm y-1 (Comerci et al. 2007)
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
86
which is expected to continue in the near future, is approximately 2.5 mm y-1 (Comerci
et al. 2007).
The long-term trends affecting flood mitigation in Como can be summarised as follows:
• The subsidence of the city has increased the need for flood mitigation;
• The dam control of lake levels has improved through time, increasingly supporting
flood mitigation.
Figure 23: Maximum (red dots), mean (black dots) and minimum (blue dots) annual lake levels since
1845 (original data: Consorzio dell’Adda); and elevation of Piazza Cavour (grey dots, Comerci et al.
2007). Vertical red lines indicate the positive difference between maximum lake level and elevation of
Piazza Cavour (e.g. flooding). The black line on the right represents the regulation range.
4.3.3.2 Seasonal trends and water uses
Flooding is most frequent in late spring and early summer (June, July) when snowmelt
coincides with high rainfall, and in autumn (October) when rainfall events cause the
most damaging episodes (Fig. 24). Part of the summer snowmelt runoff is stored
upstream in the hydropower reservoirs, which buffer potential runoff peaks by reducing
the total discharge to the Lake by an average of 29 m3s-1 between May and September.
During the same period, the Lake dam is used to store water, and therefore maintain
high lake levels (Fig. 24), in preparation for the high summer irrigation demand. From
late autumn to early spring (October to April), the electricity production peaks and the
upstream reservoir releases contribute positively to the discharge into Lake Como, by an
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
87
average of 21 m3s-1 (see also Consorzio dell’Adda 1990). In October and November,
when there is significant risk of flooding due heavy rains, the contribution of upstream
reservoir releases on the Lake level averages 0.7 cm day -1.
The seasonal trends affecting flood mitigation in Como can be summarised as follows:
• In late spring, lake storage objectives compete with flood mitigation while
upstream reservoir storage acts as an inflow buffer and thus supports it;
• In autumn, upstream power production objectives compete with flood
mitigation.
Figure 24: Average number of days per month when lake levels were higher than 198.51 m ASL
(corresponding to the lowest point of Piazza Cavour: Comerci et al. 2007) and 199.22 m ASL
(corresponding to significant floods with more than 1.5 hectares of the city flooded: Gastine 2006,
unpublished thesis). Data are averaged over the period [1965 – 2007].
4.3.3.3 Extreme events
Beside the impact of lakeshore subsidence, the high frequency of floods in the late 20th
century in Como was associated with heavy rainfall-runoff events that have become
increasingly frequent since the 1970s (Fig. 25; see also Brunetti et al. 2001). These
episodes are balanced by dry periods causing inflow minima to decrease (Fig. 25B,
black line): the runoff to the Lake has therefore been evolving in the last four decades
towards an increased variability (Fig. 25B). Beside the changing rainfall patterns, a
review of recent studies suggests that other important hydrological variables in the
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
88
region like the snow/rain ratio and glacier mass balance are showing nonlinear trends
(Horton et al. 2006; Huss et al. 2009; Grothmann et al. 2009).
The following two points can be made about the stochastic component of flood
mitigation in Como:
• Heavy rainfall events have become more frequent over the last 30 to 40 years,
increasing the need for flood prevention;
• Runoff patterns, and the catchment hydrology in general, have become less
predictable.
Figure 25: A - Maximum daily rainfall observed in Bormio [1951-2005] (upper Adda catchment, blue
line) and Olginate [1961-2007] (Southeast of the lake, cyan line) and fitted linear trends (data: Consorzio
dell’ Adda). B – Highest and lowest total lake inflow calculated for the years 1946 to 2007 and fitted
linear trends (data: Consorzio dell ‘Adda; atmospheric fluxes are included).
4.3.3.4 Flood mitigation
The upstream reservoirs are managed solely to meet hydropower demand variations,
while downstream dam management takes flood prevention into account: when the
Lake level approaches the lowest elevation on the lakeshore, the Lake manager opens
the dam gates (Fig. 26). The dam management has contributed to the decreasing
intensity and duration of floods in Como. However, in the case of heavy rainfall,
complete opening of the dam gates once the rain starts may not be sufficient to prevent
Como flooding since the maximum outflow is limited (about 900 m3 s-1: Fig. 26) and
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
89
downstream flooding risks must also be considered. The isolated management of the
downstream dam is thus not sufficient to prevent all floods and their material impact on
the city of Como; especially as extreme rainfall events are becoming more frequent.
Figure 26: Daily data of outflow discharge (m3s-1) plotted against lake level (m ASL) from 1946 to 1990
(light gray) and from 1991 to 2007 (dark gray, covers some light gray data points); dashed black line:
rating curve for Lake Como in natural conditions (before construction of the dam in 1946); plain black
line: rating curve for Lake Como in regulated conditions, all dam gates open (free regime); dotted red
lines: regulation range; plain red line: lowest elevation of Piazza Cavour measured in 1997 (Comerci et al.
2007). Rating curves were elaborated by the Hydrographic Office of the Po River and reported by
Moisello and Vullo (2011).
Results from a simple model of the catchment water budget illustrate the potential
benefits of an integrated upstream-downstream management for flood mitigation. For
the modelling exercise, we considered the flood of November 2002 as an example that
was caused by an extreme rainfall event. Starting on January 1, 2002, we compared the
measured lake levels with calculated values based on the rating curves in Fig. 26,
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
90
characterising ‘natural’ and ‘open’ regimes. Results in Fig. 27 show that the actual lake
levels reached during the flood peak in late November 2002 are equivalent to those that
would have been reached with all dam gates open from the beginning of the year, and
nearly 80 cm below those that would have been reached in a ‘natural’ catchment (no
upstream or downstream dams).
The blue line represents a scenario where the upstream reservoirs act to buffer the flood.
We assumed that (1) rainfall over the catchment was homogeneous and the reservoirs
could intercept 10% of the total runoff (Croce et al. 1987: 106); (2) the reservoirs
operated as usual unless the water level in Lake Como reached 10 cm under the lowest
level of Piazza Cavour: in that case, they started storing inflow water (calculated as
10%, then 5% of the total inflow to the lake) until the level was back under the
threshold; and (3) when the Lake level dropped below 50 cm under the Piazza,
accumulated water was released at a rate corresponding to 20% of the total daily inflow
to the lake. Under this scenario, the peak level in 2002 would have been reduced by
about half a meter. Should the reservoirs only intercept 5% of the runoff to limit their
loss in power production, the peak would still have been reduced by about 30 cm. This
scenario was oversimplified and its results are to be taken with caution, since individual
data on the runoff and reserved volumes stored within the reservoirs were not available.
However, it clearly demonstrates some potential and unexplored benefit in coordinating
catchment objectives between upstream, downstream and the lakeshores. Considering
that a flood-defence structure was to be built on the lakeshore, its height could have
been reduced for the same degree of flood protection if the flood buffering capacity of
the upstream reservoirs had been considered.
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
91
Figure 27: A – Lake levels corresponding to different catchment management scenarios for the flood of
November 2002. B – Water volume reserved in the upstream reservoirs in the base case and the
management scenario.
4.3.4 The flood defence project
The idea behind the project was based on a general recommendation to re-elevate the
subsided city shore as part of a series of combined measures proposed by scholars in the
late 1980s to manage flooding in Como (Guariso et al. 1986, Croce et al. 1987). The
project plans proposed the construction of an anti-flood structure on the lakeshore
composed of both permanent and mobile barriers, at an elevation of 200.3 m above sea
level (ASL thereafter) corresponding to approximately 1.8 m above the lowest point on
Como’s lakeshore square (Piazza Cavour). This elevation, which had never been
reached by the Lake since its regulation, was based upon an historical analysis of lake
levels (time series from 1946 to 1990) and the objective to protect the city from 50-year
peak floods.
The decision-makers chose a single structure over a combination of ‘softer’
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
92
interventions, such as improving the network of gauges on the Lake inflows, because of
the only partial effect of the latter on the reduction of maximum flood levels
(Amministrazione comunale di Como 2004, based on Croce et al. in 1987). They did
not account either for the possibility to integrate upstream and downstream catchment
management, possibly because of the costs and difficulties of negotiating priorities
between public and private institutions at different scales (including transboundary,
since two of the upstream hydropower reservoirs are located in Switzerland).
Additionally, a structural intervention benefitted from the availability of national and
regional funds, which were allocated after flooding in the Valtellina valley north of the
Lake in July 1987 (law n.102/90), and it offered the opportunity to revamp the city’s
lakeshore at the same time. These political and financial factors seem to have led to a
preference for a single major technical answer to the complex issue of floods in Como,
rather than a combination of structural and non-structural approaches at the scale of the
catchment.
The project was presented to the public in March 2003 with an emphasis on the
technology of the mobile barriers, and computer renderings of the revamped lakeshore
that did not indicate any obstruction to lake views. The project was received with some
skepticism regarding its legitimacy and engineering feasibility, but there was little
concern regarding its possible visual impact (La Provincia di Como – thereafter LPDC -
21 Oct. 2003). The original project plans were accessible to the public upon demand,
although the project underwent some changes during the implementation stage, which
were not publicly communicated.
The construction commenced in January 2008 and proceeded with no major public
reaction until mid-September 2009, when a citizen denounced a ‘wall’ (‘muro’)
standing on the construction site (Fig. 22, top left) in place of the familiar landscape of
the Lake (LPDC 23 Sept. 2009). A strong community movement ensued in Como to
oppose the structure in construction, fuelled by conversations, Internet exchanges,
media reports and activities that were underpinned by the expression of place-related
feelings of loss, frustration and outrage, as well as doubts related to the legitimacy and
transparency of the political and technical authority that had allowed the ‘wall’ to be
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
93
built. The movement gained momentum in the media, the community and the political
spheres, and it was finally dismantled in February 2010.
4.4 Social movement against the ‘wall’: a socio-cultural analysis
4.4.1 Methods
In this section we present data concerning people’s reactions to the structure in
construction. Principles of environmental psychology and anthropology are used to
contextualise and analyze the data that were composed of (1) public data: letters from
local citizens published in the local newspapers, and a record of the public discussion
conducted through a web-based social network between Sept. 23 and Oct. 7, 2009; and
(2) responses to an online questionnaire distributed between May 4 and May 18, 2010.
The design of the questionnaire and the choice of the coding frame for the analysis of
the public data were supplemented by field notes from informal interviews and
observations conducted on site between Oct. 1 and Oct. 23, 2009. This type of multi-
method approach is useful to encompass community responses both in depth and time
(Deacon et al. 1999; Moran-Ellis et al. 2006). We start by describing the methods used
to collect and analyze the data, then turn to the results. Since they complemented each
other, qualitative and quantitative results are combined in a single section.
4.4.1.1 Questionnaire
The aim of the questionnaire was to collect quantitative data related to the respondents’
reactions to the wall. We designed a computerised web-based survey, which was
selected for flexibility, time-efficiency (de Leeuw et al. 2008) and the general
consistency of its results with other survey distribution methods (Gosling et al. 2004). A
short article explaining the research objectives and a link to the questionnaire were
included in Como’s local newspaper La Provincia di Como (the paper version that is
sold through the Como province, and the web version that is freely accessible) on May
4, 2010, and the data collection was closed on May 18, 2010. The mode of distribution
made the sample a non-random, convenience sample, allowing an examination of
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
94
internal relationships between variables that made a cultural analysis possible but was
not produced for statistical generalization (Bernard 2006).
Questions relating to political and social themes were based on previous studies that
identified a sense of injustice and efficacy as cornerstones of collective action
(Mannarini 2009). Place-related questions were based on the framework developed by
Scannel and Gifford (2010) from which we selected the items that were most salient in
the informal interviews conducted in the field (Field notes 1 to 23 Oct 2009), for
instance the themes of pride and personal history - also reported elsewhere as major
components of place attachment in Italy (Carrus et al. 2005). We assessed the reaction
to the wall using a set of polar (yes-no) questions regarding a respondent’s participation
in different protest actions. The other statements were measured by Likert scale-type
responses.
A total of 471 entries were analyzed; 57.7% of respondents were male, 32.1% female13;
the age distribution differed from that of the citizens of Como and its province mainly
by an under representation of 17- and 55+ years old (demographic data: istat 2009),
which may be explained by the lower interest of the former in daily newspapers, and of
the latter in the Internet. 51% of respondents were current Como residents when they
responded to the questionnaire, of which the great majority (91.4%) had been living
there for more than 10 years. Non-resident respondents were connected to the city and
the Lake because they had once lived in Como (29.9%); they worked in the city (30.3%)
or in the Province (31.5%). 41.2% of respondents (reported seeing the Lake every day,
28.9% several times a week, 21.2% saw the Lake between once a month and once a
week and 8.7% once a month or less. A total of 208 respondents, 44.2% of the total,
engaged in at least one mode of protest against the wall.
We first undertook a principal component analysis (PCA) with orthogonal rotation to
reduce responses to survey questions into a smaller number of variables (de Vaus 2002;
Bernard 2006). We then used t-tests to assess whether the scores of these composite
variables differed significantly between groups of individuals who engaged in different
protest activities; and we conducted analyses of variance to explore the significance for
13 11% did not answer the question about gender.
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
95
these composite variables of other variables such as age, education, and frequency of
contact with the lake.
4.4.1.2 Public data
In order to compare with the PCA results and to identify patterns in time, especially
since the questionnaire data were gathered several months after the dismantlement of
the wall, we conducted a thematic content analysis on two written data streams of
residents’ reactions to the wall (Bernard 2006). We examined 225 letters and comments
published in the local daily newspaper La Provincia di Como between Sept 23 and Oct
7, which corresponded to the initial peak of concern for the wall. These constituted all
items on the topic received by the newspaper during that period, except those that were
screened by the newspaper redaction for abusive language and excessive length (LPDC,
25 Sept. 09 to 07 Oct. 09).
We also analyzed the record of 382 communication items posted during the same period
of an online group that had formed on a social networking website as a response to the
wall. The group had formed on September 23 and grew to about 7000 people on
October 7 (up to 8000 later on); 228 people took part in the discussion analyzed (151
males, 73 females, 4 unidentified). These data were valuable for our analysis because
(1) they were was public, unfiltered and dated, allowing for a longitudinal study of
dominant themes; and (2) this particular web-based group had played a role in the
mobilization of the residents against the project and particularly in the organization of
public protests. We analyzed all texts with the coding frame summarised in Appendix A
at the end of the thesis. Quotes from letters and Internet discussions are reported to
illustrate various knowledge claims and arguments (Bernard 2006); these were
translated into English for the purpose of this article (Appendix B).
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
96
4.4.2 Results
4.4.2.1 A social movement grounded in a sense of injustice, community and place
The PCA results are summarised in Table 4. The first three principal components
together explained 51.1% of the variance. After an orthogonal rotation, we identified
three defining themes for these clusters of responses that had internal consistency (Table
4, de Vaus 2002). Questions relating to attachment, personal memories and pride
associated with the Lake were grouped in a ‘lake attachment’ variable (‘vA’). Those
relating to issues of legitimacy and soundness of the project, and transparency of the
implementation process referred to the different forms of symbolic, economic and actual
power sustained by different authorities, and were therefore grouped in a ‘political
discontent’ variable (‘vP’). Finally, questions relating to a sense of shared emotion,
social unity and efficacy against the project were grouped in a ‘social cohesion’ variable
(‘vS’) 14.
We are mindful that the three integrated variables vA, vP and vS cannot be considered
as scales measuring a single construct. The series of questions that constituted them
were designed to capture some of the complexity of the concepts they relate to (like
attachment to place, see Scannel and Gifford 2010) and, as a result, their internal
consistency values are average (Cronbach’s alpha values [0.5 – 0.7]). With this caution
in mind, it is still useful to conduct further analyses with these composite variables
computed by integrating the three groups of questions shown in Table 4.
A series of t-tests showed that the respondents who had engaged in any mode of protest
against the wall scored significantly higher in the three variables vA, vS and vP, than
the people who didn’t protest (Table 5). Overall, the political component (vP) of the
protest was the most salient in the t-test results, particularly for people who engaged in
signing petitions and in public demonstrations. People who wrote a letter to the
newspapers scored higher in lake attachment (vA), and social cohesion (vS) was
particularly relevant to people who signed a petition.
14 The conception of the 'wall’ as a threat to the city’s economy scored high in factors vP and vS because the economic argument may be part of a political rationale about the legitimacy of the structure (vP) while the word ‘threat’ in the question may have suggested defensive group response related to vS. It scored higher in ‘social cohesion’ factor and was integrated to the corresponding variable (vS).
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
97
Table 4: PCA loadings for questionnaire items after rotation (Varimax with Kaiser normalisation);
questionnaire statements were translated from Italian
Questionnaire statements translated from Italian Component loadings (orthogonally rotated)
I am proud of the lake landscape .569 .268 -.268
The lake reminds me of important moments in my life .818 -.082 .109
I feel attached to the lake .796 .134 .167
The majority of Comaschi was opposed to the wall construction (from September 2009)
.041 .696 .035
From the beginning, I trusted in the efficacy of the protest against the wall
.088 .727 -.051
The wall would be useful to prevent floods in Como† .074 .216 .740
The wall is a threat to the economy of Como (tourism) -.024 .537 .452
The wall would have allowed storing more water in the lake, allowing a larger use in the agricultural districts downstream†
.120 -.089 .618
The commune has provided sufficient information on the project prior to starting the construction†
-.083 .129 .632
I was very surprised by the construction of the wall .129 .481 .274
Composite variable vA vS vP
Cronbach’s alpha 0.611 0.552 0.506
† The response was reverse-scored for analysis
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
98
Table 5: Differences in vA, vS and vP scores for different protest groups
Any form of
protest Letter to
newspapers Petition Public demonstration
NO YES NO YES NO YES NO YES
vA
N 257 206 389 35 299 125 324 100 Mean (SD)
4.22 (0.70)
4.48 (0.63)
4.30 (0.69)
4.68 (0.40)
4.27 (0.68)
4.48 (0.67)
4.28 (0.71)
4.50 (0.57)
t Sig. (2-tailed)
-4.23 .000
-4.96 .000
-2.91 .004
-3.21 .002
vS
N 229 195 353 35 268 120 293 95 Mean (SD)
3.75 (0.83)
4.08 (0.71)
3.87 (0.81)
4.16 (0.65)
3.80 (0.83)
4.1 (0.68)
3.86 (0.82)
4.02 (0.74)
t Sig. (2-tailed)
-4.31 .000
-2.42 .020
-3.88 .000
-1.69 .091 (n.s.)
vP
N 228 194 351 35 267 119 291 95 Mean (SD)
3.92 (0.80)
4.32 (0.67)
4.09 (0.78)
4.37 (0.65)
4.00 (0.78)
4.36 (0.71)
4.02 (0.81)
4.39 (0.60)
t Sig. (2-tailed)
-5.49 .000
-2.09 .037
-4.32 .000
-4.84 .000
Note: vA, vS and vP are not normally distributed. The sample size is sufficiently large for the Central
Limit Theorem to hold. We conducted nonparametric Mann-Whitney tests that highlighted the same
significant differences with equivalent significance levels.
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
99
The text analysis confirmed the strong political dimension for the protest found in the
questionnaire data: political themes were present in 52% of the letters and 45% of the
items from the online conversation, in particular as a critique of the insufficient and
distorted information provided by decision-makers to the public. This is expressed for
instance in the following quote (see also quote 1, Appendix B):
It is certainly not easy for a regular citizen to have access to a public work project and it is certainly not trivial either to interpret it for those who are not an engineer or architect. What has been fed to us, the ignorant people, were three ‘rendering’ images and on those there was no wall or, and this is very important to highlight, any ‘significant’ lifting of the sidewalk. (Letter published on 25 Sept. 2009)
Place-related concerns were evident in 69% of the letters and 21% of the online
comments, reflecting the strong association of vA with letter-writing as a form of
protest that was found in the questionnaire data. Place attachment was often expressed
by the use of the adjective ‘mio’ (mine) or ‘nostro’ (our) followed by ‘lago’ (lake),
‘lungolago’ (lakeshore) or ‘citta’ (city). For example, a woman from Como wrote (see
also quotes 2-4):
I want to see my fish again, big, small, sick, fast, slow, they are mine. The clean bottom in winter and the clear waters, dirty in summer, green, opaque, but it is my lake. (Letter published on 28 Sept. 2009)
Nonparametric bivariate correlations indicated modest but significant correlations in the
questionnaire data between vA and vS (Kendall’s τ=0.154, N=420, p<0.001), between
vS and vP (τ=0.178, N=420, p<0.001) as well as, to a lesser extent, between vA and vP
(τ=0.095, N=419, p<0.05). These links were apparent in the qualitative data, too. For
instance, the political theme of the accountability for the situation was prominent in
both the letters (55%) and online comments (28%) and it was associated with emotional
content that often explicitly referred to place-related attachments and concerns about
aesthetic and/or cultural values associated with the city, the Lake and/or the lakeshore
(for instance quote 2). In both datasets, local attachment to place was also associated
with a social dimension expressed as the sensation of belonging to a community being
threatened in one aspect of its identity and continuity by the disruption of a familiar
landscape (quotes 5-7). The following quote illustrates the kind of reaction, commonly
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
100
found in the analysis, where political discontent, social cohesion and attachment to
place were all embedded. By illustrating the correlations found between vA, vP and vS
in the questionnaire responses, it also shows the value of combining quantitative and
qualitative data:
Those who have allowed and realised such a disgrace ignoring the history of Como offend the city by injuring it in its peculiar vocation, insult the citizens and humiliate the future generations. (Letter by Como resident published on 25 Sept. 2009)
The interplay of attachment to place and sense of community also resulted in a form of
expectation by some citizens that decision-makers, born and raised in Como, would
share and bear their own entrenched feelings for a place that meant much to them and
act accordingly, as the following quote suggests (see also quote 8): ‘I would never have
thought that persons born in Como could have allowed such a disaster’ (Letter
published on 25/09/09).
4.4.2.2 ‘The rise of a wall that unites the people’: place-related emotion and
engagement
Analyses of variance of questionnaire responses revealed that respondents’ gender and
level of education had no significant effect on their scores in any of the three variables
vA, vP and vS. Their age had a significant effect on vP only (F(3) = 4.607, p < 0.01),
with post-hoc Tukey's HSD tests showing that 35-54 and 55+ years old scored
significantly higher in vP than 18-24 years old at the 0.01 level of significance15. The
frequency of contact with the Lake (from less than once a month to every day) had a
significant effect on vA (F(3) = 4.9, p < 0.01) but not on vS or vP. A series of t-tests
showed in turn that people who reported engaging in various activities on the lakeshore
(see Table 6) scored significantly higher in lake attachment (vA), but not in political
15 Other differences were not significant
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
101
discontent (vP) or social cohesion (vS), than those who didn’t (Table 6). 16
Table 6: Differences in vA, vS and vP scores for different groups of lakeshore users
Lakeshore activities Socialising with family
and friends Practicing sports Thinking and reflecting
NO YES NO YES NO YES
vA
N 241 222 351 112 212 251
Mean (SD) 4.24 (0.78)
4.43 (0.54)
4.27 (0.73)
4.54 (0.43)
4.18 (0.78)
4.46 (0.56)
t -3.07 -4.77 -4.31
Sig. (2-tailed) .002 .000 .000
vS
N 215 209 313 109 182 242
Mean (SD) 3.91 (0.81)
3.89 (0.78)
3.88 (0.81)
3.96 (0.75)
3.87 (0.84)
3.92 (0.76)
t 0.235 0.193 -0.759
Sig. (2-tailed) .659 .365 .448
vP
N 214 208 313 109 182 240
Mean (SD) 4.13 (0.80)
4.08 (0.74)
4.09 (0.79)
4.15 (0.69)
4.03 (0.78)
4.16 (0.76)
t 0.614 0.367 -1.69
Sig. (2-tailed) .499 .466 .093
Note: vA, vS and vP are not normally distributed. The sample size is sufficiently large for the Central Limit Theorem to hold. We conducted nonparametric Mann-Whitney tests that highlighted the same significant differences with equivalent significance levels.
For Como residents, attachment to the city itself and the perception that the Lake is
inseparable from it were associated with higher vA scores (respectively F(4) = 9.52, p <
0.001, and F(4) = 8.60, p < 0.001) as well as higher vS scores (respectively F(4) = 3.40,
16 Beyond local attachments to the Lake and the city, references to the aesthetic dimension of the landscape and its moral implications brought international coverage to the case, both via media and social networks. This aspect, corresponding to the ‘physical place’ component of Scannell and Gifford’s framework (2010) was not directly explored through the questionnaire but appeared in 32% of letters and 9% of online comments (quotes 24-25). One person spoke, for instance, in the name of ‘all those who love, not only Como and its lake, but the beautiful in general’ (Letter published on 26/09/09).
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
102
p < 0.05, and F(4) = 4.43, p < 0.01) (see corresponding quotes 9-12); there was also a
significant effect of the length of residence of Comaschi respondents on their
attachment to the Lake (F(4) = 2.69, p < 0.05; see also Lewicka 2011).
39.5% of respondents reported that they had actively informed themselves about the
project before the media outbreak of ‘the wall’ (out of which 51.6% subsequently took
part in the protest movement). This early proactive behavior (at least reported as such)
was significantly correlated with lake attachment score vA (τ=0.107, N=414, p<0.01),
but not with vS or vP. The majority of respondents did not actively seek information
before they heard or read about the ‘wall’, a detachment pre-project implementation that
was also revealed in the qualitative data (expressed in 11% of the letters and 5% of
items from the online discussion). The following quote illustrates this phenomenon of
initial disengagement despite, in this case, the belief that the project was illegitimate. It
is related here to the idea of political compromise and rather low expectations of local
planning policy (see Gambetta and Origgi 2009):
The flood protection structures are useless, and it is not too late to say so. All those who live near the lake know very well that when the lake floods it comes out through the manholes, the garages, the elevator shafts. There is not, and there will never be, a barrier able to stop the lake, as it has been so for two thousand years. So many of us voted for [the mayor] because of the political coalition, holding our noses about this project because we were thinking of the new lakeshore promenade. (Letter published on 05 Oct. 2009)
The disengagement between citizens and decision-makers was two-way, as illustrated
by a political actor in the affair who, as the protest was gaining momentum, commented
that ‘citizens should worry about the walls of their own houses’ (LPDC, 20 Oct. 2010).
As a result of such detachment, neither the desirability or the scientific grounds for the
project had not been thoroughly discussed before it started and were not clear for some
citizens, who challenged them a posteriori. While direct references to the frequency of
floods and lake level dynamics were few (2.5% of all documents), some advanced
hydrological arguments to suggest that the scale of the project was excessive compared
to what they described as a real, but relatively minor, issue of floods in Como (for
instance quotes 13-15 highlighting the recent improvements in the dam management
and their mitigating effect on flooding, as seen in the first part of this article). Others
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
103
disputed the economical (quote 16) and cultural (quotes 17-19) legitimacy of the
structure with, at one extreme, a member of the Internet group who emphasised the
historical and cultural dimension of floods to oppose all kinds of protective intervention
on the shore: ‘The lakeshore had to be left the way it was - the floods are part of the
history of our city’ (Comment posted on 25/09/09, accessed on 14/04/10).
As a result, the structure being constructed triggered expressions of emotion in the form
of surprise, but also outrage, sadness and/or shame (see quotes 2; 20-23), which were
found in 39% of the letters and 36% of the online items, mainly in the first few days of
the reaction to the wall (Fig. 28, red markers and trend). This confirmed impressions of
a strong emotional dimension for the movement gathered on site during the first days of
the protest (Field notes 9, 16 and 18 Oct 2009). The frequencies of expression of the
different themes in time (Fig. 28) suggest that emotions related to the loss of the
familiar landscape (Fig. 28, red and magenta trends) were particularly present at the
start of the protest movement and may have acted as a trigger. Political and technical
arguments against the structure in construction increased with time to foster the protest,
as people became more informed about the project (Fig. 28, black trend). The
newspaper articles showed similar thematic patterns, from the ‘shock’ (Letter published
on 25/09/09) of the loss of the landscape and the relevance of the lake, to questions
about the technical and political legitimacy of the project and the use of public money.
Figure 28: Theme frequency plot for online discussion platform. Horizontal axis is the item number;
items were plotted in chronological order (intervals within grey lines represent one day), vertical axis is
the count frequency for each theme (moving average over 30 items centred on item i). Lines are best-fit
linear trends for different themes. Vertical grey line represents one day.
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
104
4.4.3 Limitations of the analysis
The case prompted several other lines of inquiry that we were unable to address given
the available resources and the timing of our research. In particular, the specificities of
the project variants and the political/financial dimensions prior to and during its
implementation were admittedly important elements of the story from a planning
perspective, but were not within the scope of this paper. These latter aspects are
embedded in the broader concept of the public’s political discontent regarding the
project implementation, which we address without entering in any technical detail.
Another limitation of the socio-cultural analysis was the data range that extended
mainly within respondents with a strong opinion against the wall. Only three textual
items did not explicitly oppose the structure as it was being built on the lakeshore (out
of 623). Only 8.1% of questionnaire respondents declared certain indifference or a
positive attitude toward the construction. Although this assessment confirmed an
impression of quasi-unanimity against the wall gathered from the three weeks of field
work (Field notes 1 to 23 Oct 2009), we are mindful that our data streams are likely to
be biased towards ‘anti-wall’ protesters and activists because (1) the local newspaper La
Provincia took a strong position early on and played a significant role in focusing on,
relaying information about, and extending the protest (Field notes 16 and 20 Oct 09);
(2) the sample of questionnaire respondents was also strongly affiliated with the
newspaper through the distribution method (89.2% of respondents to the questionnaire
had read about the story of the wall in the local newspaper); and (3) the online group
was explicitly created to focus the protest. Our study did not therefore allow, and was
not designed, for a statistical generalization. It was however relevant to explore the
nature of the protest against the structure in construction, especially as it was eventually
dismantled.
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
105
4.5 Discussion
4.5.1 A case for integrated and adaptive catchment management
The analysis identified two interrelated issues with the planning approach that led to the
failure of the flood defence intervention in Como. It was shown to be a fragmented
approach, both:
• hydrologically: the project design did not account for potential flood prevention
benefit of other possible water management measures in the catchment; and
• socially: a two-way disconnect between decision-makers and citizens appeared to
be an important cause of the policy failure.
The reasons that led to the choice of a single major structure over a combination of
measures for flood prevention appeared to be political rather than scientific. In
particular a funding opportunity for the project and the chance to combine it with the
renovation of the lakeshore promenade. Embedding flood prevention policy into a
catchment management plan would, on the other hand, require rather complex and
costly reforms, especially since the upstream reservoirs are controlled by private
companies and some of them are located in Switzerland.
The social disconnect emphasised in this study was typical of a technocratic approach
(Fischer 2000) that is still predominant in Italian environmental management. In this
context, public participation is not usually considered relevant by decision-makers and
the public is, in response, generally ‘skeptical and half-hearted’ with regard its possible
participation in policy-making (Massarutto et al. 2003: 23). In the Como case there was
little communication by decision-makers about the project, even during the
implementation phase when some modifications were made. There was also a relatively
low proactive interest amongst the public with regard to the project, which to some
extent reflects a cultural attitude (Massarutto et al. 2003; Enserink et al. 2007), but was
also due to the technical nature of the available information and thus the lack of
opportunity to develop and express informed opinions about it (see Fisher 2000, Barbier
2005).
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
106
We argue that, from a long-term perspective, an integrated and adaptive approach to the
management of the Adda catchment is required to address the issues highlighted in this
study. From a hydrological perspective, a combination of multiple, flexible measures
(possibly including structural ones) would be a more desirable option than isolated
interventions for the issue of floods in Como and for the management of the catchment
in general (see also Guariso et al. 1986, Gandolfi et al. 2007). This is especially true
considering the uncertainty associated with the catchment’s near-future hydrology,
which calls for coordination across multiple scales and sectors of activity (Grothmann et
al. 2009). For decision-makers in Como, this requires a transition from a ‘flood defence’
policy focused on local control, to a ‘flood management’ approach focused on
catchment-wide learning (see Johnson et al. 2007: Table 1).
From a social perspective, the focus on learning of integrated and adaptive management
approaches would also be likely to improve communication and understanding between
decision-makers and citizens (Beierle and Konisky 2001; Goldstein 2009). Participatory
processes have been shown to enhance the knowledge base of: (a) citizens (Huitema et
al. 2010), which in the case of floods in Como could have resulted in an early response
to concerns such as those expressed in quotes 12-16; and (b) experts and decision-
makers (Bijlsma et al. 2011), at least with regard to the perceptions and values of
citizens (Huitema et al. 2010). In the case of Como, it is hard to imagine that the
upheaval of the ‘wall’ could have happened had there been a genuine and ongoing
interaction between citizens and decision-makers. The structure might have been
altogether different and more in agreement with citizens’ values, or the same structure
might have been completed, provided citizens were confident about the temporary
nature of the ‘wall’ and its impacts on lake views, and that they were satisfied with the
prospective of the finished project.
The legislative framework for integrated catchment management in Italy has been in
place since 1989, and scientists have demonstrated interest and capabilities for its
development in the Adda catchment (Gandolfi et al. 2007). With respect to public
participation in policy-making, it has been argued that, in Italy, ‘horizontal’ and
informal participation is more efficient than structured and hierarchical participation
(Massarutto et al. 2003: 24-25). In any case, there is a need to bring decision-makers
and stakeholders (including citizens) together so that they can learn about each other’s
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
107
perspectives (McLain and Lee 1996; Lebel et al. 2010). Below we suggest that a focus
on place meanings may facilitate the engagement of citizens in such process.
4.5.2 Engaging the public around place attachments and meanings
Emotions are pervasive in the relationships people have with their local environments
(see also Mitchell 1993) and these can be pivotal when it comes to environmental
planning: able, for instance, to trigger a social movement (see also Mannarini et al.
2009; Devine-Wright 2009; and Heatherington 2005). The defence of one’s identity
plays an important role in the emergence of social movements (Poletta and Jasper
2001), and this is true for place-defence movements. As summarised by Stedman (2002:
577): ‘we are willing to fight for places that are central to our identities’.
This was also the case in Como as the analysis showed. Most questionnaire respondents
declared they hadn’t been proactive about seeking information about the project, which
is considered relatively normal in a technocratic framework where policy is delegated to
experts (Massarutto et al. 2003). Qualitative accounts also reported that citizens had
been taking relatively little notice of previous failures or suboptimal planning policies.
For the wall, however, the mobilization was exceptional, although reactive and
oppositional, largely because the lakeshore was a particularly meaningful place for
people.
The question now is: are we willing to engage in decision-processes for places that are
central to our identities? Preliminary insights from our results suggest that it is the case
in Como. We already showed that people who had sought information about the project
prior to the media outburst were those with the strongest attachment to the lake.
Complementary t-tests showed that people who attended the city council meetings on
the topic of the flood-defence structure or followed them on a local television channel
(the council room had limited space for public attendants) also scored significantly
higher in attachment to the Lake than those who didn’t (t=-2.322; p<0.05), although
they didn’t score higher in social cohesion (t=-1.378; n.s.) or political discontent (t=-
1.740; n.s.).
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
108
Attachment to the Lake was itself enhanced by physical proximity, frequency of contact
and engagement with it through various activities. People’s engagement in the protest in
turn fostered their willingness to further protect and enhance the lakeshore: more than
three months after the dismantlement of the wall, 66.7% of people who responded to the
questionnaire declared feeling more engaged with the planning and conservation of the
Lake than before the affair had taken place. This was especially true for people who had
participated in protest actions (t=-4.031; p<0.001).
We suggest that the articulation and analysis of attachments to place have the potential
to enhance public participation in policy-making, and to address the type of disjuncture
between local politics and citizens that was observed in Como (see also Cheng et al.
2003; Davenport and Anderson 2005; Manzo and Perkins 2006). Indeed the protest was
a form of participation in planning policy focused on ‘place’, although reactive (see also
Devine-Wright 2009). More studies are needed to evaluate the potential of place
attachment in enhancing public participation at the early stages of planning processes,
and to better understand the relationship between place attachment and social cohesion
in the context of public participation in local planning policy (Lewicka 2011).
4.6 Conclusion
4.6.1 Place-based integration of technical and socio-cultural knowledge
This study showed how insights from the environmental and social sciences are both
pivotal to environmental planning, as they inform different yet interdependent
components of a single project. Analyses distilling human perceptions and emotions
should thus be integrated into the insights and implications of environmental sciences in
a way that is accessible to planners (Manzo and Perkins 2006; Webler and Tuler 2010).
Using mixed methods in this study, we first showed that the flood policy failure in
Como emerged from an approach to flood management that was hydrologically and
socially fragmented, and we argued that this failure constitutes a strong case for the
consideration of flood management as embedded in an integrated and adaptive approach
to catchment management (as recommended by EU 2007). We then showed that forms
of attachment for the Lake and its city shore played a trigger role in the protest
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
109
movement against the flood defence structure in construction; and finally, we discussed
the potential of such attachments to enhance people’s willingness to participate in
decision-making processes.
Meanings and attachments related to particular places constitute a form of experiential
knowledge of these places, which should be given a more central place in the dialogue
between the public and decision-makers in environmental management. The articulation
of an inclusive and relational environmental policy, concerned with the physical and
socio-cultural connections that constitute each place, may be fostered through programs
that interweave scientific and local knowledge such as those described by Swanson et al
(2008) or Selman et al. (2010) whereby local residents and scholars from the sciences,
the humanities and the arts are brought together to engage collaboratively with local
landscapes, in connection with human perceptions and emotions, as well as ecosystem
dynamics.
4.7 Acknowledgements
We wish to thank Malcolm Hollick, Nick Harney and Ron Oxburgh for their critical
reviews of previous versions of this article. We are grateful to the Consorzio dell’Adda
for providing hydro-meteorological data and to Casper Boon for his technical input with
the implementation of the web survey. The support of the newspaper La Provincia di
Como was greatly valued as it provided a way to distribute the survey. Finally, we
would like to thank all the people in Como who contributed to the study by responding
to the questionnaire or discussing the issue in the field. At the time of the study, the first
author was a recipient of an IPRS scholarship funded by the Australian government and
a living allowance funded partly by the Water Corporation of Western Australia and
UWA. Any opinions, findings and conclusions expressed in this material are those of
the authors and do not necessarily reflect the views of the individuals or agencies
acknowledged.
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
110
4.8 References
Altman, I. A. and S. M. Low (Eds.) 1992. Place attachment. Human behavior and
environment. Volume 12. Plenum: New York
Amministrazione communale di Como. 2004. Opera di difesa dalle esondazioni del
Lago nel compartimento di Piazza Cavour – Lungolago. Progetto esecutivo. [Italian]
Augé, M. 1992. Non-lieux, introduction à une anthropologie de la surmodernité. La
Librairie du XXe siècle, Seuil [French]
Barbier, R. 2005. Quand le public prend ses distances avec la participation. Natures
Sciences Sociétés 13:258-265 [French]
Beierle, T. C. and D. M. Konisky. 2001. What are we gaining from stakeholder
involvement? Observations from environmental planning in the Great Lakes.
Environment and Planning C: Government and Policy 19:515 - 527
Bernard, H. R. 2006. Research methods in Anthropology: quantitative and qualitative
approaches – 4th Ed. Altamira: Oxford
Bijlsma, R. M., P. W. G. Bots, H. A. Wolters and A. Y. Hoekstra. 2011. An empirical
analysis of stakeholders’ influence on policy development: the role of uncertainty
handling. Ecology and Society 16(1):51. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol16/iss1/art51/
Brunetti, M., M. Maugeri and T. Nanni. 2001. Changes in total precipitations, rainy
days and extreme events in Northeastern Italy. International Journal of Climatology
21:861–871
Carrus, G, M. Bonaiuto and M. Bonnes. 2005. Environmental concern, regional
identity, and support for protected areas in Italy. Environment and Behavior 37:237-257
Cheng, A. S., L. E. Kruger and S. E. Daniels. 2003. ‘Place’ as an integrating concept in
natural resource politics: Propositions for a social science research agenda. Society and
Natural Resources 16:87–104
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
111
Comerci, V., S. Capelletti, A. M. Michetti, S. Rossi, L. Serva and E. Vittoria. 2007.
Land subsidence and Late Glacial environmental evolution of the Como urban area
(Northern Italy). Quaternary International 173–174:67–86
Consorzio dell’Adda 1990. Regolazione del sistema Lago di Como – Fiume Adda – Usi
irrigui ed idroelettrici. Consorzio dell’Adda: Milano [Italian]
Consorzio dell’Adda. 2010. Statuto del Consorzio dell’Adda – Capo 1 – Scopi e limiti
del Consorzio – Art. 1 [online] URL: http://www.addaconsorzio.it/ [Italian]
Creighton, J. L. 2005. The public participation handbook: making better decisions
through citizen involvement. Jossey-Bass, Wiley: San Francisco
Croce, A., U. Maione, E. Mantovani, U. Messina and S. Zorzi. 1987. Studio per la
soluzione dei problemi conessi con le esondazioni del Lago di Como. Ministero dei
lavori pubblici - Magistrato per il Po: Parma [Italian]
Davenport, M. A. and D. H. Anderson. 2005. Getting from sense of place to place-based
management: An interpretive investigation of place meanings and
perceptions of landscape change. Society & Natural Resources 18(7):625 – 641
Deacon, D., M. Pickering, P. Golding, and G. Murdoch. 1999. Researching
communications. A practical guide to methods in media and cultural analysis. Oxford
University Press: Oxford
de Leeuw, E. D., J. Hox and D. Dillman, (Eds.) 2008. International handbook of survey
methodology. Routledge Academic.
de Vaus, D. A. 2002. Analyzing social science data. Thousand Oaks: London
Devine-Wright, P. 2009. Rethinking NIMBYism: The role of place attachment and
place identity in explaining place-protective action. Journal of Community & Applied
Social Psychology 19 (6):426 - 441
Devine-Wright, P, and Y. Howes. 2010. Disruption to place attachment and the
protection of restorative environments: A wind energy case study. Journal of
Environmental Psychology 30 (3):271-280
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
112
Enserink, B., M. Patel, N. Kranz and J. Maestu. 2007. Cultural factors as co-
determinants of participation in river basin management. Ecology and Society 12(2):24.
[online] URL: http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol12/iss2/art24/
EU. 2000. Directive 2000/60/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council
establishing a framework for the community action in the field of water policy. Official
Journal (OJ L 327). [online] URL: http://ec.europa.eu/environment/water/water-
framework/links/index_en.htm
EU. 2007. Directive 2007/60/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council on the
assessment and management of flood risks. Official Journal L 288, 06/11/2007 P. 0027
– 0034. [online] URL:
http://eurlex.europa.eu/LexUriServ/LexUriServ.do?uri=OJ:L:2007:288:0027:01:EN:HT
ML
Fischer, F. 2000. Citizens, Experts and the Environment: The Politics of Local
Knowledge Duke University Press: USA
Gambetta, D. and G. Origgi, 2009. L-worlds - The curious preference for low quality
and its norms. Oxford Series of Working Papers in Linguistics 1:23
Gandolfi, C., R. Soncini Sessa, D. Agostani, A. Castelletti, D. de Rigo, A. Facchi, B.
Ortuani, F. Pianosi, M. Rienzner, V. Sachero, L. Tepsich and E. Weber. 2007. IWRM in
the Adda basin, Northern Italy. Geophysical Research Abstracts (9)
Gieryn, T. 2000. A space for place in sociology. Annual Review of Sociology 26:463
Godschalk, D. R., S. Brody and R. Burby. 2003. Public participation in natural hazard
mitigation policy formation: Challenges for comprehensive planning. Journal of
Environmental Planning and Management 46(5):733–754
Goldstein, B. 2009. Resilience to surprises through communicative planning. Ecology
and Society 14(2):33. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol14/iss2/art33/
Gosling, S. D., S. Vazire, S. Srivastava and O. P. John. 2004. Should we trust Web-
based studies? American Psychologist 59:93-104
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
113
Grothmann, T., D. Nenz and M. Putz. 2009. Adaptation in vulnerable alpine regions:
lessons learnt from regional case studies. In European Environment Agency (Ed.),
Regional climate change and adaptation: The Alps facing the challenge of changing
water resources (pages 96–108). EEA technical report no 9/2009, European
Environment Agency, Copenhagen. [online] URL:
http://www.eea.europa.eu/publications/alps-climate-change-and-adaptation-2009
Guariso, G., S. Rinaldi and R. Soncini-Sessa. 1986. The management of Lake Como: a
multiobjective analysis. Water Resources Research 22:109-120
Heatherington, T. 2005. ’As if someone dear to me had died’: Intimate landscapes,
political subjectivity and the problem of a park in Sardinia In Milton, K. and M. Svasek.
(Eds.) Mixed emotions – Anthropological studies of feeling. Berg: Oxford
Horton, P., B. Schaefli, A. Mezghani, B. Hingray and A. Musy. 2006. Assessment of
climate-change impacts on alpine discharge regimes with climate model uncertainty.
Hydrological Processes 20:2091-2109
Huitema, D., E. Mostert, W. Egas, S. Moellenkamp, C. Pahl-Wostl and R. Yalcin. 2009.
Adaptive water governance: assessing the institutional prescriptions of adaptive (co-)
management from a governance perspective and defining a research agenda. Ecology
and Society 14(1):26. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol14/iss1/art26/
Huitema, D., C. Cornelisse and B. Ottow. 2010. Is the jury still out? Toward greater
insight in policy learning in participatory decision processes—the case of Dutch
citizens' juries on water management in the Rhine Basin. Ecology and Society 15(1):16.
[online] URL: http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol15/iss1/art16/
Huss, M., S. Usselmann, D. Farinotti and A. Bauder. 2009. Glacier mass balance in the
south-eastern Swiss Alps since 1900 and perspectives for the future. Erdkunde
64(2):119-140
Ingold, T. 2000. The perception of the environment: essays on livelihood, dwelling and
skill. First edition. Routledge: London
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
114
Irvin, R. A. and J. Stansbury. 2004. Citizen participation in decision making: Is it worth
the effort? Public Administration Review 64(1):55
Italian national statistical institute (Istat). 2006; 2009. [online] URL:
http://demo.istat.it/pop2009/index_e.html
Johnson, C., E. Penning-Rowsell and D. Parker. 2007. Natural and imposed injustices:
the challenges in implementing ‘fair’ flood risk management policy in England. The
Geographical Journal. 173(4):374–390
La Provincia di Como. 2009-2010. [online] URL: http://www.laprovinciadicomo.it/
Lebel, L., T. Grothmann and B. Siebenhuner. 2010. The role of social learning in
adaptiveness: insights from water management. International Environmental
Agreements: Politics, Law and Economics 10:333–353
Lewicka, M. 2011. Place attachment: How far have we come in the last 40 years?
Journal of Environmental Psychology 31(3):207-230
Lynch. 2010. Sustainable natural resource management. Cambridge University Press
Mannarini, T., M. Roccato, A. Fedi and A. Rovere. 2009. Six factors fostering protest:
predicting participation in locally unwanted land use movements. Political psychology
30:985-918
Manzo, L. C. and D. D. Perkins. 2006. Finding common ground: The importance of
place attachment to community participation and planning. Journal of Planning
Literature 20:335
Massarutto, A., A. de Carli, C. Longhi and M. Scarpari. 2003. Public participation in
river basin management planning in Italy: an unconventional marriage of top-down
planning and corporative politics. Report of workpackage 4 of the HarmoniCOP
project. [online] URL: http://www.harmonicop.uni-
osnabrueck.de/_files/_down/Italy.pdf
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
115
McDaniels, T. L., R. S. Gregory and D. Fields. 1999. Democratizing risk management:
Successful public involvement in local water management decisions. Risk Analysis
19(3)
McLain, R. J. and R. G.Lee. 1996. Adaptive management: Promises and pitfalls.
Environmental Management. 20(4):437-448
Medema, W., B. S. McIntosh and P. J. Jeffrey. 2008. From premise to practice: A
critical assessment of integrated water resources management and adaptive management
approaches in the water sector. Ecology and Society 13(2):29. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol13/iss2/art29/
Milton, K. 2005. Meanings, feelings and human ecology In Milton, K. and M. Svasek.
(Eds.) Mixed emotions – Anthropological studies of feeling. Berg: Oxford
Mitchell, M. Y., J. E. Force and M. S. Carroll. 1993. Forest places of the heart:
incorporating social places into public management. Journal of Forestry 91(4):32-37
Moisello, U. and F. Vullo. 2011. I massimi annuali di portata dell’Adda a Lecco in
diversi regimi di deflusso. Consorzio dell’Adda - Pubblicazione n. 13 [Italian]
Monti, S. 1900. Inondazioni del lago di Como dal 1431 al 1765 e provvedimenti per
porvi riparo (Archivio di città). Como, Società storica Comense, 1900:128-172.
[Italian]
Moran-Ellis, J., V. Alexander, A. Cronin, M. Dickenson, J. Fielding, J. Sleney H.
Thomas. 2006. Triangulation and integration: processes, claims and implications.
Qualitative Research 6(1):45–59
Nunes Correia, F., M. Fordham, M. da Graca Saaiva and F. Bernardo. 1998. Flood
hazard assessment and management: interface with the public. Water Resources
Management 12:209–227:
Pahl-Wostl, C. 2007. The implications of complexity for integrated resources
management. Environmental Modelling & Software 22(5):561-569
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
116
Pahl-Wostl, C., J. Sendzimir, P. Jeffrey, J. Aerts, G. Berkamp and K. Cross. 2007.
Managing change toward adaptive water management through social learning. Ecology
and Society 12(2):30. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol12/iss2/art30/
Pahl-Wostl, C., J. Sendzimir and P. Jeffrey. 2009. Resources management in transition.
Ecology and Society 14(1):46. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol14/iss1/art46/
Poggi, C. and C. Cantù, 2000. Como e le piene più famose del lago. Pfifferi Ed., E.P.I:
Como [Italian]
Poletta, F. and J. M. Jasper. 2001. Collective identity and social movements. Annual
Review of Sociology 27:283-305
Rydin, Y. and M. Pennington. 2000. Public participation and local environmental
planning: the collective action problem and the potential of social capital. Local
environment 5(2):153-169
Scannell, L. and R. Gifford. 2010. Defining place attachment: A tripartite organizing
framework. Journal of Environmental Psychology 30(1):1-10
Selman, P., C. Carter, A. Lawrence and C. Morgan 2010. Re-connecting with a
neglected river through imaginative engagement. Ecology and Society 15(3):18. [online]
URL: http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol15/iss3/art18/
Stedman, R. C. 2002. Toward a social psychology of place: predicting behavior from
place-based cognitions, attitude, and identity. Environment and Behavior
34:561
Strang, V. 2004. The meaning of water Berg: Oxford
Swanson, F. J., C. Goodrich and K. D. Moore. 2008. Bridging boundaries: scientists,
creative writers, and the long view of the forest. Frontiers in Ecology and the
Environment 6(9):499–504
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
117
Tompkins, E. L. and W. N. Adger. 2004. Does adaptive management of natural
resources enhance resilience to climate change? Ecology and Society 9(2):10 [online]
URL: http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol9/iss2/art10
Toussaint, S. 2008. Kimberley friction: Complex attachments to water-places in
northern Australia, Oceania 78:46-61
Tuan, Y-F. 1977. Space and place: the perspective of experience. University of
Minnesota Press: Minneapolis
Turati, P. and A. Gentile. 1858. Como ed il suo lago – Illustrazione storica, geografica
e poetica del Lario e circostanti paesi. Tipografia Giorgetti: Como [Italian]
Twigger-Ross, C. L. and D. Uzzell. 1996. Place and identity processes. Journal of
Environmental Psychology, 16:205–220
United Nations. 1992. Rio declaration on environment and development. United
Nations Conference on Environment and Development, Rio de Janeiro 3-14 June 1992
Vis et al. 2003. Resilience strategies for flood risk management in the Netherlands.
International. Journal of River Basin Management 1(1):33–40
Webler, T. and S. P. Tuler. 2010. Getting the engineering right is not always enough:
Researching the human dimensions of the new energy technologies. Energy Policy
38(6) 2690-269
Chapter 4. Technical and socio-cultural perspectives on a failed flood prevention intervention
118
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
119
Chapter 5 Fishing nets and data loggers: contributions
of local knowledge to physical limnology
Laborde, S., J. Imberger, and S. Toussaint.
5.1 Abstract
This article shows how local knowledge may be valuably integrated to a scientific
approach in the study of large and complex hydrological systems where data collection
at high resolution is a challenge. This claim is supported through a study of the
hydrodynamics of a large lake where qualitative data collected from professional fishers
were combined with theory to develop a hypothesis that was then verified by numerical
modelling. First the fishers’ narratives were found to describe with accuracy internal
wave motions that were evident in water column temperature records, which built
confidence in their practical knowledge of the lake’s hydrodynamics. Second, local
knowledge accounts emphasised the recurrent formation of mesoscale gyres and return
flows in certain zones of the Lake in stratified conditions, which did not appear in the
physical data due to limitations of sampling resolution. We hypothesised that these
features developed predominantly due to the interaction of wind-driven internal motions
with the lake’s bathymetry, and the earth’s rotation in the widest areas of the basin.
Numerical simulation results corroborated the fishers’ descriptions of the flow paths and
supported the hypothesis about their formation. We conclude that the collaboration
between scientific and local knowledge groups, although an unusual approach for a
physical discipline of the geosciences, is worth exploring in the pursuit of a more
comprehensive understanding of complex geophysical systems such as large lakes.
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
120
5.2 Introduction
The hydrodynamics of stratified lakes is highly relevant to ecosystem governance
(Ostrovsky et al. 1996; Cuypers et al. 2010) and also, in many lakes, to the practices of
professional fishers. While fundamental and applied limnologists collaborate to advance
the field of physical limnology, the potential contribution of fishers’ local practical
knowledge has not been addressed.
Local Knowledge (LK) also known as Traditional Ecological Knowledge (TEK) and, in
some cases, Indigenous Knowledge (Inglis 1993) arises from the way people live and
work in their local environment; it is embedded in their long-standing practices, skills,
traditions and narratives, spanning across a broad range of temporal and spatial scales.
While a few decades ago most research on aquatic environments was conducted on field
sites that were located near the researchers’ university or research centre, today the
advances of telecommunication technologies and international scientific collaboration
allow much of environmental research to be conducted with limited time in the field (a
comparative look at editions from the 1960s and the 2000s of a journal such as
Limnology and Oceanography illustrates this point), limiting at the same time
researchers’ exposure to LK.
In the last decade however, there has been an increasing and explicit academic interest
for LK in the science and governance of environmental systems, particularly in ecology
(Johannes et al. 2000; Calheiros et al. 2000; Gadgil et al. 2003). Despite this trend that
has shown the potential benefits of considering LK in environmental research (Couzin
2007), studies that attempt to do so are still few, especially in the physical sciences,
because: (1) LK is generally qualitative, requiring social science methods to be accessed
and interpreted; and (2) there is no way to quantify the uncertainty of information
obtained through LK, making it difficult to integrate with a natural science framework
(Huntington 2000).
In this article we show how local knowledge may be useful also in the physical
geosciences. We use fishers’ practical knowledge to formulate a hypothesis that, after
validation by numerical modelling, lead to a greater understanding of the
hydrodynamics of a large subalpine Italian lake. The article starts by introducing the
lake, basic aspects of its hydrodynamics and relevant practices of the fishers. We then
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
121
compare some of the heuristics fishers discussed with records of water column
temperature and wind data, to establish the coincidence of the two types of knowledge,
scientific and local, with regard to large scale physical processes in the lake. We then
address some of the fishers’ accounts of recurrent gyres and return flows in certain
zones of the lake, mesoscale hydrodynamic processes that were not evident in the
quantitative data since their spatial scale was smaller than the sampling resolution. We
turn to results from basin-scale numerical modelling simulations to confirm fishers’
observations of these flow features and to discuss their formation. We conclude by
discussing the broader methodological implications of this study for environmental
science.
5.2.1 Lake Como (Lario)
Lake Como is a deep and narrow lake stretching 45 km between the mountain regions
of the Alps and the agro-industrial plains of the Brianza. Its morphology and wind field
are complex as the Lake has three arms that extend respectively north (Alto Lago),
southeast (ramo di Lecco) and southwest (ramo di Como). Regular winds on the Lake
are the Tivano, a light morning northerly wind, and the Breva, an afternoon southerly;
the Vento is a violent and less-predictable northerly wind that may last several days. A
seasonal thermal stratification develops in spring in the lake’s water column,
strengthens throughout summer and persists until late autumn and, most years, also
throughout winter in a weak and deep form (Chiaudani et al. 1986). The zone of rapid
temperature change in the water column (the metalimnion, encompassing the
thermocline that marks the sharpest temperature gradient) that separates the upper
mixed layer (the epilimnion) from the denser bottom layer (the hypolimnion) deepens
through the year, from the near surface in spring to about 15 m in summer, through to
30 to 40 m in autumn (Fig. 29a).
Water column temperature records evidence wind-driven internal waves along the
lake’s thermocline, in particular an internal uninodal vertical seiche (see schematic Fig.
29b) that is triggered by northerly wind events, has a period of about four days in
summer and can lead to large interface displacements (Laborde et al. 2010). Spectra of
isotherms displacements also evidence a higher vertical mode internal wave with a
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
122
phase keyed to the diurnal wind patterns. The lake’s main inflows drain water from
alpine catchments in the north and generally intrude as interflows during the stratified
period, and interplay with wind patterns and the earth’s rotation to foster southward
currents in the lake’s metalimnion that tend to be stronger on the western side of the
basin (Laborde et al. 2010).
5.2.2 Fishers’ practices: free-drifting nets
Small boat professional fishing is carried out in the Lake by about 30 professional full-
time fishers, for a total catch of about 200 tons of fish per year, of which the species of
landlocked shad (agone) and whitefish (coregone) together represent between 75 and
80%. Throughout the stratified period (April to November), the shad is caught within
the epilimnion while the whitefish, a salmonid, is found in the cooler waters of the
lower metalimnion where the temperatures are within its preferred range of 12 to 16
degrees (Fig. 29a). The capture of these species is carried out with large drifting gill
nets (called pendenti and oltane), a common fishing technique requiring consideration
of water motions throughout the upper 30 (in summer) to 50 m (in autumn) of the water
column. The nets are ‘set free’ at dusk, in the middle of the Lake and perpendicular to
the shores, constituting drifting barriers that may be 700 m long and 6.5 m (for the
pendenti) to 9 m high (for the oltane). A weighted ground-line (most often a lead cored
rope) and an upper line tied to regularly distributed surface floats keep each net
vertically extended: by adjusting the string length between the floats and the upper line,
fishers can target different depths and thus different species of fish (refer to Fig 29b for
a schematic representation). The nets are attached to buoys and lights so they can be
followed from shore during the night and located when the fisher comes to recover
them, usually just before dawn. This routine is normally carried out nightly, with
variations in targeted species throughout the year.
Fig. 29 (b) and (c) show the schematics of the nets’ displacement in response to
different types of internal motions in the lake: wind-induced seiches (b) and gyres and
return flows (c). Understanding these motions is part of the fishers’ work: while
minimising the distance to retrieve the nets is not as relevant as it was before most boats
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
123
were equipped with engines (about 40 years ago), the need to avoid entanglement
between nets that were set at different depths by neighbour fishers remains relevant.
Figure 29: Thermal structure of Lake Como and displacement of fishing nets due to internal motions (a) 1-day moving average of water column temperature (shading) in Lake Como averaged across thermistor chains T1 (SW), T2 (N) and T3 (SE) throughout the year 2007; depth of isotherms 12 and 16 (blue lines) representing the preferred habitat of whitefish caught with oltane (b) schematic drawing (section view) of the displacements of two types of drift nets (pendenti for the capture of shad - red nets - and oltane for whitefish - blue nets), due to a wind-driven internal seiche (the dashed line represents the density interface – black at the lower time bound and grey at the upper time bound); top and bottom panels are separated in time by half the wave period. (c) Schematic drawing (map view) of the displacements of nets (oltane) due to gyres and return flows.
5.3 Material and methods
Qualitative data documenting the fishers’ LK of the Lake hydrodynamics were collected
using social science research methods. The first author conducted a three-month period
of ethnographic field work in summer-autumn 2010 that involved participant
observation of the fishers’ practices on and off the boat, in-depth interviewing and
participatory mapping whereby patterns of net paths were drawn by the researcher
and/or the interviewed fisher on an outline of the zone of the Lake relevant to the
fishing practice. The interviews were then transcribed and analyzed, and the maps were
re-examined in light of the corresponding interview and digitised. The research was
approved by the Human Research Ethics Committee of UWA, and informed consent
was obtained from all participants.
The fishers were approached with some a priori knowledge of the lake’s
hydrodynamics (Laborde et al. 2010), which helped to identify the connections between
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
124
local and scientific knowledge, particularly through the fishers’ accounts of well-known
primary processes and the potential scientific interest of other narratives relating to
locally unexplored processes such as the transversal variability of flow patterns. We
suggest that this is an important point for studies that aim to integrate SK and LK: one
‘reads’ local accounts differently in light of scientific results, and the other way around.
Therefore, making the most of interactions with LK holders requires a form of dialogue
between qualitative and quantitative information.
The physical data included wind speed and direction as well as water column
temperature from the water surface to a depth of 150 m, recorded by thermistor chains
at three in-lake stations located at the end of each arm of the Lake (Fig. 30a, black
stars). The temporal resolution was 20 sec and the vertical resolution of temperature
sensors along the chains ranged from 0.25 m near the surface to 20 m in the deep
hypolimnion, allowing a long-term, fine-resolution documentation of the lake’s thermal
structure. Relative humidity, air temperature, short-wave radiation and net radiation
were measured at the northern station, while rainfall was obtained through the regional
Agency for Environmental Protection (ARPA Lombardia), and inflows, outflows and
lake level data through the Consortium for the Adda River (Consorzio dell’Adda).
The lake’s hydrodynamic model was produced using the finite difference Estuary Lake
and Coastal Ocean Model (ELCOM) that solves the Reynolds-averaged Navier–Stokes
equations and scalar-transport equations with the hydrostatic and Boussinesq
approximations (Hodges et al. 2000). The 3D grid of the lake-domain had a horizontal
resolution of 200 m and a vertical resolution ranging from 0.5 m to 86 m, with the finest
resolution from the surface down to 20m and a regular increase to the coarsest
resolution in the deep hypolimnion. The model was initialised with a mean temperature
profile for Jan 1, 2007 00:00 and ran for the full year of 2007 with a time step of 1 min,
solely forced with atmospheric and water fluxes data. This was to assess the model’s
capability to reproduce seasonal variations as well as phenomena occurring over a few
hours such as internal waves, since the qualitative data covered these various timescales.
The reasons for choosing 2007 pertained to data availability. The performance of the
model was evaluated by calculating the set of statistics proposed by Willmott (1982) -
mean absolute error (MAE), root mean square error (RMSE) and index model
performance (d2, should approach unity) – for the water column temperature records
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
125
from the three thermistor chains over the whole year (Table 7). The data matrix was
sub-sampled every 15 minutes to match the model output time series and the model
values were linearly interpolated onto the measurement depths after correction for
variations in water level. Data points deeper than 50 m were removed to avoid
enhancing model performance measures with data from the hypolimnion, which sees
very little temperature change over the year and was not relevant to the analysis carried
out in this article.
Table 7: Set of model performance statistics proposed by Willmott (1982) – Mean absolute error (MAE),
Root mean square error (RMSE) and normalised index of model performance (d2) for model output and
data at T1 (15 depths), T2 (13 depths) and T3 (8 depths)
T1 T2 T3
N 355272 406529 203614
MAE (o C) 0.8244 0.7702 1.0865
RMSE (o C) 1.2043 1.0714 1.4779
d2 [0-1] 0.9825 0.9859 0.9693
After validation, numerical results were extracted for comparison with the fishers’
accounts. The results presented in the frames in Fig. 30b were velocities averaged
between 12 m and 21 m depth, corresponding to temperatures ranging between 12 and
16 degrees for a period ranging from 12 to 16 of July 2007, a period chosen for its
regular and moderate wind forcing (Fig. 30b), strong stratification (Fig. 29a) and
relatively high inflows and outflow – conditions that we hoped would evidence the flow
patterns described by the fishermen. The temperature / depth range corresponds to the
lower metalimnion at this period, where the whitefish were found and the oltane nets
were set. Net depths in arm spans extracted from the interviews confirmed these depths.
Velocities were averaged overnight between 7 pm and 4 am, corresponding to typical
net setting and retrieving times.
To make a qualitative comparison with the flow paths described by the fishermen, the
trajectories of numerical drifters were also simulated using the available algorithms in
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
126
ELCOM for semi-lagrangian, fixed-depth sail drifters (15). The drifters were
rectangular stiff sails 9 m high and 200 m wide, with total weight and drag coefficient
set to 30 kg and 0.5 respectively. The sails were stretching between 12 and 21 m depth
(like the oltane nets), and released at the same location every night at 7 pm and retrieved
the following morning at 4 am. The model calculated the drag force on the drifters using
the velocities at the relevant depths (12 to 21 m) at the location of the drifter’s
horizontal centroid at each time step. The drifters’ width was that of one grid cell, the
weight was an estimate based on fieldwork with the fishermen and the drag coefficient
(cd) was within the range obtained from empirical equations for netting (16).
The cumulative distances travelled by the drifters overnight were comparable to those
reported for the nets in regular conditions (in the order of one kilometre). Inertia had a
limited influence on the drifters’ motion, which was dominated by drag, so the
trajectories were not sensitive to the drifters’ weight. The paths of drifters with varying
cd displayed the same horizontal flow patterns and similar accumulated distances:
increasing cd up to 2, which is very high even for much thicker netting than is
considered here [16], led to increases in the distances travelled overnight by the drifters
that were well within the range of uncertainty associated with the qualitative and
relative nature of the fishers’ accounts of distances travelled by their nets. For example,
doubling cd to 1 led the drifters to travel an average of about 100 m overnight, and a cd
value of 2 led to an increase of about 150m. For comparison, a variability of several
hundred meters was associated with the fishers’ accounts of the average distances
travelled by their nets in common weather conditions.
5.4 Results
5.4.1 Fishers’ knowledge of the lake’s seasons and dominant currents
The fishers’ practical knowledge of: (a) the depth of the seasonal thermocline and
strength of the stratification (data in Fig. 29a), and (b) the existence and period of wind-
induced internal seiches (Fig. 29b), was expressed in the interviews in the form of
‘limnological heuristics’ (quotes Table 8a and b) acquired through the practice of
drifting-net fishing. The depth of the seasonal stratification is a key variable for
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
127
fishermen using oltane nets to catch whitefish, as this species inhabits the lower
metalimnion during the stratified period. Fishermen start setting these nets at about 1.5
m deep in spring and progressively lower the top of the nets, reaching about 30 to 40 m
in autumn (Table 8a, Fig. 29a). The pendenti, set in the epilimnion to catch shad, were
generally reported to travel the fastest and in the direction of the wind, opposite to the
oltane, therefore with the risk of encounter and entanglement between the two types of
nets (Fig. 29b).
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
128
Table 8: Hydrodynamic processes (bold) and corresponding fishers’ heuristics or practices
(a) SEASONAL STRATIFICATION (Fig. 29a)
When you fish for whitefish in April, you set [the top of the nets] at one arm span (’spazza’), because they have always been caught at one arm span, since the world is world … After two months, you catch them at 3 arm spans, 3 ½ even, and then further down and down… (Alto Lago) > Fig. 29a
In summer, if we have nets near the surface or even in the first, say, 20 m, when there is a strong wind the nets travel far and fast; while in winter, even if there is a strong wind … the water ‘runs’ less at the surface: the velocity of the current is smaller, and it doesn’t last as long. (Centro Lago) > Fig. 29a,b
If we set deep nets in August, September or October, at say 60-70 m depth because the whitefish (‘bondella’) starts going down to these depths, if there is a strong wind we retrieve clean nets, so it means that the wind hasn’t moved the water that deep. If we happen to set [the nets] there in January or February they get full of leaves, of algae, so it means that the force of the wind has managed to reach down to these depths (Centro Lago) > Fig. 29a,b
(b) VERTICAL MODE 1 INTERNAL SEICHE (Fig. 29b)
When at the surface [the lake] goes north (‘in su’), underneath it goes south (‘in giù’); when at the surface it goes south; underneath it goes north. (general ‘rule’ stated by several fishermen interviewed) > Fig. 29b
In summer when there is a strong wind the water at the surface follows the wind first, and then it starts moving underneath too, in the other direction. (Centro Lago) > Fig. 29b
When there is the northerly [wind] for a day, the first night the undercurrent always goes north very fast. Then if you get 3 days of wind, the second night it goes south very fast. (Alto Lago) - Yes… it’s like this. But if you set nets near the surface it’s the other way around. And… say there’s a week of wind: when the wind stops, the lake keeps going. (other fisher from Alto Lago – joint interview) > Fig. 29b
(c) TRANSVERSAL VARIABILITY IN FLOW PATTERNS (Fig. 29c)
If I put the nets on the [western] shore of Dongo, or Cremia when there is the Adda, the nets tend to take the current and go [south] towards the Como or Lecco arms. In general they arrive near Bellano and then they turn around. If I set them on our [eastern] side here, they tend to go up north. (Alto Lago) > Fig. 29c, Fig. 30b1
What can happen is that over here, [the current] goes faster, from the middle to there, it goes less, therefore, the net that is set perpendicular to the shore is found rotated in the morning, (Lecco Arm) > Fig 30b5
This point blocks the current (…) one thing we may do if we don’t want the nets to travel too far is to set, say, half the net inside [behind] the point, so that half is stalled while the other half catches the current and it rotates it like this. In the end the current drags [the net] away, but you’ve saved time. (Centro Lago – Como arm) > Fig 30b2
[The lake] turns underneath, does a swirl. It comes [south], turns like this and comes back north on this shore. This is true at the depth of the oltane. If there are two sets of nets for the whitefish near each other and they go south, they might end up way down [south], but one or both may also turn in this embayment and come back towards north, and then turn again and go back towards south... So they may end up more or less where they were set, but in the reverse order! (…) [It is] because there are the points on the shores: where the river has made a promontory by filling up the lake, this causes a vortex. (Lecco arm) > Fig. 30b5
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
129
The characteristics of the seasonal stratification and primary motions such as seiches
may be reasonably well described and predicted scientifically with theory (e.g. Imberger
and Patterson 1990) and few monitoring stations. These processes are documented in
Lake Como (e.g Fig. 29a; Laborde et al. 2010) through three in-lake stations – one at
the end of each of these arms (Fig. 30a, black stars) - that have been recording water
column temperature and meteorological variables since 2006. The fishermen do not
consult these data; their accounts of internal motions (Table 8a and b) corroborated the
temperature records independently, building confidence in their practical expertise of
the lake’s hydrodynamics (see Davis and Wagner 2003).
5.4.2 Observations of net drifting paths and cross-shore flow patterns
The fishermen also described the consistent formation of gyres and return flows in some
areas of the basin (quotes Table 8c; Fig. 29c). These qualitative accounts were
interesting from the perspective of physical limnology, because such features: (1) are
highly relevant to the horizontal distribution of catchment material, thus to the lake’s
ecology; and (2) require sampling at high spatial resolution to be documented
quantitatively. One possible approach to document these flow features in the field is to
use physical drifters, which, in essence, are what the fishing nets were, with the
advantage of being very large and flexible, and to be reset and followed every night in
most areas of the lake.
Fig. 30a shows a qualitative composite of all individual maps produced during
interviews for the zone in which each individual fisher generally said to operate with the
oltane. The blue arrows indicate the dominant direction of the water currents as inferred
from the paths reported as being most frequently followed by the nets overnight (from
sunset to sunrise) in stratified conditions (late spring - summer - autumn) when the nets
are set in the lower metalimnion. This map is only partially valid for ‘common’
meteorological conditions meaning the alternation of a tivano (light northerly wind) in
the morning and a moderate breva (medium southerly wind) in the afternoon, and the
absence of storm winds, especially the vento (strong northerly wind) that changes
circulation patterns by inducing large-amplitude seiching (Fig. 29b).
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
130
Most fishermen highlighted that one could never be sure the nets would follow the
patterns indicated as ‘most likely’, even with the right wind conditions. This is why
professional fishermen follow the displacements of their drifting nets from the shore
throughout the night. Such uncertainty was particularly associated with the areas of the
Centro Lago and the Como arm. They expressed the velocity of nets relative to other
zones, other periods, other depths or other types of nets, and the distance traveled by the
nets varied each night, thus the length of the arrows on the map does not reflect
quantitative differences in velocity. The large scale velocity patterns that were recurrent
in the narratives of fishermen familiar with several zones of the Lake do however
appear on the map: the strongest currents were said to be in Alto lago and Centro lago
as well as the northern part of the Como arm (Fig. 30a (+)), while the southern part of
the Como arm and the Lecco arm were generally described as less prone to strong water
currents (Fig. 30a (-)) except after a strong northerly wind, which reportedly sets the
whole lake in motion. Fishers from different zones of the Lake also emphasised the
relevance of different forcings on the flow patterns: those who fished in the north (Alto
lago) stressed the role of the large inflows (Adda and Mera, Fig. 30a), those in the south
western arm (ramo di Como, the ‘closed’ arm) that of the storm winds and those of the
south eastern arm (ramo di Lecco) that of the outflow regime that is dam-regulated at
the south eastern end of the lake.
5.4.3 Modelling results
The practical observations by the fishermen of transversal variability in the water flows
(Table 8c; Fig. 29c; Fig. 30a) lead to a numerical modelling study to verify and further
describe the formation of these features. The frames on Fig. 30b display the results of a
numerical, three-dimensional hydrodynamic simulation of the Lake for comparison with
the qualitative map (Fig. 30a; see Methods). The velocities were output at depths
corresponding to temperatures ranging between 12 and 16 degrees, where the whitefish
are found at night and the oltane are normally set. Simulated velocities were averaged
overnight between 7 pm and 4 am, corresponding to typical net setting and retrieving
times, for a period in summer (July 12-17) that was chosen for regular wind conditions
corresponding to a ‘common’ pattern of moderate northerly wind in the morning and
southerly in the afternoon (Fig. 30b). Also, the summer stratification was strong and the
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
131
inflows to, and outflow from, the Lake were high at this period (due to snowmelt) so
pronounced current patterns were expected.
Most of the flow features computed by the model (Fig 30b) corroborated descriptions
by the fishers’ (Table 8c, Fig. 30a). The black velocity arrows highlight the presence of
velocities opposing the main current in coves and embayments (Fig. 30b1, 3, 4 and 5),
or caused by larger scale features such as gyres in the widest zones of the Lake (Fig.
30b2). The blue tracks show the paths of numerical drifters that were set to provide
nightly drifting trajectories comparable with the paths of the drifting oltane nets (see
Methods for a description of the numerical drifters). These results evidenced patterns in
the drifting paths night after night, as well as the relative variability from one night to
another.
The main ‘north-south’ flow path in the lower metalimnion was a result of wind forcing,
combined in the north with inflow intrusions and in the southeast with the effect of the
proximity of the outflow. Most return flows reflected the pressure gradients caused by
the winding bathymetry, which was the element generally cited by fishermen to explain
the return flows and gyres (e.g. Table 8c). The Earth’s rotation also played a role in the
west-east variability of the flow by causing stronger velocities along the western shore
of the lake, and in the formation of the large features (gyres) in the widest parts of the
basin (Alto Lago and Centro Lago, Fig. 30b1 and 2) where the internal Rossby radius of
deformation calculated for 12-17 July was comparable to the basin width (~ 3.5 – 4
km).
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
132
Figure 30: Comparison of qualitative map and model results of nightly patterns of metalimnetic motions. (a) Qualitative map of water currents inferred by the displacements of oltane nets, overnight, during the stratified period and in ‘common’ wind conditions (daily alternation of Tivano and Breva): composite of individual maps obtained from interviews and participatory mapping with professional fishermen. (b) Central map: records of wind speed and direction at stations T2 (N), T3 (SE) and T1 (SW) for July 12-17 2007; green and red shadings pertain to the regular winds called Tivano (northerly) and Breva (southerly). Frames: model results of velocities in the metalimnion for July 12 – 17 2007, output every 0.5 m (depth) and 15 min (time), then averaged overnight (7pm – 4am) and depth (12m - 21m). Return flows are highlighted in black. Blue lines are nightly (7pm – 4am) paths of constant-depth numerical sail drifters (one path per night between July 12 -17) set in the lower metalimnion (12m - 21m). Each green cross is the start of a path, each red circle its end. Frame locations are in (a).
5.5 Discussion
The local knowledge of Lake Como’s fishermen about flow patterns in the Lake was
considered through the lens of physical limnology, and the extent of their ‘practical
limnology’ was an interesting finding in itself. From a methodological perspective, the
fishers’ descriptions of mesoscale cross-shore current patterns at depths where they set
nets for whitefish (lower metalimnion) were particularly relevant, as they provided
qualitative information about flow features that were not evidenced in temperature data
records. These accounts elicited our interest and focused a numerical modelling study
that confirmed the occurrence and form of the gyres and return flows described by the
fishermen.
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
133
Further work may be conducted to parse in more detail the formation of each of the flow
features described by the fishers and the model (Fig. 30, frames) in terms of the relative
contribution of wind-driven internal waves, inflows, the bathymetry of the basin and the
Earth’s rotation. This could involve the design of a field experiment focused on zones of
the Lake identified as relevant by LK accounts and modelling results. Our point here is
that qualitative data from local knowledge accounts, combined with processed-based
numerical modelling, provided a solid anchor point to further the study of horizontal
transport in the lake, particularly of mesoscale processes that may have been overlooked
due to their spatial scale by a study solely based on quantitative data.
Scientific Knowledge (SK) aims to explain and predict natural phenomena. Local
practical knowledge emerges from the adaptation of people’s life and work to natural
phenomena through their life-style, history, sociality and everyday practice. LK
therefore, like SK, gets to ‘know’ natural environments. This article does not suggest
that LK can substitute scientific research or provide insights that can be readily
integrated to science, or that it should or can always be integrated into scientific
research projects. We argue however that exposure to LK can foster and complement
environmental science by providing a long-term, situated perspective on processes
occurring in natural systems, which are the field sites of environmental scientists and
the sites of everyday life for LK holders. In so doing, such an approach can assist
environmental scientists in framing hypotheses and designing focused experiments, with
the ultimate aim to produce SK that is verifiable through standard scientific procedures
and easily transferable. We conclude that, when relevant and possible, the intellectual
engagement of scientists’ with other knowledge groups such as LK holders can result in
a more comprehensive scientific understanding of geophysical systems such as lakes.
5.6 Acknowledgements
We first thank the professional fishermen of the Lario (Lake Como) for sharing their
knowledge of the Lake with the first author. We are also grateful to Alberto Negri,
Jason Antenucci, Kenji Shimizu, Giulia Valerio, Ryan Alexander, Nick Harney and
Roman Stocker for their constructive comments on previous versions of the manuscript.
Meteorological and water column temperature data have been provided through the
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
134
Plinius project coordinated by Centro di Cultura Scientifica 'A. Volta' and funded
collectively by the Como Province, Como Town Council, Como Chamber of
Commerce, Cariplo Foundation, Banca Intesa - San Paolo and Pliniana. The first author
conducted the research while benefiting from an International Postgraduate Research
Scholarship funded by the Australian Government through the Department of
Innovation, Industry, Science, and Research, as well as a Postgraduate Award funded by
UWA. The first author also acknowledges the School of Social and Cultural Studies of
UWA for providing research funding to support the fieldwork.
5.7 References
Calheiros, D. F., A. F. Seidl and C. J. A. Ferreira. 2000. Participatory research methods
in environmental science: local and scientific knowledge of a limnological phenomenon
in the Pantanal Wetland of Brazil. Advances in Applied Ecology. 37:684-696
Chiaudani, G., G. Premazzi and G. Rossi. 1986. Problemi e metodi nei piani di
risanamento di tutela e gestione delle risorse dei grandi bacini lacustri. Il caso del lago
di Como. Ingegneria Ambientale 15(9):503:510 [Italian]
Couzin, J. 2007. Opening doors to native knowledge. Science 315 (5818):1518-1519
Cuypers, Y., B. Vincon-Leite, A. Groleau, B. Tassin and J-F. Humbert. 2011. Impact of
internal waves on the spatial distribution of Planktothrix rubescens (cyanobacteria) in an
alpine lake. The ISME Journal (5):580-589
Davis, A. and J. R.Wagner. 2003. Who knows? On the importance of identifying
‘experts’ when researching local ecological knowledge. Human Ecology 31(3)
Furnans, J., J. Imberger, and B. R. Hodges. 2008. Including drag and inertia in drifter
modelling. Environmental Modelling and Software 23: 714-728.
Gadgil, M., P. Olsson, F. Berkes, and C. Folke. 2003. Exploring the role of local
ecological knowledge in ecosystem management: three case studies. Pages 189-209 in
Berkes, F. J. Colding, and C. Folke. (Eds.). 2003. Navigating social-ecological systems:
building resilience for complexity and change. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge.
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
135
Hodges, B. R., J. Imberger, A. Saggio, and K. B. Winters. 2000. Modeling basin-scale
internal waves in a stratified lake. Limnology and Oceanography 45:1603–1620.
Huntington, H. P. 2000. Using traditional ecological knowledge in science: Methods
and applications. Ecological Applications 10(5):1270-1274 [online]
http://www.jstor.org/stable/2641282
Imberger, J., and J. C. Patterson. 1990. Physical limnology. Advances in applied
mechanics. 27:303-473
Inglis, J. T. (Ed.) 1993. Traditional ecological knowledge: concepts and cases.
International program on traditional ecological knowledge. Canadian museum of
Nature.
Johannes, R. E., Freeman, M. M. R. and R. J. Hamilton. 2000. Ignore fishers'
knowledge and miss the boat. Fish and Fisheries. 1(3):257-271
Laborde, S., Antenucci, J. P., Copetti, D. and J. Imberger. 2010. Inflow intrusions at
multiple scales in a large temperate lake. Limnology and Oceanography 55(3):1301–
1312
Ostrovsky, I., Yacobi, Y. Z., Walline, P. and I. Kalikhman. 1996. Seiche-induced
mixing: Its impact on lake productivity. Limnology and Oceanography 41(2):323-332
Shimizu T, Takagi T, Korte, H., Hiraishi T, Yamamoto K. 2005. Application of NaLA,
a fishing net configuration and loading analysis system, to drift gill nets. Fisheries
Research 76:67–80
Willmott, C. J. 1982. Some comments on the evaluation of model performance. Bulletin
of the American Meteorological Society 63:1309-1313
Chapter 5. Contributions of fishers’ knowledge to physical limnology
136
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
137
Chapter 6 The making and meaning of environmental
knowledge: A fisherman, a limnologist, and an Italian lake
Sarah Laborde
The point of the probe is always in the heart of the
explorer: What is my answer to the question of the nature
of knowing? I surrender to the belief that my knowing is a
small part of a wider integrated knowing that knits the
entire biosphere
Gregory Bateson
6.1 Abstract
Environmental knowledge is a theme of concern to current anthropological enquiry,
especially as it interweaves analyses of local and scientific understandings of, and
relationships with, biophysical environments. In this article, a dual ethnographic
engagement with fishers and limnologists enables examination of the production and
enacting of environmental knowledge via water currents in Lake Como, Italy, in the
contexts of lake-based fishing and academic technoscience. Two main points emerge
that have theoretical and methodological implications. First, despite being seemingly
located at different edges of the environmental knowledge spectrum, the
epistemological nature of the fishermen and limnologists’ knowledges does not differ:
local and scientific ways of knowing the Lake emerged from the same form of
engagement via fields of practice conceptualised as taskscapes (after Ingold). Second,
the contrasting natures of these taskscapes facilitate an analysis showing how
knowledge develops ‘in place’. Foucault’s discussion of heterotopias is drawn on to
disentangle the relationship that environmental scientists have with the environment
they work on, through the environment they work in.
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
138
6.2 Introduction
On a cool autumn evening, in a small fishing boat on a large lake, I was staring at a
yellow balloon a few hundred of meters away in the water while trying to help hold the
boat reasonably still near a rocky outcrop on the shore. The engine was off. Alessandro,
the fisherman with me asked: ‘So, what do you see?’ Unsure, I asked whether the
balloon was going down [south]. ‘No, it’s going up, and it’s quite fast’, he replied. I
then thought how much easier it would be to look at the balloon from the sky, a
perspective I was so familiar with after engaging with map-like representations of that
lake for years.
The Lake was the Lario, also known as Lake Como17, which extends three long arms
between the alpine foothills of Lombardy, in northern Italy (Fig. 31). Alessandro is a
professional fisher operating on the Lake; that evening he was evaluating the Lake
current at about 5 m depth, before setting his nets. I had studied the water currents in
that lake as part of a research project in physical limnology18: the need to meet with the
people for whom my study site was a place of daily life and work had drawn me back,
this time as a postgraduate student in anthropology, with the aim of carrying out
ethnographic field work with the professional fishermen of the Lake19.
The intent of this article is to reflect analytically on my dual engagement with ways of
knowing the Lake’s physics and on the notion of environmental knowledge. I present
ethnographic data in the form of two narratives of knowledge in the making, in the
contexts of lake fishing and academic environmental science. The interrelated questions
I address through a comparative analysis are: 1) what does it mean to know an
17 I refer here to the Lake as Lake Como rather than its original name ‘Lario’ because it is how the Lake is now known by most people. I acknowledge a local controversy about the Lake being shared between two provinces (Como and Lecco) but bearing the name of one of them only when being called ‘Lake Como’
18 Physical limnology (from the greek limne: lake) is the study of physical processes (water motions) in inland waters. I also refer to environmental fluid dynamics, which is the more general study of the movements of fluids in the environment
19 I started as a PhD candidate in Environmental Engineering, and became jointly enrolled in Environmental Engineering and Anthropology mid-way through my doctorate
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
139
environment, and 2) how does scientific knowledge both resemble and differ from local
practical knowledge when the focus is on precisely the same environment?
Since I am embedded in the two narratives, as an emerging anthropologist and
environmental scientist, I feel the need to clarify my own epistemological position. A
positivist, if not realist scientific framework came naturally to me through scientific
education and postgraduate research as an environmental scientist in France and
Australia. The field of mechanics, described by Polanyi as a ‘show-case of objectivity’
(1969: 106), is based on Newtonian mechanics, and much research in environmental
fluid dynamics in the last two centuries has relied on the same set of equations (derived
by Navier in 1822). I had quite unconsciously accepted these theories as valid and
approximately true descriptions of some aspects of the world, which in hindsight was
heuristically useful, I believe, as it allowed me to focus on the description and
prediction of natural phenomena without having to question understandings that had
resisted ‘enough’ scrutiny (Latour 2005).
As I became increasingly reflexive overtime about the practice of science and the
limitations of individual disciplines, I also became increasingly interested in
anthropology. A particular attraction was the idea that all productions of knowledge –
including science – are embedded in, and shaped by, socio-cultural contexts (Latour
2005; Barth 2002); a premise on which this article is based. In many ways, my current
position resonates with Escobar’s view that anthropologists have an important role in
‘theorising the ways [nature] is culturally constructed and socially produced, while
acknowledging the biophysical basis of its constitution’ (1999: 2), an emphasis I
develop further below.
Before introducing the study site and the narratives, the concept of environmental
knowledge needs to be clarified. Throughout the argument, I juggle with two common
definitions of environment, calling ‘definition 1’ the most recent use of the term, central
to the practice of environmental science and engineering, which refers to a natural world
that is separate from humans but subject to their actions and interventions. ‘Definition
2’, in contrast, refers to a unique environment in relation to a particular organism. This
dual definition allows, for instance, a scientist to study an Italian lake or another
environment (definition 1) from his or her academic work environment (definition 2)
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
140
that is at a distance from the first (through remote sensing, numerical data analysis etc.),
thereby producing environmental knowledge about places he or she has no direct
relationship with. As for the notion of knowledge, like Barth (2002) I am concerned here
with useful descriptions of, or action in, the world: knowledge that works in the context
of its production and usage. This includes theoretical as well as practical and other ways
of knowing.
Starting from the premise that knowledge is contextual and relational (Polanyi 1969;
Turnbull 2003), my analysis is grounded in the theoretical writings of Tim Ingold
(2000; 2011). I examine the emergence and enacting of knowledge in the context of the
fisher and the scientist’s engagements in fields of practice embedded in their respective
biophysical and social environments, an emphasis that Ingold refers to as a ‘taskscape’
(2000: 194-200). This practice perspective on knowledge has theoretical roots in
phenomenology, and it has been developed by scholars in a wide range of fields from
anthropology and sociology (Bateson 1972; Bourdieu 1972) to philosophy (Varela et al.
1991; Clark 1997), psychology (Lave 1988; Bargh 1999), and neuroscience (Damasio
1994) - with the common underlying aim to dissolve the Cartesian divides between
mind, body, and environment, in theories of knowledge. This approach also provides
theoretical ground for comparative analyses of knowledges in the making that include
technoscience, as it places all traditions of knowledge on an equal footing (Ingold and
Kurttila 2000; Turnbull 2003).
6.3 The Lake
6.3.1 A waterscape
For the poet Shelley, Lake Como resembles ‘a mighty river winding among the
mountains and forests’ (1882: 25). It is a long, narrow and deep lake surrounded by
mountains that channel regular winds and, except in times of exceptional fog, one can
see the opposite shore from anywhere by the Lake. The three arms of the Lake extend
respectively north (Alto Lago), southeast (ramo di Lecco) and southwest (ramo di
Como), for a total of 170 km of winding shoreline (Fig. 31). The lakeshore offers a
combination of open views over the Lake and small places: coves and points, cliffs and
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
141
flats, small valleys and villages. The variation of light and colour, the shadows of the
mountains and the patterns made by the breeze onto the Lake create an ever-changing
landscape.
The lakeshore cities and villages are home to over 180 000 people, three quarters of
which are concentrated in the urban centres of Como and Lecco in the south. In
contrast, most villages count a few hundred inhabitants; they were built on the steep
mountainsides, down to the Lake where a few local boats are berthed in small, protected
docks; and up toward the pasture areas that have returned to forest since small-scale
farming became marginal in the local economy.
The professional fishers, today three or four per village at most, spend long and
demanding hours working on the Lake: they set their nets at sunset and retrieve them
later during the night, most often alone on their boat. They fish principally for whitefish
and shad in the middle of the Lake, with drifting gillnets called oltane (whitefish) and
pendenti (shad). They also catch sedentary fish, mainly perch that are caught with nets
called perseghere.
In 2010, 69 people were holders of professional licenses permitting them to fish in Lake
Como20. My main ethnographic concern was with regular professional fishers operating
daily and all year-round on the Lake, a group of about 30 men between 19 and 78 years
old spread around the Lake. Other license holders operated on small neighbour lakes or
they were retired, seasonal, or family members, specifically women as wives or mothers
who held a license to help with the activity on the land, for instance to clean, prepare,
and sell the freshly caught fish.
6.3.2 A body of water
From the perspective of physical limnology, the Lake is a water body that constantly
exchanges water, heat and momentum with the atmosphere above, resulting in water
movements from the surface down to its depths. The shape of the lakebed and the rivers
20 Data from the Departments of Fisheries of the Como and Lecco Provinces
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
142
flowing in and out of the Lake also influence these movements. Lake Como’s
hydrodynamics (water motions) came under detailed study through a locally managed
project that involved the installation of three in-lake monitoring stations (one near the
end of each arm) with meteorological instruments to record atmospheric data, and
downward chains of sensors to measure water temperature from the surface down to the
depths.
I used these data for doctoral research when based in Perth, Australia to study the
Lake’s hydrodynamics in different weather and seasonal conditions. In particular, in the
warmer months of the year, the Lake stratifies in layers of water with different
temperatures and thus densities. At the interface between these layers, waves can
propagate (like at the interface of water and air) and induce underwater currents that
interplay with other physical processes such as lake inflows. I was working under the
supervision of two academics expert in physical limnology, and also in close contact
with other students focusing on similar topics, albeit at different sites.
Figure 31: Map of Lake Como. Left: regional context (northern Italy and the Alps21); right: outline of the
Lake, the name of the localities correspond to the place where I interviewed one or more local fishers
(apart from Como)
21 photo: NASA
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
143
6.4 Cross-current narratives: fishing and limnology in practice
6.4.1 A note about context and methods
I begin with an overview of how data for this article were collected, contextualised and
angled. The fishing trip described below took place on 27 and 28 of October 2010. It
was one of several trips that I took part in during a three-month period of fieldwork with
the Lake’s fishermen, where I carried out participant observation, ethnographic
interviews and mapping, via a focus on the fishers’ knowledge and interactions with
their physical lake environment. The narrative draws on data recorded on the boat via
notes, photographs and drawings.
The limnologist’s work narrative was reconstructed from my own notebooks, emails
and memories relating to the two years I spent as a PhD student in physical limnology
studying water motions in Lake Como22. I was part of an academic research group
focused on environmental fluid dynamics, giving me the opportunity to interact daily
with other researchers in that field. The account constitutes a description of tasks I
carried out during this period and it is representative of a level of skill corresponding to
late 2008 onwards.
I am embedded in both narratives, as an anthropologist and as a limnologist: the data on
which the stories draw were thus collected at different times, as detailed above.
However the stories could have happened in parallel, one at the Lake, the other at an
Australian university office: there were many nights in 2008-2009 during which my
numerical simulations of the Lake’s hydrodynamics and Alessandro’s nets ran in
parallel with the Lake’s flows.
6.4.2 Fishing the Lake
Alessandro is the son and grandson of fishers. He is the only professional fisher left in
the small village where he lives with his family in the central area of the Lake. The
small harbor (molo) where he keeps his two fishing boats, the family-owned restaurant
22 During November 2007 to December 2009
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
144
that he helps his wife run and the small self-managed fish-processing facility where he
works with a colleague transforming fish caught for retail, are all within walking
distance from his home.
That day, in the late afternoon at the small harbor, Alessandro prepares his nets and his
boat. It is a sunny autumn day with ‘a bit of Vento [strong northerly wind] in the air’, as
he puts it. He has an idea about which nets to set and where, based on his experience
combined with the seasonal conditions, the weather expected for the night, the fishing
regulations, the last few days’ catches and the types of fish needed to supply the shop
and the restaurant. Besides a few whitefish and perch, he needs to catch shad to start
preparing the missultin, a local dried-fish specialty.
While the whitefish are caught relatively deep these days (about 30 m), the shad are
found near the surface during the night. For the sedentary fish (perch), his father and
grandfather had shown him productive fishing spots that he still uses and alternates with
other locations he has found himself, to give the fish schools time to recover between
catches. Water places have names on the Lake, mainly in dialect, which are used for
practical conversations about a fishing trip: they refer to what is, or was, on the shore, or
to stories that happened at these places (for example ‘the little cross’ offshore from a
small chapel, ‘the fatigued willow tree’, ‘the point of David’23).
On this particular morning Alessandro increased the length of string that set the depth of
the oltane because he has found most whitefish caught in the lower part of the nets
yesterday morning. He is now running each series of nets through his fingers to
disentangle any major knot and check the state of the nets. As he goes along he coils the
nets onto aluminium rods, to be later placed on the boat so he has them to hand for
when the setting is to begin. When everything is prepared and the boat loaded,
Alessandro manoeuvres out of the harbor. It is quite late, as he likes to get on the Lake
after the other fishers to see where the other nets have been set and to adapt his work
consequently. Two drift nets carried by different currents (at different depths, like
pendenti and oltane) can tangle and get damaged. In such case, the tacit rule among
fishers suggests that the responsibility lies with the owner of the pendenti; these are the
23 These names are from a fisherman from the Lecco arm
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
145
nets that get most damaged, and they also typically (but not always) travel faster than
the oltane as they are set at shallower depths.
After setting perseghere on the bottom and oltane anchored to the rocky shore, he starts
sailing southward to set the drifting pendenti, which are 6.5 m high and will stretch
roughly between 2 and 10 m depth (Fig. 32). The current cannot be inferred by looking
at the Lake surface. Alessandro’s experience suggests that during most nights on his
side of the Lake this current goes north; he had also given a quick, reflex look at the
long seaweed that grows near the harbor as we left: they were bending toward the north.
He is thus anticipating that his nets will drift north through the night: by setting them a
couple of kilometres south from his home and harbor, it is easier for him to control their
movements and to retrieve them later.
About two kilometres away from San Giovanni, Alessandro sets a drifter improvised
with an old jacket tied to a weight and a balloon to confirm the direction of the current
and get an idea of its velocity (this is the scene that opened this article). It is not
something he does every time, but that day the current seems quite strong. The balloon
is going north rather fast, so Alessandro takes the boat a bit further south and starts by
putting a buoy in the water with the white flashing light that will mark one net
extremity. He then lets the nets run through his hand and into the water as he sails the
boat slowly, accounting for the effect of the breeze and superficial current so that the net
ends up on an imaginary line across the basin (east–west) along hundreds of meters (Fig.
32:3). All fishers initially set their drift nets, attached to lights of different colours and
flashing frequencies, approximately perpendicular to the shores, parallel to each other
and across from the main north–south currents. There is another fisher’s set of nets
further south that, Alessandro explains, is of little concern because it is behind a
peninsula that tends to block the current. There is also another fishing boat north of us. I
can only see a light and hear an engine, but Alessandro knows which fisher it is and
what kind of nets he is setting: they are oltane, attached to a blue flashing light, which
might drift southward.
Because the current is strong near the surface, as also revealed by the resistance of the
floats to the net’s traction, Alessandro removes one float near the eastern extremity of
his series of nets for that part to hang in deeper waters, where the current is slower or
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
146
even contrary to the superficial current (Fig. 32:2). He explains that this is to slow down
the northern progression of the net and to make it rotate, so it can stay longer in the
water without risking an entanglement with nets coming from the north. Alessandro did
not learn this and other techniques he uses to manage the nets in case of strong current
from his forebears who were more reticent to work in strong currents, mainly because of
the much greater relative cost of nets24. He developed them by experimenting and
learning from nights like this one. As he finishes setting the nets, he suggests we meet
around midnight to retrieve them.
From the lakeshore, Alessandro watches the movements of the nets for a while. When
he is reassured that nothing abnormal is happening, he goes to have dinner with his
family. He keeps an eye on the nets through the night, checking the position of the lights
from his house with binoculars, from the harbor, or from the road above if they are
behind a bend of the shoreline. He checks about ten times per night between short
periods of rest; as he had told me on another occasion: ‘It’s better for me to sleep two
hours in the afternoon than to sleep at night. … When I have the drift nets in the Lake, I
go to sleep but I’m not relaxed … I just can’t throw them in and forget about them.’
At 11:30 pm I am out by the harbor. The moon is big and the air is cold. The lights from
the villages and the villas on the lakeshore are reflected in the Lake’s surface. I evaluate
the velocity of the blue flashing light, as I have seen Alessandro and other fishermen do,
by looking at a reference item on the shore aligned with the flashing light (the steeple of
a church, a villa), and then looking again an instant later. The blue nets seem to be
coming south faster and faster. As I become anxious about a possible entanglement,
Alessandro arrives wearing gumboots and a waterproof suit, and I join him on the boat.
The position of the two lights and the visible floats suggests that his series of nets has
rotated clockwise. The blue light is very close now and it appears that the rotation that
he crafted a few hours earlier has prevented an encounter between the two nets (Fig.
32:4).
24 Nets used to be hand-made up until a couple of generations ago. For a diachronic ethnography of fishing in the Lake, including on this topic, see Pirovano (1996, 2003)
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
147
Hoping for a good catch, he gets the white light back on board and starts pulling the net
out at a steady pace with his bare hands to remove the fish from the meshing. The live
shad emit a short gurgling noise as he pulls them out of the net with dexterity; they are
silver with green and purple shades as the scales on their bellies refract the light.
Alessandro’s fishing practice will go on day after day, varying as he attunes it to, among
other things, the changing flows of air and water over and under the Lake surface.
Figure 32: 1. Schematic of nets (pendenti: A and oltane: B) in different currents; 2. Drawing from
notebook (27 Oct 2010) of a view across the nets (approximate east–west cut) that explains the strategy of
removing one float to obtain net rotation; 3. Alessandro setting the nets (picture taken on 27 Oct 2010); 4.
Schematic of the net rotation crafted using the differential currents.
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
148
6.4.3 Modelling the Lake
I am a PhD student in a university research centre focusing on the hydrodynamics of
standing water bodies such as lakes. I sit in an office behind a desktop computer, with a
map of Lake Como on the wall above my screen. To my left is a window with a view
opening on a garden of the university, on my right a student from Venezuela is studying
the coastal ocean of Western Australia, at my back another student from China is
studying a hurricane in the Caribbean Sea. I conduct computer-mediated analyses of
meteorological and lake temperature measurements. I also combine these data with a
three-dimensional hydrodynamic model.
That day, I am about to run another model simulation of the Lake’s hydrodynamics. My
numerical lake is made of thousands of grid cells containing ‘digital water’ whose
properties are calculated by the computer as the simulations run. The grid is based on a
topographic map of Lake Como’s bed (bathymetry, Fig. 33:2), and the number and size
of the cells is a compromise between precision and computational speed. I have set the
horizontal grid size (200 m) and the time period on which the model will run (three
weeks, with a calculation for every minute of [virtual] time, done by the model in a
couple of [actual] seconds) based on the data and results from previous simulations.
On this particular morning I increased the vertical resolution of my grid to try to get the
model to pick up with more precision a feature that looked interesting in the data:
pronounced movement in the temperature structure of the Lake (Fig. 33:1) after a strong
northerly wind. I am now checking the integrity of each of the data series I will use in
the simulation (wind speed and direction, solar radiations, air humidity and temperature,
inflows and outflow). I do so by writing (coding) short scripts with the software matlab
and running the data files through these to check for, and address, gaps and
inconsistencies, and I write the clean data into new files in a standard format that will be
read by the model. Some of the scripts I use were adapted from more senior software
users: by reading through their codes, running them and trying to understand the flow of
ideas and the logic behind them, I have learnt to write my own, and I now would not
want to be handling and processing large matrices of numbers in any other way.
Practically, these tasks correspond to focused sequences of, for example, the following
actions: coding (typing code lines) – running the script: it crashes – finding the error –
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
149
correcting the script – running – plotting – thinking of another way to process or plot the
data – changing the script accordingly – running – plotting etc. This goes on until I am
satisfied that I have seen enough of the data, that they makes sense and are in the right
format. I then place the various data files in the folders for the model to find and
process. I always use the same folder structure to keep things organised; the main layout
came from the more senior student who first showed me how to set up the model, and I
have refined my own organization since. The model I am going to use (called
ELCOM25) has been developed by several generations of researchers in environmental
fluid dynamics, mostly in the research centre where I am now studying. Founded on
accepted fluid dynamics theory, the code is being continuously developed and refined,
which has made it particularly adapted to standing bodies of water like lakes.
When everything is sorted for the numerical simulation, I log on remotely to the
modelling Linux computer, typing my password and the usual commands without
thinking about it – I have been doing it for years now. Before starting, I check whether
there are other people’s simulations running on that machine: too many at once can lead
to a slow run or even to a simulation crashing. The computation should take about eight
hours and I aim to get it running overnight. I have defined a series of curtains through
the Lake, roughly perpendicular to the shores (east–west): the model will output values
of water temperature, velocity and direction in the cells of these curtains at every time
step.
I type in the commands to start the simulation. Lines of a log appear every second or so
on my monitor (Fig. 33:3), proof that my simulation is running; I watch these run down
my screen for a while and when I am reassured that nothing abnormal is happening, I go
home. I then have another look, connecting remotely from my home computer, before
going to sleep hoping that the simulation does not crash during the night.
At about 9 am the next morning I am back in the office. Hoping for good results, I copy
the output files onto my computer, open matlab and I start looking at (plotting) the
results: what matches the field data and what does not, what is potentially interesting,
what looks like an artefact of the model. I try a few different plots to better highlight the
25 Estuary Lake and Coastal Ocean Model
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
150
features that I feel are meaningful, then show them to a more senior researcher who
directs my attention to elements in the results that catch his attention, and suggests ways
I can improve the fit of the model. My practice will go on until my graphs and tables
can be turned and written into a ‘story’ about the Lake’s hydrodynamics (Laborde et al.
2010).
Figure 33. Example of data plot of temperature structure at one location in the Lake, through depth and
time; 2. the Lake’s bathymetry; 3. Extract of model log.
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
151
6.5 Comparative Analysis
6.5.1 Attention, embodiment and the flows of practice
The narratives might seem unnecessarily detailed, however, a focus on the small day-to-
day actions that make up the practices of the two protagonists serves to illustrate the
way knowledge of the Lake is developed and expressed in the two different contexts. It
is clear that Alessandro’s knowledge of the Lake environment is predominantly
instantiated through action: the way he selected and organised his gear on the boat, then
set his nets accounting for the weather, the currents and the movements of nearby
fishers were embedded in his skilled fishing practice (see also Pálsson 1994; Lauer and
Aswani 2009). About 15 thousand kilometres away, on an entirely different continent, I
was focused on my computer screen coding matlab scripts to ‘navigate’ the data, guided
by my previous experience with similar data series and familiarity with my digital
workspace and software toolboxes. These tasks were similar to the preparation of the
fishing gear and the sailing of fishing routes: in both cases, personal practice afforded
the conditions of emergence of knowledge by moving through, and seeing information
in, the Lake and the data; and the way it was enacted by adjusting accordingly, and
intuitively, the course of the boat in one location, and that of the computer code in
another.
Bourdieu (1972) conceptualised the habitus as a personal set of embodied dispositions
that tacitly (and, in the context of skilled practice, helpfully) infuse practice by
underlining and informing patterns of acting, thinking and feeling. It is this ‘sense of the
game’ (Bourdieu 2001: 101 and 1997: 23) that allows the fisher and limnologist to act
in their respective environments (in accordance with definition 2) without the need to
consciously aggregate their perceptions, evaluate their meaning and reason through
appropriate responses. This is not to say that all knowledge embodied in the habitus is
enacted unconsciously, as some critics of Bourdieu have emphasised (e.g. Farnell
2000). Thoughts, intentions and ideas are embedded in practical engagement, even
when habit and skill allow conscious attention to reach out in the taskscape instead of
being reflectively focused on mind activity (Farnell 2000: 408; Ingold 2011: 50). This
confers an adaptive quality to skilled practice that is evidenced in the narratives.
Consider the way Alessandro responded to the presence of another net that he
anticipated would drift toward his, and the process of trial-and-error guided by hunches
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
152
that characterised my computer coding practice. Creative improvisation arose out of
skilled practice, shaped by countless episodes of engagement with the Lake’s currents
and the numerical datasets, and combined with, in each case, an embedded commitment
and intentionality. This line of thought, developed in the collection of essays edited by
Hallam and Ingold (2007) also elucidates how tradition and creativity are, far from
mutually exclusive, two faces of the same token (see also Ingold and Kurttila 2001;
Knudsen 2008).
One may self-consciously reflect on experience and plan future action while disengaged
from it, which might happen for instance upon exposure to new phenomena, ideas, or
the need to argue over knowledge claims26 such as through the writing of an academic
article. These ideas, however, do not emerge from a vacuum but from a history of
practice and, after short instants of self-conscious, detached reflection, they will be
brought to life again, in practice. For instance, the arrival of new fishing gear like echo
sounders might at first lead the fisher to reflecting on its mode of operation and
planning how, when and where to use it, but soon enough it will become ‘just as much a
‘natural sign’, directly sensed, as birds in the air or natural landmarks’ (Pálsson 1994:
918). The same can be said for concepts of physical limnology such as thermocline:
upon first encounters, a science student might spend time reasoning them through
conceptually, but soon they will just be a familiar entity, look a certain way on graphs
and tell them something about the data (see also Roth et al. 2002).
Key to skill development is other people in the taskscape. The majority of fishermen
said they were deeply influenced by the older fishers, and one of them used the term
figli d’arte, which literally translates as children of the art to describe the learning
relationship across generations. It highlights the importance of growing up in place, by
the Lake and, for most (but not all) currently practicing fishermen, in a fishers’
household. Art is a fitting term for the Lake’s fishing activities, emerging
etymologically from skill and craft (Ingold 2001: 17). Listening to stories and seeing the
places and techniques of fishing, while helping more experienced fishers by rowing or
holding nets, leads to the tuning of young fishers’ awareness to their fishing taskscape.
26 Mercier and Sperber (2011) even propose that conscious reasoning is a ‘social competence’ that developed for the purpose of argumentation.
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
153
This process that Ingold calls an education of attention27, is central to his relational
theory of environmental knowledge acquisition (2000: 132-151). Environmental
scientific knowledge is also acquired via an education of the novice’s attention through
textbooks, problem solving exercises and articles, and by following the conceptual and
experimental path of more senior practitioners by integrating and reworking aspects of
these into his or her own practice, as illustrated in the narrative. As Bourdieu observed:
‘[scientific] research is a customary practice that is learnt through example’ (2001:49).
The same can be said, of course, about fishing.
Following Helmreich, ‘water28 is both good to think with and here to live with’ (2011:
138), and a lake is a good metaphor to think about the nature of environmental
knowledge: it seems rather stable and still, its content changing at a small rate by the
input and output of new and old water from known streams; and it appears contained in
the terrain and distinct from the sky above it and the earth below it. In reality, the water
in a lake moves along complex flow lines that respond to the slightest change in the
fluxes (of heat, momentum and water) to and from the atmosphere and the surrounding
terrain. The Lake surface is no fixed boundary; it is always changing and constantly
interacting with its surroundings.
While a limnologist and a fisher may seem to be at different edges of the environmental
knowledge spectrum, the epistemological nature of their knowledges does not differ.
Typing one’s password is like turning the key to start the boat, coding a script like
negotiating a fishing route: all knowledge merges in the flow29 of practice. Their
taskscapes are, however, dramatically different. I now turn to examining how.
27 First developed by James Gibson (Ingold 2000: 22).
28 ‘seawater’ in Helmreich’s article
29 The ‘flow’ metaphor has been used elsewhere in relation to skilled practice, for instance in psychology (Csikszentmihalyi 1997)
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
154
6.5.2 Heterotopias of environmental science
If a fisher and a limnologist engage with the same lake on an everyday basis, they will
engage with different environments, in the sense of definition 2: the fisher will work
with fishing gear, the lake and the sky, whereas the scientist will work with numbers,
computer models and graphs. My experience of physical limnology was almost entirely
mediated by a computer, with the combination keyboard–screen as a form of ‘blind’s
man’s cane’ in the sense of Bateson’s allegory (1972: 465). I am therefore encouraged
to describe the activities carried out in such a research environment as a digital
taskscape, able to stretch through network technologies. I choose to bring the focus here
onto models, and more particularly numerical models that are an increasingly central
feature of much of the work carried out today in the environmental sciences30. Such
models come in various forms (Wainwright and Mulligan 2004: 13-15); those
combining processes already described mathematically to simulate the dynamics of an
environment (such as ELCOM) provide particular foci for my argument.
I first take issue with the common idea that models are abstract representations of
natural systems, a definition that reverts to the questionable ‘mentalist’ divide between
scientific and non-scientific traditions of knowledge. A conceptual or abstract
representation lies altogether in the world of ideas; it suggests that the scientist carries
the lake as a complex object in his or her mind and it does not do justice to the dynamic
and concrete nature of models, or to their epistemic value as a learning tool. It will be
obvious from the narrative that I did not carry in my mind the whole of ELCOM, rather
I learnt from my engagement with it. Along with Knuutila (2005), it think it can thus be
argued that it is not only appropriate, but also intellectually productive, to regard models
as concrete epistemic artefacts with which scientists develop a learning relationship, just
as fishers develop a learning relationship with a lake. A model like ELCOM has
evolved from the work of many scientists and developers, and it continues to grow and
change as different people use and adjust the code to their tasks. Drawing on an original
expression by Stewart Brand, the idea of a model is crystalline while its day-to-day
reality is fluid (Ingold 2011: 314).
30 Academic journals dedicated to environmental models include Environmental modeling and software (Elsevier), Ecological Modeling (Elsevier), Environmental Modeling and assessment (Springer)
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
155
During my limnology studies, ‘my’ Lake Como was as a numerical lake. Using the
model and data available to me, I built and developed a relationship with it like a child
builds a playhouse and then loves to ‘live’ in it. In this sense, the numerical data and
model of the Lake became a form of what Foucault called a ‘heterotopia’, an ‘other
space’ (Foucault 2004). Heterotopias differ from unreal utopias in that they are
‘absolutely real’ (the computer, its screen and keyboard, the ELCOM code) and
‘absolutely unreal’ (the digital lake, the water filling its thousands of rectangular
prisms), as well as ‘absolutely different from all the places that they reflect and speak
about’ (the Lake) (2004: 15).
There are two relevant points to be made about the heterotopic spaces of environmental
science, and particularly models. Firstly, they articulate imperceptible transitions
between virtual and real places and times (Foucault 2004: 17), which can support
reflection and insight, just like a museum, a library or a cinema room31 can do.
Numerical models facilitate contextual shifts between the data to be processed here and
now, and scientific formal knowledge embedded in the code and derived from other
places and times. Second, they are not freely accessible (2004:17). One needs a
background, a password to download the code and/or connect to the computers, and
substantial time to become familiar with a numerical model. Further, the accumulation
of formalised knowledge in models leads to their growth at a rate afforded by increasing
computational power and knowledge formalization, which makes them increasingly
complex and more and more opaque to outsiders, also reflecting a ‘will to enclose’
(time, space, knowledge) that characterises Foucault’s heterotopias (2004:17).
Such models are thus part of protected taskscapes where the scientist can run scenarii
about an environment (definition 1) that is not his or her environment (definition 2). On
a day-to-day basis, these heterotopic taskscapes support the practical and concrete
engagements of many environmental scientists who, as a result, are deeply connected to
these environments that they live and work in (in the sense of definition 2), like local
inhabitants are connected to their own (Bourdieu 1997:170). However, the scientists
31 These examples were cited by Foucault (2004:17)
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
156
remain physically and emotionally distant from the environment they work on (this time
in the sense of definition 1).
6.6 Conclusion
Let us return, once more, to where this article started: the boat by the rocky outcrop on
the lakeshore, the drifting balloon, Alessandro and myself. It should now be clearer why
at this instant I felt like a fish out of water: the lake I was looking at had very little to do
with the numerical lake I had engaged with for years. I knew ‘my’ lake in a way that
was visual and vertical from looking down on maps and graphs, which contrasted with
the multisensory and horizontal view that inhabitants have of the environment they
navigate (Ingold 2011: 233-236).
Local inhabitants of an environment and the scientists who study that environment do
not have fundamentally different ways of knowing the same place. Their cognitive
engagement with their respective taskscapes is of the same epistemological nature, only
these taskscapes differ drastically. In one case the knowledge-generative practice is
embedded in the place-based environment (the Lake), in the other it is embedded in a
largely digital heterotopia that combines some disembodied data from the environment
in focus with formalised, generic knowledge about a type of environment
(environmental fluids and lakes). Through their situated practices, each community
(fishermen and limnologists) becomes familiar with their respective taskscape and, as
Orlove put it, their own ‘imagined countrysides32... that make the area visible and
comprehensible to them’ (1991: 31-32).
This emphasis is not to suggest that scientific environmental knowledge is less, or more,
legitimate than local knowledge. The focus of fundamental natural science on
formalising and displacing knowledge supports the ongoing critical conversations that
confer its accuracy and power (Latour 2005). When this formal knowledge is claimed to
describe a place however, and even more so when these claims are being used to
32 After Anderson's ‘imagined communities’ (Orlove 1991)
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
157
transform that place (for instance through environmental policy) then the knowledge of
local inhabitants should be central to the knowledge-making conversation. In the same
way as critical exchanges among scientists from the same field yet different places
enhances theoretical environmental knowledge, engagement across knowledge groups
about the same place stimulates the shifts in context, articulation and critical evaluation
of arguments that lead to reflexive insight and to a more accurate knowledge of that
place or environment. As illustrated via studies in political ecology showing that many
environmental contests are sustained by opposing knowledge groups failing to
understand each other as they talk about different places (different natures) such an
emphasis is also relevant to politics of the environment (Orlove 1991; Escobar 1999;
Williams 2000; Corrigan 2010).
A connection between and among knowledge groups should and can be found via a
focus on the stories of knowledge in the making, instead of their outcomes.
Environments are made of places, and places are the ‘knots of stories’ (Ingold 2011:
234), which is what confers their meaning and their value (Toussaint 2008). The virtual
places produced by environmental technoscience seem devoid of meaning because the
stories that surround and construct them are covered up and kept in the places where
environmental science is crafted. I have shown that these places, referred to as
heterotopias, are embedded with meaning: stories about moments of excited insight or
of bored routine, data navigation, computer issues, animated meetings – of the practice
of environmental science. These stories are similar to those of the day-to-day life of
‘local knowers’ of an environment, and there is substantial epistemological room to
connect on a human level around these stories of knowledge-in-the-making.
I am cautious when Ingold suggests that a ‘sense of astonishment … is so conspicuous
by its absence in contemporary scientific work’ (2011: 129). It is admittedly absent
from its written products, but the practice of science is full of astonishment.
Environmental fluid dynamics was a particular source of amazement as it provided a
new connection to the ‘fluid world’ through an inspiring way to study lakes, oceans, the
sky and clouds, not as separate entities but as fluid media that stratify, mix and flow, a
way of looking at the world that resonates with Ingold’s latest writings (2010; 2011).
On the other hand, scientists of all persuasions who study environments must articulate
their own histories of practices, habits and motivations, in order to engage with other
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
158
groups who live in the environments they study. Ingold’s call is apposite here: ‘if
science is to be a coherent knowledge practice, it must be rebuilt on the foundation of
openness rather than closure, engagement rather than detachment. ... Knowing must be
reconnected with being, epistemology with ontology, thought with life’ (2011: 129).
6.7 Acknowledgements:
The research for this article was supported by a postgraduate scholarship from the
Australian Government and a postgraduate award from UWA. The School of Social and
Cultural Studies (SSCS) of UWA partly funded the three-month fieldwork in Italy,
while the limnology studies were conducted at, and supported by, CWR. I thank SSCS
and CWR for providing the conditions supporting the writing of this paper. In Italy, I
wish to thank Massimo Pirovano and the fishers of the Lario, especially Alessandro Sala
and his family, for their availability and helpfulness. Finally, I thank Nick Harney who
provided helpful feedback on a previous version of this paper, and Sandy Toussaint for
her help throughout conceptualization, design and writing of this research.
6.8 References
Bargh, J. A. and T. L. Chartrand. 1999 The unbearable automacity of being. American
Psychologist. 54(7):462-479
Barth, F. 2002 An anthropology of knowledge. Current Anthropology 43(1):1-18
Bateson, G. 1972 Steps to an ecology of mind: collected essays in anthropology,
psychiatry, evolution, and epistemology. Chandler: San Francisco
Bourdieu, P. 1972 Esquisse d’une theorie de la pratique. Droz: Geneve
Bourdieu, P. 1997 Meditations Pascaliennes. Seuil: Paris
Bourdieu, P. 2001 Science de la science et réflexivité. cours du Collège de France -
Raisons d'agir: Paris
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
159
Clark, A. 1997 Being there: putting brain, body, and world together again. MIT Press:
Cambridge, Mass.
Corrigan, B. 2010. Different stories about the same place: Institutionalised authority and
individual expertise within topographies of difference. World Anthropologies Network
(WAN) e-journal 5:170-219
Csikszentmihalyi, M. 1997 Finding flow: The psychology of engagement with everyday
life. Basic books: New York
Damasio, A. R. 1994 Descartes' error: emotion, reason, and the human brain. G.P.
Putnam: New York
Escobar, A. 1999 After Nature - Steps to an anti-essentialist political ecology. Current
Anthropology: 40 (1)
Farnell, B. 2000 Getting out of the Habitus: An alternative model of dynamically
embodied social action. The Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute 6(3):397-
418
Foucault, M. 2004 [1967]. Des espaces autres. Empan 2 (54):12-19 [French]
Hallam, E. and T. Ingold (Eds.) 2007. Creativity and cultural improvisation. Berg:
Oxford
Helmreich, S. 2011 Nature/Culture/Seawater. American Anthropologist 113(1):132–144
Ingold, T. 2000 The perception of the environment: essays on livelihood, dwelling and
skill. Routledge: London
Ingold, T. 2010 Footprints through the weather-world: Walking, breathing, knowing.
Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute (N.S.), S121-S139
Ingold, T. 2011 Being Alive. Routledge: London
Ingold, T. and T. Kurttila. 2000 Perceiving the environment in Finnish Lapland. Body
and Society 6(3-4):183-196
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
160
Knudsen, S. 2008 Ethical know-how and traditional ecological knowledge in small
scale fisheries on the eastern Black Sea coast of Turkey. Human Ecology 36:29–41
Knuutila, T. 2005 Models as epistemic artifacts: towards a non-representationalist
account of scientific representation. PhD thesis. University of Helsinki, Department of
Philosophy
Latour, B. 2005 [1987] La science en action. Introduction à la sociologie des sciences,
La Découverte. Sciences humaines et sociales
Lauer, M. and S. Aswani 2009 Indigenous ecological knowledge as situated practices:
Understanding fishers’ knowledge in the western Solomon Islands. American
Anthropologist 111 (3):317–329
Lave, J. 1988 Cognition in practice: mind, mathematics, and culture in everyday life.
Cambridge University Press
Mercier, H. and D. Sperber 2011. Why do humans reason? Arguments for an
argumentative theory. Behavioral and brain sciences 34:57–111
Orlove, B. S. 1991 Mapping reeds and reading maps: The politics of representation in
Lake Titicaca. American Ethnologist 18(1):3-38
Pálsson, G. 1994 Enskilment at Sea. Man. 29 (4):901-927
Pirovano, M. 1996 Pescatori di lago. Storia, lavoro, cultura sui laghi della Brianza e sul
Lario. Ricerche di etnografia e storia, Nr. 5: Cattaneo 2003 Vita da pescatori sulla costa
sud-occidentale del Lario. Tesori di Lombardia – Bellavite
Polanyi, M. 1969 Knowing and Being. University of Chicago Press: Chicago
Roth, W-M. Bowen, G. M., and D. Masciotra. 2002. From thing to sign and ''natural
object'': Toward a genetic phenomenology of graph interpretation. Science Technology
Human Values 27:327
Shelley, P. B. 1882 Select letters of Percy Bysshe Shelley. Edited with an introduction
by Richard Garnett – Kegan Paul, Trench & Co: London
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
161
Toussaint, S. 2008 Kimberley friction: Complex attachments to water places in northern
Australia. Oceania 78:46-61
Turnbull, D. 2003 [2000] Masons, tricksters and cartographers: comparative studies in
the sociology of scientific and indigenous knowledge. Routledge: London
Varela, F. J., E. T. Thompson and E. Rosch. 1991 The Embodied Mind. MIT Press:
Cambridge, MA
Wainwright, J. and M. Mulligan (Eds.) 2004 Environmental modelling: finding
simplicity in complexity. Wiley & Sons: England
Williams, D-M. 2000 Representations of nature on the Mongolian steppe: An
investigation of scientific knowledge construction. American Anthropologist
102(3):503-519
Chapter 6. The making and meaning of environmental knowledge
162
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
163
Chapter 7 Discussion
The world in which one thinks
is not the world in which one lives.
Gaston Bachelard
In this section I discuss the benefits and the limits of the approach that characterises this
thesis. I undertake this work by putting the four papers in perspective as I address a
number of the questions raised in the Introduction.
7.1 A few steps back to start with…
I referred to Giovanni Bertacchi’s work to introduce this thesis by juxtaposing an
extract from his poem with a recent study of Lake Como’s physical limnology. By
putting the two texts ‘face to face’ my aim was to bring the reader’s attention to the
contrasting elements between two ways of describing the Lake and its physical
dimension, a contrast I have been concerned to explore throughout the thesis. To
emphasize the links between such perspectives, I now include another text, written by a
contemporary of Bertacchi: the limnologist Rina Monti33 (1871 – 1937). An extract of a
scientific monograph she wrote in 1924 about Lake Como in relation to fisheries
applications reads as follows:
The currents of the Lario are in general gentle, except at the mouth of the alpine Adda and at the exit of the emissary at the Lecco bridge. The elders assert that the Adda current continues in the middle of the arm between Colico and the Centro Lago: such a notice, very
33 She was one of the international pioneers in the field of limnology, and also the first woman to hold a university chair in Italy (Creese 2004)
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
164
exaggerated, must have originated from the observation made from the top of the Mt Legnone, where on clear days can be recognised the Adda, white of suspended silt, entering via a long stretch in the blue lake.
But then the current damps in the middle of the Colico Gulf and continues almost imperceptible along the western shore down to Como to go back up the opposite shore to Bellagio, turn around the promontory and go back down along the right shore [Limonta to Lecco] of the Lecco lake34.
Much more pronounced are the superficial currents determined by the periodic or local winds, which can have a notable influence to concentrate the superficial plankton in certain gulfs, or to transport far away the so-called voltane, fishing nets set in the lake, very deep, hanging only by floats left free at the mercy of the waters.
(Monti 1924: 19)
My emphases in italics are to highlight that the author, an internationally renowned
limnologist who was not from the immediate Lake Como area (although still from the
Lombardia region, near the Lugano lake), had taken into account not only what the
‘elders’ said around the Lake but also the effect of water motions on the displacement of
fishing nets in Lake Como. The understanding of ‘the elders’ is criticised, but
nonetheless considered, and other local uses and knowledges are linked with physical
phenomena in this text. For instance, she describes the regular wind patterns on the
Lake through a narrative of the way sailing boats carrying merchandise used to take
advantage of them, sailing at night from the north down to the city of Como for the
market, and sailing back during the day toward north, pushed by the ‘Breva’ (Monti
1924: 19).
34 An interesting point particularly for readers familiar with limnology is that the conclusion Monti reaches regarding the fate of the riverine current in the Lake are qualitatively similar to the results presented in Chapter 3 (at the time I had no knowledge of this monograph, which I found in the Como library mid-way through my PhD): the Adda current following the western shore of the southwestern arm with a return current on the eastern shore of the same arm; and along the western shore of the southeastern arm, toward the outflow. It would have been interesting to find out about the methods she used (not detailed in the book) to reach these conclusions.
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
165
This historical text thus easily mixes claims that would have been considered as
expressions of distinct ways of knowing - scientific and local - in the context of today’s
influential epistemologies in the environmental science and management literature, and
of Chapter 5 in this thesis. It illustrates the point that scientific and local knowledge can
and often do intersect or evolve together around elements of divergence and
convergence.
This interpretive point also flows from the analysis developed through Chapter 6, and it
constitutes a first element of response to the questions asked in the Introduction: I have
argued that scientific and local knowledge should not be thought of as different ways of
knowing from an individual, cognitive perspective: they both constitute traditions of
knowledge that emerge through one’s situated engagement in a field of practice (a
physical and social environment) in which one becomes skilled. Scientific and local
fields of practice, or taskscapes, may differ substantially, but they may also intersect and
overlap, for instance in the case of scientists living in the environment they study or
engaging with people who do (as illustrated with Monti’s text above and Chapter 5 of
this thesis), or local knowledge holders using new technologies in their practices35.
Increasingly however, the taskscapes of environmental scientists are numerical and
remote from the physical places they work on, leading to ways of understanding these
environments that often share little resemblance with situated (‘on site’) local
knowledge.
7.2 Useful knowledge – the point is for whom, and how?
In Chapter 6 I chose to theorise these differences in scientific (limnological) and local
(fishing) fields of practices by drawing on the concept and materiality of ‘place’, which
was also my focus in Chapter 4. I return to this matter below. Such a focus led my
original interest away from other analytical angles of analysis that may have been
productive, not least of which the issue of the social organisation of knowledge in
35 During my fieldwork I encountered such cases, for instance the case of a biologist who studies the Lake while also living by its shores and showing a clear love for the place. Also, some of the Lake’s fishers use, for instance, echo-sounders to probe the depth of the Lake and the presence of fish below their boat.
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
166
different fields of practice. Following this line of thought and beyond, but related to, my
thesis emphasis in the development of knowledge through an individual’s practice, the
following questions may then have been asked: What counts as valid lake knowledge
and how is this knowledge used, in the scientific and local cases? Below I introduce a
selection of responses to these questions – my aim in doing so is to acknowledge their
relevance to the argument developed in particular in Chapter 6 and to a lesser extent in
Chapter 4. I also provide a rough sketch of what an analysis of these issues might have
looked like, had I developed this aspect further in the ethnographic inquiry and the
analysis.
Agrawal (1995) stressed that while bodies of knowledge are always useful, they might
not always be useful to the same people – systems of knowledge are anchored in
specific socio-cultural contexts. Academic environmental science is one such context,
which aims to develop and share knowledge about natural environments that is as
generic as possible so that it may be understandable and useful to other scientists and
possibly environmental managers and other social groups. Therefore knowledge
production is geared towards creating and highlighting connections between different
places (e.g. different lakes and estuaries around the world, research institutes and labs)
and, to be recognised as valid, scientific knowledge must generally be peer-reviewed
and published. Beyond the use of text for the transfer of knowledge, there is an
emphasis on the visualisation of data and results through graphs and maps in the world
of academic environmental science. Relevant organisations of labour, hierarchies and
social strategies are developed around the aim to publish and disseminate the knowledge
that is produced (see Latour’s discussion of inscriptions [1990]).
While the day-to-day practice of science consists in creating knowledge that may be
easily communicated, fishing knowledge on Lake Como is more obviously
performative: the aim of fishers’ knowledge about the lake is that it be acted upon. Even
during apprenticeship, most of the learning occurs through observation and a slow
introduction to active participation to lake fishing (beside tasks that require no fishing-
associated expertise, such as rowing), with only occasional questions and explanations
(Field notes e.g. 27 Sept. 2010). After knowledge is acquired through observation,
mentoring and individual practice, it is notable that some of the fishermen’s knowledge
is even purposely protected by silence (or even fibs [‘balle’ Field notes e.g. 02 Nov.
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
167
2010]) from concurrents and sometimes administrators. A fisherman from an older
generation told me once in an emphatic way that he ‘wouldn’t even tell his son what he
catches and where!’ (Field notes 02 Nov. 2010 – his son, now an adult fisherman, had
learnt the trade with him, but this quote demonstrates that the concealment of tricks and
knowledge is openly part of the practice of the Lake’s fishermen). Fishers do not
generally engage in extensive collaboration or communication with their peers or with
administrations - they like to mind and protect their own individual business, confident
of their ancestral knowledge of the Lake and its fish, and, as formulated by Pirovano
(1996:228) of a form of ‘extraterritoriality’ allowed by the lake. Among neighbour
fishers on the lake there is no need to talk much either as very often they ‘know’ at a
glance or from the noise of an engine, who is the fisher setting nets a few kilometres
away and what his next move is likely to be.
The extent of such practical, ‘silent’ knowledge finds its way into the subtle hierarchy
that exists between fishers, which is also related to age, family history, geographical
location on the Lake, amount of fish usually caught and level of (non-)engagement with
local authorities. In contrast with the social hierarchy established in academic science,
some of the oldest fishermen hinted at, and sometimes explicated that in their view the
‘real fishermen’ were those who had left school early - for their experience among full-
time fishers had started sooner. Consider, for instance this quote by a retired fisherman
(who had himself started fishing at 10 years old, at the end of primary school):
The modern (his emphasis) fishers that get subventions from the European Union… They take the subventions… but none can prepare or fix a net anymore, now when there is something wrong they throw them away. (…) The rich fishermen, because now they are rich… there is who is a fisherman and has a restaurant, who is a fisherman and has a shop… There are all accountants. There is not one that stopped school at the end of primary school… They’re all accountants! (Interview 14 Oct. 2010)
Of course the idea of what a ‘real fisherman’ is – and therefore of whose fishing
knowledge is valid, when, where and why – is also dynamic. Like all knowledge it is
constantly evolving, and in Como it is changing for instance in particular for the
younger fishermen through exposure to the findings of the fish biologist monitoring the
fish stocks. This introduces yet another notable example of the way local and scientific
knowledge may interweave in day-to-day fishing practice and culture.
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
168
A similar point about the social and political dimensions of knowledge may be made in
reference to Chapter 4 and the story of the wall on Lake Como. As illustrated by the
data presented in that Chapter, knowledge was used to draw social boundaries. For
instance, to some citizens the idea of belonging to the local community - being a
‘Comasco’ - appeared to be strongly associated with the tacit knowledge of how
important the view of the lake was to the city and its citizens. In these citizens’
comments, the administrators were set outside of these tacit community boundaries as a
consequence of the project’s ignorance of the relevant local body of knowledge.
Likewise, the form of the knowledge available to citizens about the project, most of
which was technical, was itself a boundary and a political statement against any
involvement of the public in the project.
The examination of the relationship between knowledge and power, most notably
explored by Foucault, is an approach that has proven especially useful in the analysis of
environmental conflicts (Escobar 1998; Williams 2000). Within the scope of this thesis,
I am unable to develop here the social-political aspects of knowledge. The descriptions
and analysis introduced above nevertheless suggest that the social organisation of
knowledge production have a major influence on the form of knowledge and the way it
is transmitted and used (see also Barth 2002). It is this social dimension that leads
scientific knowledge to be mainly visual and to be valued for its applicability to many
different yet similar environmental systems (e.g. stratified lakes in general). For the
fishermen knowledge is mainly embodied and difficult to express other than by acting
upon it: its value comes from its direct applicability to the day-to-day job in Lake
Como.
The possibility and usefulness of combining knowledge claims thus depends on the uses
that will be made of that knowledge, the audience to which it is destined and the criteria
that will be used to evaluate and apply it. The four papers that were summarised in the
Introduction and developed in the thesis are to engage readers from different disciplines.
From another vantage point, they speak as a unified whole. I propose below an exercise
that evaluates the outcomes of each one of these papers (Chapters 3 to 6) from the
perspectives of a scientist/engineer, an environmental manager, a local knowledge
holder (fisher, or citizen in the case of Chapter 4) and an anthropologist. These different
viewpoints on the same work project different elements of knowledge, summarised in
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
169
the table below. The bold entries highlight the audience for which each paper was
written.
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
170
Table 9: Possible research outcomes for each of the papers constitutive of the thesis, from the perspectives of a) an environmental scientist/engineer, b) an environmental manager, c)
a local knowledge holder, d) an environmental anthropologist.
Perspective Chapter a) Environmental
scientist/engineer (physical limnologist)
b) Environmental manager c) Local knowledge holder d) Environmental anthropologist
3
Inflow intrusions at
multiple scales in a large
temperate lake
(Limnology and Oceanography)
. Flows paths of inflows of different nature and scales are influenced by the stratification, wind-driven internal waves, basin morphometry and the earth’s rotation in a canyon-shaped stratified lake, and affect transport and mixing of catchment material in the superficial layers of the lake. . Numerical hydrodynamic model performs well in reproducing the internal dynamics of a large stratified lake.
. Changes in inflow regimes, especially due to climate change, may result in changes in lake hydrodynamics. In particular for Lake Como, the flushing in the southwestern arm of the Lake may be affected. . As a first step, the inflows should thus be carefully monitored, as well as precipitations on the catchment and glacier volume. . Occurrence of algae blooms should lead to examination of these variables, to explore the potential connection (as well as others such as temperature and nutrient concentration).
A fisher’s perspective: . It is difficult to see the practical use that could be made of these technical descriptions of lake currents that are bounded in time, especially in relation to fishing. . It is also difficult to see what motivates scientists to conduct such studies, since they have no connection with the Lake and no practical application of their findings. . However, the real-time availability of data showing where the thermocline is could be interesting, since the coregoni are generally caught at that depth and sometimes it is hard to find straight away after strong wind events.
. Direct and local relevance of this study, written in technical language and focused on water currents in a lake in relation to river inflows, is not clear, but it seems to lay in the relationship between these currents and the ecology in the Lake (such as algae blooms). . From the perspective of the anthropology of scientific knowledge, an interesting point is that this paper was conceptualised and written from Perth – remotely from its study site. The use of a numerical model could also be a revealing angle of study. Both points would require ethnographic fieldwork to unravel knowledge claims.
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
171
4
A wall out of place: a
hydrological and socio-
cultural analysis of physical
changes to the lakeshore of Como, Italy
(Ecology and Society)
. The Lake Como catchment should be addressed as a complete hydrological system: ignoring some of its components that are connected to others, such as upstream reservoirs with the rest of the catchment, limits and/or flaws attempt to act on changing the system. . A decision-support system could be developed, including all components of the system, to dynamically allocate optimal water volumes to each component.
. The paper is a case for reforms toward spatially integrated management in the Lake Como catchment (including dialogue with upstream reservoir users), as well as more public participation. . The paper suggests that focusing on the meanings and attachments related to the place to be transformed during the early planning stages may help foster early public participation in environmental management, and avoid the form of NIMBY* reaction described in this case.
*NIMBY stands for ‘Not in my backyard’, a term that is commonly used in the environmental management literature to describe cases such as the social movement in Como
A Como citizen’s perspective: . Diagrams on the fluxes of water through the catchment show some of the constraints for downstream dam managers that are difficult to see from Como. They also highlight that the rain events are getting more intense, which can be observed day-to-day, and that the dam management has actually improved with regard to flood control in the last two decades. . Regarding the reaction to the wall, the connection with attachments to place, social cohesion and political discontent highlighted in the paper is a pretty obvious one. The situation however was more complex, especially the political/financial aspects of it that were not addressed in this study.
The paper adds to the literature describing the role of attachments to place, combined with social and political resentment, and a sense of common identity, in fostering social movements. . A theoretical interest of the paper is that it canvasses literature from environmental psychology, which is an angle that can sometimes enrich environmental anthropology analyses. . A methodological interest is triangulation of socio-cultural data, mixing statistics and text analysis. A limitation is however embedded in the data themselves: expanded ethnographic data would have helped canvass the complexity of the case and draw more useful recommendations from it, especially through an early engagement with different stages of the project.
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
172
5
Fishing nets and data loggers:
contributions of local knowledge
to physical limnology
(PNAS)
. Fishermen have a local understanding of some hydrodynamic processes in Lake Como. . Local knowledge may be useful to physical limnologists by providing them with a perspective on lake hydrodynamics that covers different scales to that covered by the numerical data: in the case study, spatial scales smaller than the resolution of the monitoring probes.
. The hydrodynamic processes described here, gyres and return flows, may be indirectly relevant to lake management through the distribution of nutrients and algae in the lake – but these specific aspects remain to be studied. . However, some zones of more stagnant water are characterised, and may need more water quality monitoring attention. . The paper shows a good performance of the hydrodynamic model over a year: such a model could be a useful tool to determine (for instance) zones of relatively stagnant water that might facilitate algal blooms. . The fishers may be able to contribute more helpful knowledge for lake management, for example with regards to long-term changes in water quality.
A fisher’s perspective: . A computer model was able to reproduce some of the patterns that have always been known by fishermen of the Lake, for individual fishing zones, which is interesting. . The figures show a somewhat fixed picture however, while in reality the currents vary, even if by a small amount, every single night. . This provides a different perspective on things that are known, but may not be useful for the profession: the Lake currents are still, so far, better known from the clues given by the Lake, one night of fishing after another. As one may say ‘practice is still better than grammar’ (Field notes 18 Oct. 2010) from a fishing perspective.
. The paper presents ethnographic data on fishers’ understanding of lake hydrodynamics, which is not common especially for the processes described (a point of ethnoscientific interest). . There are epistemological implications that are not addressed: local and scientific knowledge are treated like very distinct bodies of knowledge, local knowledge is seen as secondary (the primary concern here is science) - the criteria of science are used to assess the validity of local knowledge, embedding a power relationship between traditions of knowledge. . From the perspective of an anthropologist, the ethnographic data lack development and attention to cultural life and nuance cannot be expanded fully; the maps lack a narrative context.
Chapter 7. Discussion: putting individual chapters in perspective
173
6
The making and meaning of
environmental knowledge: a fisherman, a
limnologist and an Italian lake
(American Anthropologist)
. This paper discusses science and fishing as day-to-day practices; it highlights the development of expertise through some form of habituation. . It also stresses the detachment of today’s environmental scientists from the systems they work on. As a reaction, a point may be raised: isn’t such detachment useful to produce science that is objective and neutral?
. If management is the bridging, or at least accommodating, of different perspectives, including, often, local and scientific, then the paper suggests that a focus on ‘place’ and practices may help connect and define common goals.
A fisher’s perspective: . The paper suggests that one learns through imitation, practice, and attunement of the senses to the aspects of the world around relevant to their job. This was known for the profession of fisher, but it is an unusual way to look at that of scientist.
. An epistemological point of interest is the argument, based on substantial data, that both local and scientific knowledge of the lake emerge from the same kind of engagement in fields of practice (or, after Ingold, taskscapes) . A theoretical point is the use of Foucault’s heterotopia to describe the taskscapes of the environmental scientists: writing about a lake but really knowing a largely digital place: the lake’s expression in numbers and graphs. . A practical implication is that a focus on place along with the articulation of scientific practices may help to connect with local knowledge holders ‘in place’.
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
174
The interpretations in Table 9 raise some issues related to the problem of generalization,
and some of the perspectives might be seen as reductive. There are indeed limits to
these readings in the table, as they are my own, looking through the various research
lenses that have led to the production of such different papers as Chapters 3 to 6, and
inspired by my readings and comments from a range of people during these studies. The
point I am trying to make with this table, however, is that different perspectives on the
same work can absorb, indicate and interpret varied information and present a wide
spectrum of knowledge and emphases. Below I develop some of these different
perspectives to consider what might support or challenge their engagement with each
other.
7.2.1 The grammar and the practice36: environmental science and local knowledge
First, it is legitimate to ask why natural scientists and local knowledge holders would
consider working together – and by extension, why local residents and decision-makers
would jointly engage in environmental management (through ‘public participation’).
Indirectly, the question raised from the scientist’s perspective about Chapter 6 asks
whether interaction with local knowledge holders is worthwhile or even desirable, when
the focus is on the production of neutral scientific knowledge – in the sense that it seeks
to describe empirical data as closely as possible while avoiding any bias (for instance,
by local interests).
There are two related issues here embedded in one: the production of environmental
knowledge and its use. With regard to the production of knowledge, my answer to the
scientist (who could be myself) is certainly ‘yes’: when environmental scientists
describe phenomena occurring in a particular environment, they should, when relevant
and possible, engage in a conversation with local knowledge holders. I argue that in the
same way as a critical conversation among scientists within the same field about
different places (through publications, conferences etc.) will result in enhanced
36 ‘Practice is worth more than grammar’ is a common saying that the fishers used when referring to their skill in dealing with the Lake, and their perspective on scientific knowledge (e.g. Field notes 18 Oct. 2010)
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
175
theoretical environmental knowledge, the same kind of critical engagement, this time
about the same place but across various knowledge groups, can deepen situated
environmental knowledge. This point rests on the epistemological foundations
discussed in Chapter 6, and it is illustrated in Chapter 5 from the perspective of
scientific knowledge. An environmental scientist’s research is always biased by the
domain they chose to study, the resolution of the data they work with, the tacit choices
of the ‘issue’ they need to solve, and the hypotheses they decide to test. In this context,
and in the same way as more data about a system is generally more desirable (certainly
at least at the stage of problem-definition) a more pluralistic view of the system through
engagement with local knowledge holders represents an opportunity for the
development of more complete, complex and useful environmental knowledge, rather
than a risk of bias or distraction.
Likewise but from the perspective of local knowledge holders, being exposed to the
perspective of natural science on their environment can help improve practices through
access to some new data, particularly regarding various rates of environmental change.
In the case of the Lake Como fishers, there were no direct or immediate practical
benefits from our interactions that they could implement in their day-to-day practice
(besides, perhaps, to gain access to the address of a website with real-time lake
temperature data), but some of them benefited from an ongoing dialogue with a local
biologist working with fish stocks. One other potential benefit of engagement across
scientific and local traditions of knowledge is that it is likely to make each group more
intelligible to the other, in terms of values, understandings and also socio-political
positions, which can only help relationships with institutions and environmental
management bodies (Chapter 4).
Such engagement is not, of course, always relevant or possible. Sometimes, there are no
local knowledge holders for environmental processes described by scientists (in
particular, but not only, when these processes happen at space and time scales not
accessible by direct human perception – such as in the upper atmosphere, or micro-scale
turbulence in water bodies for instance) and sometimes there are, but it might not be
possible or productive for scientists to engage with them, or vice-versa. Furthermore,
exchanges across traditions of knowledge are not always as easy as in the Como case,
where scientific and local knowledge of the lake rested on cosmologies that were not
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
176
conflicting – the principles of western science being part of the fishermen’s
conceptualisation of nature through their life and education in Italy. Therefore the
interactions and knowledge claims of the fishermen and the French academic that I was
did not unsettle the very foundations of each other’s understandings of the world. When
such destabilisation occurs, it results in a kind of ontological tension that makes
consideration and intelligibility (and thus knowledge-sharing) between traditions of
knowledge more challenging, as documented for example by Corrigan between beliefs
and practices associated with the Dreaming of Aboriginal Australians and the academic
discourses of archaeologists (Corrigan 2010). It follows that beside time and effort (and
sometimes cost, e.g. of field work), a level of awareness and openness to different
cosmologies is often required on both sides for a meaningful exchange between
knowledge groups. Therefore and as reminded by Huntington (2000), integrating local
and scientific knowledge should not be reduced to a token, or part of a common or
standard framework. Its relevance needs to be argued for, and substantiated along the
way. The main point is that in many cases such engagement across traditions of
knowledge is relevant and possible in environmental studies, but it does not always
happen as a matter of course or design.
With regards to the use of environmental knowledge and when political interests are at
stake (i.e. in most cases), the interests and power relationships embedded in multiple
conceptualisations of an environment must be unpacked, for the focus of the exchange
to move from the description and interpretation of empirical data to the political
positions of the different groups and their aims. Public participation in environmental
management requires such clarification of goals and motivations, ‘transparency’ in this
context. In the case of Chapter 4 for instance the lake was clearly part of distinct
realities for the technical experts who had designed the flood protection structure and
for the citizens of Como: the engineers arguably seeing the lake in terms of resources
and risks to be taken advantage of, or addressed; compared with the local residents
seeing it as an integral and essential part of the cityscape, to be preserved. The
acknowledgement of these positions and their complexities should have been a starting
point of a participatory process regarding the flood-prevention project.
Following this line of thought the lake could be conceptualised as multiple (Mol 2002)
as it was numerical in an Australian office (Chapters 3 and 5), fishing grounds for local
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
177
fishermen (Chapters 5 and 6), reservoir for downstream farmers, potential flood risk for
engineers and a vital part of the city for citizens (Chapter 4). As shown in Chapter 6,
people develop a form of connection to their field of practice – in the case explored
here, to their conceptualisation of the lake – that becomes a part of their identity. In
science this may take the form of a passion for one’s work and the artefacts that support
it or that it produces (such as computer programs, models, theories). Bourdieu (1997:10)
calls this engagement illusio, the belief of the practitioner in the issues that have
emerged from, and are specific to, their field of practice (such as physical limnology, or
fishing) and that may appear disinterested to people external from the field. The
difference between scientific and fishing illusio explained for instance the reaction
(retranscribed in table 9) of one fisher to my limnology studies: he acknowledged the
work but could not understand where the motivation to carry it out had come from.
Through a comparable engagement in their fishing practices, the fishermen had
expressed strong meanings and attachments associated with the places where their life
and work unfolded, most notably the Lake. This form of love of the place, intertwined
with habit and practical skill was expressed in the introductory emphasis through
Bertacchi’s poem, evident in my fishers’ interviews, and part of the origin of Como
citizens’ social movement described in Chapter 4. In Como, communicating across
traditions of knowledge meant negotiating a dialectical process between the multiple
visions of the Lake and the places where they had emerged. This topic was explored in
Chapter 6 and I develop the relevance of the notion of ‘place’ further below.
7.2.2 Anthropologists and scientists across traditions of knowledge, within their own,
and ‘in place’
Anthropologists can play a crucial role in fostering, while at the same time taking part
in, a dialogue between various traditions of knowledge. This is the case through their
potential role as socio-cultural interlocutor and translator for local groups, their
commitment to unpacking cultural assumptions that may be taken for granted in various
communities of knowledge (including academic science), and their sensitivity to the
power relations (and their implications) embedded in the relationships between these
groups. These concerns are obvious in the last column of the table as well as in Chapter
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
178
6, and they are crucial in environmental matters that are associated, as noted in the
Introduction, with many contests over knowledge and ownership.
At the same time, anthropologists must be mindful of their own assumptions as they are
of others’ while participating in, or facilitating, cross-disciplinary work. Tensions and
even oppositions that can often be related to different ontological positions along the
realist/relativist continuum have long marked interactions between cultural
anthropologists and natural scientists37. It is beyond the scope of this thesis to explore
the countless variations of ontological positions that have been developed between these
two extremes and their relationship with environmental studies (for a helpful discussion
see Escobar 2010). It is useful to mention here however that the productivity of cross-
disciplinary dialogues involving anthropologists and environmental scientists relies on
their ability to articulate their respective ontological positions and to transform possible
oppositions into productive tensions (Turnbull 2005).
Ontological and epistemological positions are related to theories of ‘place’ and the
ways in which they informed the argument put forward in this thesis. Notions of ‘place’
have been closely associated with environmental studies in my research, in the context
of cross-disciplinary (Chapter 4), inter-disciplinary (Chapter 5) and trans-disciplinary
work (Chapter 6). This was largely the case as I became aware of the value of
enmeshing socio-cultural and environmental research in the complexity of a particular
place and time, and as I explored my own assumptions about reality and knowledge.
The last guiding question in the Introduction raised queries about the role of place in
bridging together traditions of knowledge within and beyond academia, and below I
summarise responses to this question.
‘Place’ is a complex notion, and in the thesis I have drawn on several understandings of
the term anchored in different disciplines. Before engaging in any reflection about place
and as I was working toward Chapter 3, my understanding of place might have been
close to a rough-and-ready physical conceptualisation, possibly similar to Newton’s
37 I purposefully use the term ‘continuum’ rather than the term ‘divide’ that is often found in the literature, because I believe it is helpful to keep the way between these two extremes open to a variety of nuanced positions.
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
179
definition of the concept as ‘a part of space which a body takes up’ (cited in Casey
1997: 144). My idea of it evolved as I thought and read about the socio-cultural
dimensions of place, an evolution that is reflected in the thesis chapters.
Chapter 4 built on an understanding of place that was influenced mainly by the human
geography and environmental psychology literature, and on the idea of a ‘sense of
place’ that surely had a social dimension, but that was mostly described as a connection
that develops between individuals and their physical surroundings. In the relevant
literature, place is described as relational but the focus is on measures and analyses of
individual psychological responses such as attachment and satisfaction with the place
one lives in (e.g. Stedman 2002). Arguably because of its quantitative dimension, this
understanding of place has been taken up in some environmental management studies
and linked for instance to oppositional reactions to environmental changes (e.g. Devine-
Wright 2009).
In Chapter 6, I was interested in the production of place through socio-cultural
practices, a topic that has been addressed in anthropology as a reaction to the ‘erasure of
place’38 (in Escobar’s words) that had resulted from a focus of the discipline on notions
of ‘space’ and ‘networks’ through, for instance, an interest in globalisation (Escobar
2001). Such erasure of place and a focus on space also appeared to be an effect of the
production of ‘place-independent’ knowledge (transferable from place to place) by the
natural sciences. My interest in practice theories of knowledge, pursued in Chapter 6,
brought my attention to phenomenological perspectives on place as a more fluid and
emergent concept than the notion adopted in Chapter 4. In particular through the work
of Tim Ingold (e.g. 2000), it became clear to me that a local, situated component to
knowledge is, so to speak, ‘inescapable’ even for scientists: paraphrasing Escobar’s
expression, knowledge ‘sits in places’39 (2001). My interest was then to expose and
disentangle the relationship that environmental scientists may have with the places
where they produce knowledge and the places about which they produce knowledge, an
attempt that I initiated in Chapter 6.
39 ‘Culture sits in places’ (Escobar 2001)
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
180
Finally, the notion of ‘place’ has an important role to play in the integration of several
traditions of environmental knowledge, as argued in Chapter 4 and as exemplified in
Chapter 5. To be clear, I do not mean by such a focus on ‘place’ to suggest that there is
no value in remote numerical analyses of data from environmental systems – which in
passing would be undermining part of my own work, as constituting for instance the
whole of Chapter 3. To the contrary, this kind of research based on analyses of large
databases uniquely allows scientists and engineers to focus on dominant processes in
environmental systems, and to identify leverage points in the dynamics of these that
would often be impossible to detect at the scales of direct (non-mediated) human
perception. However, and as shown in Chapter 5, such remote knowledge makes sense
beyond the theoretical when it is brought back into place, within a particular
environment’s local complexity. I argued that scientific and local traditions of
knowledge may only be brought together in place and in practice, and anthropological
inquiry may constitute a bridge in that process. I concur with Robinson (2008) who
argued for a type of inter-disciplinarity that is issue-driven and locally anchored. In the
same way as theories of reality only make sense when applied to day-to-day life,
environmental science makes sense ‘in place’.
7.3 Limitations and future work
There are plenty of questions left unanswered, and unasked, by this thesis that aimed to
be an experiment of thinking and practising across, and beyond, disciplines. The main
issue to be raised in this context, I believe, is the fact that various traditions of thought
merged and enacted through my individual research practice40. This personal
engagement across fields means that I have sometimes generalised the perspectives of
natural scientists and anthropologists in a way that can be seen as problematic, for I am
not fully inscribed in either of these traditions of knowledge. At the same time I am
embedded in both, a point that leads to a simplified view of the relationships between
40 This is not to downplay the influence that many people, and especially my supervisors, have had on my thinking within and beyond the two fields canvassed. My only intention here is to highlight the differences between a cross-disciplinary working team, with experts in each of the fields concerned, and a case where such conversations happening, most often, in my own mind.
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
181
various traditions of knowledge: I came later to anthropology but in the last two years of
my candidature I was at once and alternately limnologist and anthropologist, bypassing
many issues of unintelligibility and of contests over power and identity that are often
faced by people working in inter-disciplinary teams of experts (Jolly and Kavanagh
2009; Strang 2009).
Finally, my cross-disciplinary engagement also meant that I was not able to contribute
the depth in each one of these fields that I might have, had I focused on either one of
them for this PhD. The breadth of this thesis is at once its strength and a limitation, and
it is almost certain that readers who are experts in either of the disciplines will find areas
that lack depth. For instance, I could have explored further the origin of the lake gyres
and return flows I describe in Papers 1 and 3: what is the relative influence on their
formation of wind-driven internal waves, of the bathymetry or of the Coriolis force? I
was certainly curious to explore these processes further, but more curious to discuss
their relevance for local people. Likewise in anthropology, readers might find a lack of
development of socio-political issues, which are always relevant to environmental
studies. Anthropologists might also find my generalisations and distinctive uses of
terms of ‘local’ and ‘scientific’ unclear or poorly supported as I risked an
overgeneralisation in order to be able to use these concepts in relation to each other in
my argument, and to facilitate discussion about their differences and similarities. This
qualitative emphasis also applies to the bounded concept of ‘natural environment’,
which I used through the thesis as it is a core concept of environmental science and
engineering, and against which Ingold urged caution (2011: 130-146).
I am aware that a tendency to categorise, and at times fail to contextualise adequately,
may be problematic. In the context of this doctoral study, however, it allowed a
dialogue between fields that typically engage in categorisations with different levels of
caution. Consider water as a metaphor: water in a lake is water whether it is recent or
ancient, flowing fast or slow, and yet for the sake of description, explanation and
application, limnologists distinguish masses of water and call them say, epilimnion,
metalimnion, inflow intrusion etc. These are useful approximations of a complex and
fluid reality. So too the categories of knowledge used in this thesis – they are an
approximation of the complex and fluid reality described by Ingold (2010; 2011) in his
discussions of the ‘fluid world’, and in conceptualisations of knowledge as flows,
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
182
currents and cross-currents that mix, transport, evaporate and precipitate just like water
in and over a lake.
7.4 References
Agrawal, A. 1995. Dismantling the Divide Between Indigenous and Scientific
Knowledge. Development and Change 26:413-439
Barth, F. 2002 An anthropology of knowledge. Current Anthropology 43(1):1-18
Berkes, F. J. Colding, and C. Folke. (Eds.). 2003. Navigating social-ecological systems:
building resilience for complexity and change. Cambridge University Press: Cambridge.
Bourdieu, P. 1997 Meditations Pascaliennes. Seuil: Paris
Casey, E. 1993. Getting back into place: Toward a renewed understanding of the place-
world. Indiana University Press: Bloomington
Casey, E. 1997. The fate of place. University of California Press: Berkeley
Corrigan, B. 2010. Different stories about the same place: Institutionalised authority and
individual expertise within topographies of difference. World Anthropologies Network
(WAN) e-journal 5:170-219
Devine-Wright, P. 2009. Rethinking NIMBYism: The role of place attachment and
place identity in explaining place-protective action. Journal of Community & Applied
Social Psychology 19 (6):426 - 441
Escobar, A. 1998. Whose knowledge, whose nature? Biodiversity, conservation, and the
political ecology of social movements. Journal of political ecology 5
Escobar, A. 2001. Culture sits in places: reflections on globalism and subaltern
strategies of localization. Political Geography 20: 139–174
Escobar, A. 2010. Postconstructivist political ecologies. Pages 91-104 in M. R. Redclift
and G. Woodgate (Eds.) The International Handbook of Environmental Sociology
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
183
Edward Elgar Publishing: Cheltenham, UK
Huntington, H. P. 2000. Using traditional ecological knowledge in science: Methods
and applications. Ecological Applications 10(5):1270-1274 [online]
http://www.jstor.org/stable/2641282
Ingold, T. 2000 The perception of the environment: essays on livelihood, dwelling and
skill. Routledge: London
Ingold, T. 2010 Footprints through the weather-world: Walking, breathing, knowing.
Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute (N.S.), S121-S139
Ingold, T. 2011 Being Alive. Routledge: London
Ingold, T. and T. Kurttila. 2000 Perceiving the environment in Finnish Lapland. Body
and Society 6(3-4):183-196
Jolly, L. and L. Kavanagh. 2009. Working out and working in critical interdisciplinarity.
20th Australasian Association for Engineering Education Conference University of
Adelaide, 6-9 December 2009:709-714
Mol, A. 2002. The body multiple: ontology in medical practice. Duke University Press
Monti, R. 1924. La limnologia del Lario in relazione al ripopolamento delle acque ed
alla pesca. Studi fati sotto la direzione della Prof. Rina Monti. Ministero dell’economia
nazionale. tipografia coop. ‘Luigi Luzzatti’: Roma [Italian]
Pirovano, M. 1996. Pescatori di lago. Storia, lavoro, cultura sui laghi della Brianza e sul
Lario. Ricerche di etnografia e storia , Nr. 5: Cattaneo [Italian]
Robinson J. 2008. Being undisciplined: Transgressions and intersections in academia
and beyond. Futures 40:70–86
Stedman, R. C. 2002. Toward a social psychology of place: predicting behavior from
place-based cognitions, attitude, and identity. Environment and Behavior
34:561
Strang, V. 2009. Integrating the social and natural sciences in environmental research: a
Chapter 7. A discussion: putting the papers in perspective
184
discussion paper. Environment Development and Sustainability 11:1–18
Turnbull, D. 2005. Multiplicity, criticism and knowing what to do next: way-finding in
a transmodern world. Response to Meera Nanda’s Prophets facing backwards. Social
Epistemology 19(1):19–32
Williams, D-M. 2000. Representations of nature on the Mongolian steppe: An
investigation of scientific knowledge construction. American Anthropologist
102(3):503-519
Chapter 8. Conclusions
185
Chapter 8 Conclusions, and a statement about how and
why this thesis might have been different …
Inter-disciplinary work is difficult to evaluate (Strathern 2007), for one may ask: which
criteria should be used for evaluation, and from which discipline? In my Conclusion, I
return to the dialectical process that has been at the centre of thesis developments. In
particular I highlight key epistemological and methodological outcomes – the elements
that can be drawn from interwoven studies into other academic or applied research, and
the variety of meanings attached to these. I conduct the evaluation by attempting to
outline what this thesis would have been like had it been grounded in one discipline
only. I hope to be able to pinpoint key outcomes that can be associated with the inter-
disciplinary and comparative nature of this thesis, and its implications.
In the Discussion I have examined each one of the constitutive papers from different
standpoints, within and beyond academia (Table 9). Consider now two broad academic
perspectives, that of the environmental scientist/engineer, and that of the social
scientist/anthropologist, and their viewpoint on the thesis as a whole. The three
questions that guide this reflective and interpretive Conclusion are the following:
• What would the thesis have looked like had I remained at the CWR only?
• What if I had been a full-time anthropology student from day one?
• What substantive and epistemological insights did the eventual inter-disciplinary
approach add to the thesis’ argument and outcomes?
8.1 A process-focused contribution to physical limnology
In the first case, Chapter 3 would have been just the same. For the next three chapters,
however, things would have most likely taken a different course. PhD theses at CWR
Chapter 8. Conclusions
186
and other environmental engineering departments tend to be focused on natural
processes and phenomena rather than on particular geographic sites. The aim is to
facilitate outcomes that are transferable to others sites, or places, rendering them useful
for other researchers. Thus, for instance, the theses of Shimizu (2008) and Okely (2010)
address specific aspects of lake hydrodynamics via studies conducted in lakes and
reservoirs in Japan, Israel, Australia, Mexico and Kenya. Each project did not rely on
these researchers being physically present at their key research site: in some cases they
did go to conduct a few days of fieldwork, in other cases they did not and relied on the
numerical data collected by others or by automated probes.
Had my focus remained fully within environmental engineering and physical limnology,
it is likely that my studies would have been mostly conducted from UWA in Perth, but
broadened geographically in terms of foci from Lake Como to other lakes. The topic
would have remained concentrated on a sufficiently narrow and unexplored aspect of
lake hydrodynamics, to allow for the development of new knowledge. This could have
been, for instance, the fate of riverine inflows in stratified conditions and its impact on
the mixing and transport of catchment material through water bodies.
Limnology being multi-disciplinary, my thesis could also have remained focused on
Lake Como and linked the hydrodynamics of Chapter 3 with ecological data and
analyses (related to nutrients and phytoplankton), similar to the research conducted by
Hillmer (2007) on the coastal ocean of Western-Australia. In fact this idea was part of
my original project and articulated in a thesis proposal prepared early 2008.
Finally, environmental engineering departments, including CWR, are conducting more
and more research related to environmental management through the development of
decision-support systems. An approach that is often taken consists in the formulation of
an objective function for a given environmental system, composed quantitative
indicators representing ‘ecosystem services’ (that could be the price of water,
concentration of phosphorus in water, hydropower production etc.; e.g. Kristiana 2009),
and this could have been another course for the thesis to follow. In this case, Chapter 4
might have had the same topic, with the same hydrological component and the socio-
cultural component replaced by some quantification of the different objectives related to
lake levels (see for instance the work of Galelli and Soncini-Sessa 2010).
Chapter 8. Conclusions
187
In short, the thesis would have been quantitative, with a stronger and narrower focus on
hydrodynamics (of Lake Como and other lakes), or including connections between
hydrodynamics, aquatic ecology and quantified lake management objectives.
8.2 An in-depth ethnographic inquiry into people’s relationships to Lake Como
If I had been an anthropology student from the outset of my PhD, many things would
have been different too. Firstly, Chapter 3 would not have existed, for that paper is
totally anchored in physical limnology. Neither would Chapter 5 have existed, since the
idea for this paper emerged from the connections between the fishers’ narratives and my
previous knowledge of the Lake’s hydrodynamics.
I would also have spent a longer period, of at least a year, in the ethnographic field.
Assuming I had been in Como when the social movement of the ‘wall’ developed, I
would probably have studied it as it relates strongly to people’s understandings and
relationships with the Lake, and local socio-cultural and political life. I would have
spent much more time conducting fieldwork, talking to different parties involved,
observing and experiencing everyday life, and probably developing a more refined and
nuanced picture of the social movement than described in the socio-cultural section of
Chapter 4. My approach would have been qualitative and my analyses and writing
developed for anthropologists: I might have carried out a questionnaire and statistical
analyses, but only as an auxiliary approach to complement the elicitation and analysis of
ethnographic data.
As for the hydrological part of Chapter 4, I could not have written it had I majored in
anthropology only. I would have had to construct my understanding of these relevant
phenomena on interviews with experts, such as the dam manager. On the one hand such
an approach and more time in the field might have allowed me to have greater contact
with more ‘stakeholders’, such as the hydropower companies running upstream
reservoirs, benefiting a more pluralistic and complex vision of the catchment
management. On the other hand, that vision would have been based on different
people’s perceptions of the phenomena of lake level variation and flood rather than my
own research directly drawn from the numerical data.
Chapter 8. Conclusions
188
Assuming I had still been interested in investigating people’s perceptions and
understandings of the Lake’s physicality and water currents, I might have initiated my
study with the professional fishermen as I did, while also talking to other groups of
people such as lake divers and sailors. The focus on the currents might have led to
discussions about issues more clearly relevant to the fishers such as the fish, the
evolutions of the profession, relationships with fishery management institutions etc.
Indeed, there are not so many things to say about the currents, if one does not have any
prior understanding of patterns of water motions in lakes. Instead of this focus on
physical phenomena I might have developed further the social dimension of the
fishermen’s practices, and Chapter 6 could have then shared parallels with the work of
Pálsson (1994), where a discussion of enskilment encompasses fishers and
ethnographers rather than fishers and limnologist as in my current Chapter 6.
Had an interest in the water currents persisted, which I think is not very likely because it
is not very obviously relevant to the fishers’ lives, I might have approached a physical
limnologist to ask for their perspective on the fishers’ knowledge collected about the
currents (assuming I would have had the idea to map the currents without a natural
science background). Some version of Chapter 5 could have emerged from that
interaction, had it become a collaboration, and then I might have decided to pursue
ethnographic fieldwork in a lake research institute such as CWR. A different version of
Chapter 6 might have been written, with someone else’s limnological knowledge
combined with my anthropological description and analyses. My own contribution to
both those fields of knowledge, however, and thus to a thesis, would have been
qualitative and anchored entirely within a humanities and social science framework.
8.3 More than the sum of its parts?
The first and most obvious outcome of the thesis and the way it eventually turned out is
methodological. Papers 1 to 4 are respectively: mono-disciplinary, cross-disciplinary,
inter-disciplinary and trans-disciplinary. This was a progression from working in one
discipline (Chapter 3) to working in two separate disciplines and juxtaposing outcomes
(Chapter 4), working in two at the same time as a dialectic: one approach shaping the
other (Chapter 5), and finally, adding an enhanced socio-cultural, theoretical and
Chapter 8. Conclusions
189
reflexive emphasis to the picture (Chapter 6). These papers together and independently
illustrate a variety of ways to approach work across disciplines, depending on the nature
of the issue to be addressed. All of these methods enabled the production of substantive
insights, developed in the papers, which could not have emerged from work carried out
in a single discipline.
This leads me to the second outcome, which is epistemological. My data and analyses
have shown, following Ingold (2000) and others, that the experiential knowledge
emerging from fields of practice is a major component of scientific and local knowledge
alike, through socialisation, habituation and enskilment. Accessing the way such
knowledge develops and accumulates is difficult, precisely because it is so embedded in
our day-to-day lives. Conceptualising knowledge as practice allows the researcher,
when exposed to different lines of thought on common issues, to reason through and
make plain these tacit, taken-for-granted aspects their own tradition of knowledge. This
in turn is useful to define common objectives (and solutions) across them, and to jointly
work toward these. My point is that a focus on knowledge as practice is a productive
way to work across traditions of knowledge on complex social and environmental
problems.
Because this claim is based on practice theory and anthropological concepts, it might be
opaque to a non-anthropologist reader. To make this epistemological point in a different
way, it may be helpful to think about this concept through the simple equation (Eq. 8)
proposed by the cognitive scientist and philosopher Joshua Greene (2007):
TD
TI
= f ((WP −WE )2)
Eq. 8
Greene’s caption for this equation is: ‘The optimal ratio of deliberate thinking (Td) to
intuitive thinking (Ti) is a function of the difference between the world we inhabit at
present (WP) and the world we evolved in (WE)’ (2007).
Consider applying this relationship to a researcher, who is expert in a particular
discipline. When the researcher is working in his or her own discipline, their ‘present
world’ (Wp) is very close to the ‘research world’ they evolved in and are familiar with
(WE), thus the right hand side of the equation ((Wp - WE)2) is very small. In this case,
Chapter 8. Conclusions
190
Ingold and other theorists emphasising knowledge as practice and skill would suggest
that the researcher’s work tends to ‘flow’ and to be efficient, and that their thinking
tends to be mainly intuitive as their experience of the context, or ‘educated attention’
(Ingold 2000:22) allows them to be quickly and selectively responsive to the
information they need in their current task. This is consistent with the equation, as it
suggests that intuitive thinking (Ti) is large while the laborious deliberate thinking (Td)
is small, and thus the ratio on the left of the equation is very small, too.
Now what if the researcher is exposed to a ‘research world’ that is not familiar, such as
through inter-disciplinary collaboration? In that case, their unfamiliarity with their
current research context symbolised by the difference (WP –WE) on the right hand side
of the equation increases. The ratio on the left hand side of the equation therefore
increases also, which means that the engagement in deliberate, self-reflexive thinking
(Td) increases over the habitual intuitive thinking that constitutes their tacit disciplinary
expertise. This, I argued, facilitates the researcher’s awareness of their own disciplinary
assumptions, and sets the basis for a reflexive dialogue between disciplines that is
difficult (it doesn’t ‘flow’) but productive. It is also the case of exposure and openness
to other traditions of knowledge through ethnographic fieldwork, and it was certainly
the case for my work as the fishers’ understanding of the Lake’s physics triggered the
reflection that I developed in Chapter 6.
Clearly, what made this thesis more than the sum of its parts was the sometimes-
unsettling dialogue occurring between the different thinking habits that are part of
academic disciplines. Strathern proposed that information-sharing across disciplines
may be a criteria used to assess interdisciplinary work (2007), and my own engagement
in both parties of the dialogue made the exchange continuous, shaping this work from
both sides in the manner of Escher’ ‘Drawing hands’ that were in Chapter 2 (Fig. 5).
To summarise and conclude, this thesis has argued that it is epistemologically
appropriate and practically useful to engage in a dialog between traditions of knowledge
(within and beyond academia) for the production of environmental knowledge and the
resolution of environmental issues that are concrete and situated. In these cases, a
reflexive, trans-disciplinary examination of the social and geographical conditions of
knowledge production across knowledge groups presents an important place to start.
Chapter 8. Conclusions
191
8.4 References
Galelli, S. and R. Soncini-Sessa. 2010. Combining metamodelling and stochastic
dynamic programming for the design of reservoir release policies. Environmental
Modelling & Software 25:209–222
Greene, J. 2007. In Formulae for the 21st century – Edge: World question Center.
http://edge.org/3rd_culture/serpentine07/serpentine07_index.html
Hillmer, I. A. 2007. Scales of interactions between physical processes, primary
producers and nutrients in aquatic ecosystems. PhD Thesis Ph.D - University of
Western Australia, Centre for Water Research
Ingold, T. 2000 The perception of the environment: essays on livelihood, dwelling and
skill. Routledge: London
Kristiana, R. 2010. Sustainability assessment in water management: the application and
development of the index of sustainable functionality on various water resources, PhD
Thesis - University of Western Australia, Centre for Water Research
Okely, P. N. 2010. Interplay of lake motions and processes affecting horizontal
transport in a range of water bodies. PhD Thesis - University of Western Australia,
Centre for Water Research
Pálsson, G. 1994 Enskilment at Sea. Man. 29 (4):901-927
Shimizu, K. 2009. Application of modal analysis to strongly stratified lakes. PhD Thesis
- University of Western Australia, Centre for Water Research
Strathern, M. 2007. Experiments in interdisciplinarity. Social Anthropology 13(1):75-90
Chapter 8. Conclusions
192
Bibliography
193
Complete bibliography
Agrawal, A. 1995. Dismantling the Divide Between Indigenous and Scientific
Knowledge. Development and Change 26:413-439
Akimoto, K., M. Kugori, and M. Kumagai. 2004. Numerical study of a thermally
induced gyre system in Lake Biwa. Limnology 5: 103-114.
Alavian, V. 1986. Behaviour of density currents on an incline. Journal of Hydraulic
Engineering 112: 27-42.
Alavian, V., G. H. Jirka, R. A. Denton, M. C. Johnson, and H. G. Stefan. 1992. Density
currents entering lakes and reservoirs. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering118: 1464-
1489.
Altman, I. A. and S. M. Low (Eds.) 1992. Place attachment. Human behavior and
environment. Volume 12. Plenum: New York
Amministrazione communale di Como. 2004. Opera di difesa dalle esondazioni del
Lago nel compartimento di Piazza Cavour – Lungolago. Progetto esecutivo. [Italian]
Anderson, L. 2006. Analytic autoethnography. Journal of Contemporary Ethnography.
35 (4):373-395
Augé, M. 1992. Non-lieux, introduction à une anthropologie de la surmodernité. La
Librairie du XXe siècle, Seuil [French]
Barbier, R. 2005. Quand le public prend ses distances avec la participation. Natures
Sciences Sociétés 13:258-265 [French]
Bargh, J. A. and T. L. Chartrand. 1999 The unbearable automacity of being. American
Psychologist. 54(7):462-479
Barth, F. 2002 An anthropology of knowledge. Current Anthropology 43(1):1-18
Bateson, G. 1972 Steps to an ecology of mind: collected essays in anthropology,
psychiatry, evolution, and epistemology. Chandler: San Francisco
Bibliography
194
Beierle, T. C. and D. M. Konisky. 2001. What are we gaining from stakeholder
involvement? Observations from environmental planning in the Great Lakes.
Environment and Planning C: Government and Policy 19:515 - 527
Bennett, E. M., G. D. Peterson and L. J. Gordon. 2009. Understanding relationships
among multiple ecosystem services Ecology Letters 12:1394–1404
Berkes, F. J. Colding, and C. Folke. (Eds.). 2003. Navigating social-ecological systems:
building resilience for complexity and change. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge.
Bernard, H. R. 2006. Research methods in Anthropology: quantitative and qualitative
approaches – 4th Ed. Altamira: Oxford
Bijlsma, R. M., P. W. G. Bots, H. A. Wolters and A. Y. Hoekstra. 2011. An empirical
analysis of stakeholders’ influence on policy development: the role of uncertainty
handling. Ecology and Society 16(1):51. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol16/iss1/art51/
Bothelo, D. A., and J. Imberger. 2007. Dissolved oxygen response to wind-inflow
interactions in a stratified reservoir. Limnology and Oceanography 52: 2027-2052.
Bourdieu, P. 1972 Esquisse d’une theorie de la pratique. Droz: Geneve
Bourdieu, P. 1997 Meditations Pascaliennes. Seuil: Paris
Bourdieu, P. 2000 [1997] Pascalian meditations. Stanford University Press: Stanford
Bourdieu, P. 2001 Science de la science et réflexivité. cours du Collège de France -
Raisons d'agir: Paris
Brembilla, G. and A. Valpolini. 1999. Breva e Tivano Motori Naturali. Associazione
culturale L. Scanagatta: Varenna [Italian]
Brookes, J. D., J. P. Antenucci, M. Hipsey, M. D. Burch, N. J. Ashbolt, and C.
Ferguson. 2004. Fate and transport of pathogens in lakes and reservoirs. Environment
International 30: 741-759.
Bibliography
195
Brunetti, M., M. Maugeri and T. Nanni. 2001. Changes in total precipitations, rainy
days and extreme events in Northeastern Italy. International Journal of Climatology
21:861–871
Calheiros, D. F., A. F. Seidl and C. J. A. Ferreira. 2000. Participatory research methods
in environmental science: local and scientific knowledge of a limnological phenomenon
in the Pantanal Wetland of Brazil. Advances in Applied Ecology. 37:684-696
Carmack, E. 1978. Combined influence of inflow and lake temperatures on spring
circulation in a riverine lake. Journal of Physical Oceanography 9: 442-434.
Carmack, E., R. C. Wiegand, R. J. Daley, C. B. Gray, S. Jasper, and C. H. Pharo.
1986. Mechanisms influencing the circulation and distribution of water mass in a
medium residence time lake. Limnology and Oceanography 31: 249-265.
Carrus, G, M. Bonaiuto and M. Bonnes. 2005. Environmental concern, regional
identity, and support for protected areas in Italy. Environment and Behavior 37:237-257
Centre for Water Research (CWR) Website: http://www.cwr.uwa.edu.au/homepage.php
Chen, C., J. Zhu, K. Y. Kang, H. D. Liu, E. Ralph, S. A. Green, and J. W. Budd.
2002. Cross-frontal transport along the Keweenaw coast in Lake Superior. Dynamics of
Atmospheres and Oceans 36: 83-102.
Cheng, A. S., L. E. Kruger and S. E. Daniels. 2003. ‘Place’ as an integrating concept in
natural resource politics: Propositions for a social science research agenda. Society and
Natural Resources 16:87–104
Chiaudani, G., G. Premazzi and G. Rossi. 1986. Problemi e metodi nei piani di
risanamento di tutela e gestione delle risorse dei grandi bacini lacustri. Il caso del lago
di Como. Ingegneria Ambientale 15(9):503:510 [Italian]
Clark, A. 1997 Being there: putting brain, body, and world together again. MIT Press:
Cambridge, Mass.
Bibliography
196
Comerci, V., S. Capelletti, A. M. Michetti, S. Rossi, L. Serva and E. Vittoria. 2007.
Land subsidence and Late Glacial environmental evolution of the Como urban area
(Northern Italy). Quaternary International 173–174:67–86
Consorzio dell’Adda 1990. Regolazione del sistema Lago di Como – Fiume Adda – Usi
irrigui ed idroelettrici. Consorzio dell’Adda: Milano [Italian]
Consorzio dell’Adda. 2010. Statuto del Consorzio dell’Adda – Capo 1 – Scopi e limiti
del Consorzio – Art. 1 [online] URL: http://www.addaconsorzio.it/ [Italian]
Copetti, D., N. Guyennon, L. Valsecchi, G. Tartari, J. Imberger, and J. P. Antenucci.
2008. Western arm exchange enhancement project. Centro Volta Como. Final Report I.
Copetti, D., and N. Salerno. 2006. Meteorology, hydrology and lake hydrodynamics, in
Centro Volta, Como. Rehabilitation of the water quality in Lake Como. Gruppo di
Lavoro Lago di Como. PLINIUS project. [In Italian]
Corrigan, B. 2010. Different stories about the same place: Institutionalised authority and
individual expertise within topographies of difference. World Anthropologies Network
(WAN) e-journal 5:170-219
Couzin, J. 2007. Opening doors to native knowledge. Science 315 (5818):1518-1519
Creighton, J. L. 2005. The public participation handbook: making better decisions
through citizen involvement. Jossey-Bass, Wiley: San Francisco
Croce, A., U. Maione, E. Mantovani, U. Messina and S. Zorzi. 1987. Studio per la
soluzione dei problemi conessi con le esondazioni del Lago di Como. Ministero dei
lavori pubblici - Magistrato per il Po: Parma [Italian]
Csikszentmihalyi, M. 1997 Finding flow: The psychology of engagement with everyday
life. Basic books: New York
Cuypers, Y., B. Vincon-Leite, A. Groleau, B. Tassin and J-F. Humbert. 2011. Impact of
internal waves on the spatial distribution of Planktothrix rubescens (cyanobacteria) in an
alpine lake. The ISME Journal (5):580-589
Bibliography
197
Dallimore, C., J. Imberger, and T. Ishikawa. 2001. Entrainment and turbulence in saline
underflow in Lake Ogawara. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering 127: 937-948.
Damasio, A. R. 1994 Descartes' error: emotion, reason, and the human brain. G.P.
Putnam: New York
Davenport, M. A. and D. H. Anderson. 2005. Getting from sense of place to place-based
management: An interpretive investigation of place meanings and
perceptions of landscape change. Society & Natural Resources 18(7):625 – 641
Davis, A. and J. R.Wagner. 2003. Who knows? On the importance of identifying
‘experts’ when researching local ecological knowledge. Human Ecology 31(3)
Deacon, D., M. Pickering, P. Golding, and G. Murdoch. 1999. Researching
communications. A practical guide to methods in media and cultural analysis. Oxford
University Press: Oxford
De Cesare, G., J-L. Boilat, and A. J. Schleiss. 2006. Circulation in stratified lakes due to
flood-induced turbidity currents. Journal of Environmental Engineering 132: 1508-
1517.
de Leeuw, E. D., J. Hox and D. Dillman, (Eds.) 2008. International handbook of survey
methodology. Routledge Academic.
Dettamanti, P. 2004. Viaggiatori stranieri nel territorio lecchese. In Perego, N. and M.
Pirovano (Eds.) – Patrimoni culturali, ricerce storiche, memorie collettive: Brianza e
Lecchese. Ricerche di Etnografia e Storia 11:183-196. Cattaneo: Oggiono (Lc) [Italian]
de Vaus, D. A. 2002. Analyzing social science data. Thousand Oaks: London
Devine-Wright, P. 2009. Rethinking NIMBYism: The role of place attachment and
place identity in explaining place-protective action. Journal of Community & Applied
Social Psychology 19 (6):426 - 441
Devine-Wright, P, and Y. Howes. 2010. Disruption to place attachment and the
protection of restorative environments: A wind energy case study. Journal of
Environmental Psychology 30 (3):271-280
Bibliography
198
Enserink, B., M. Patel, N. Kranz and J. Maestu. 2007. Cultural factors as co-
determinants of participation in river basin management. Ecology and Society 12(2):24.
[online] URL: http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol12/iss2/art24/
Escobar, A. 1998. Whose knowledge, whose nature? Biodiversity, conservation, and the
political ecology of social movements. Journal of political ecology 5
Escobar, A. 1999 After Nature - Steps to an anti-essentialist political ecology. Current
Anthropology: 40 (1)
Escobar, A. 2001. Culture sits in places: reflections on globalism and subaltern
strategies of localization. Political Geography 20: 139–174
Escobar, A. 2010. Postconstructivist political ecologies. Pages 91-104 in M. R. Redclift
and G. Woodgate (Eds.) The International Handbook of Environmental Sociology
Edward Elgar Publishing: Cheltenham, UK
EU. 2000. Directive 2000/60/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council
establishing a framework for the community action in the field of water policy. Official
Journal (OJ L 327). [online] URL: http://ec.europa.eu/environment/water/water-
framework/links/index_en.htm
EU. 2007. Directive 2007/60/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council on the
assessment and management of flood risks. Official Journal L 288, 06/11/2007 P. 0027
– 0034. [online] URL:
http://eurlex.europa.eu/LexUriServ/LexUriServ.do?uri=OJ:L:2007:288:0027:01:EN:HT
ML
Farnell, B. 2000 Getting out of the Habitus: An alternative model of dynamically
embodied social action. The Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute 6(3):397-
418
Fernandez, R. L., and J. Imberger. 2008a. Relative buoyancy dominates thermal-like
flow interaction along an incline. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering 134: 636-643.
Fernandez, R. L., and J. Imberger. 2008b. Time varying underflow into a continuous
stratification with bottom slope Journal of Hydraulic Engineering 134: 1191-1198.
Bibliography
199
Fischer, H. B., and R. D. Smith. 1983. Observations of transport to surface waters from
a plunging inflow to Lake Mead. Limnology and Oceanography 28: 258-272.
Fischer, H. B., and R. D. Smith. 1983. Observations of transport to surface waters from
a plunging inflow to Lake Mead. Limnology and Oceanography 28: 258-272.
Fischer, F. 2000. Citizens, Experts and the Environment: The Politics of Local
Knowledge Duke University Press: USA
Ford, D. E., and M. C. Johnson. 1983. An assessment of reservoir density currents and
inflow processes. US Army Eng. Waterway Experiment stations. Technical Report E-
83-7.
Foucault, M. 1966. ‘Les hétérotopies’ - Radio conference, France culture: Culture
Française (December 7, 1966)
Foucault, M. 2004 [1967]. Des espaces autres. Empan 2 (54):12-19 [French]
Furnans, J., J. Imberger, and B. R. Hodges. 2008. Including drag and inertia in drifter
modelling. Environmental Modelling and Software 23: 714-728.
Gadgil, M., P. Olsson, F. Berkes, and C. Folke. 2003. Exploring the role of local
ecological knowledge in ecosystem management: three case studies. Pages 189-209 in
Berkes, F. J. Colding, and C. Folke. (Eds.). 2003. Navigating social-ecological systems:
building resilience for complexity and change. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge.
Gagnon, C. A. and D. Berteaux. 2009. Integrating traditional ecological knowledge and
ecological science: a question of scale. Ecology and Society 14(2): 19. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol14/iss2/art19/
Galelli, S. and R. Soncini-Sessa. 2010. Combining metamodelling and stochastic
dynamic programming for the design of reservoir release policies. Environmental
Modelling & Software 25:209–222
Gambetta, D. and G. Origgi, 2009. L-worlds - The curious preference for low quality
and its norms. Oxford Series of Working Papers in Linguistics 1:23
Bibliography
200
Gandolfi, C., R. Soncini Sessa, D. Agostani, A. Castelletti, D. de Rigo, A. Facchi, B.
Ortuani, F. Pianosi, M. Rienzner, V. Sachero, L. Tepsich and E. Weber. 2007. IWRM in
the Adda basin, Northern Italy. Geophysical Research Abstracts (9)
Gieryn, T. 2000. A space for place in sociology. Annual Review of Sociology 26:463
Gill, A. E. 1982. Atmosphere – Ocean dynamics. International Geophysics Series, vol.
30. Academic.
Gini, G. 2000. Centro Lago e altri racconti. Giorgio Fiocchi: Milano [Italian]
Godschalk, D. R., S. Brody and R. Burby. 2003. Public participation in natural hazard
mitigation policy formation: Challenges for comprehensive planning. Journal of
Environmental Planning and Management 46(5):733–754
Goldstein, B. 2009. Resilience to surprises through communicative planning. Ecology
and Society 14(2):33. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol14/iss2/art33/
Goodwin, C. 1995. Seeing in depth. Social Studies of Science 25:237-274.
Gosling, S. D., S. Vazire, S. Srivastava and O. P. John. 2004. Should we trust Web-
based studies? American Psychologist 59:93-104
Greene, J. 2007. In Formulae for the 21st century – Edge: World question Center.
http://edge.org/3rd_culture/serpentine07/serpentine07_index.html
Griffiths, R., and P. F. Linden. 1981. The stability of vortices in a rotating, stratified
fluid. Journal of Fluid Mechanics. 105: 283-316.
Grothmann, T., D. Nenz and M. Putz. 2009. Adaptation in vulnerable alpine regions:
lessons learnt from regional case studies. In European Environment Agency (Ed.),
Regional climate change and adaptation: The Alps facing the challenge of changing
water resources (pages 96–108). EEA technical report no 9/2009, European
Environment Agency, Copenhagen. [online] URL:
http://www.eea.europa.eu/publications/alps-climate-change-and-adaptation-2009
Bibliography
201
Guariso, G., S. Rinaldi and R. Soncini-Sessa. 1986. The management of Lake Como: a
multiobjective analysis. Water Resources Research 22:109-120
Haggan, N., B. Neis and I. G. Baird (Eds.). 2007. Fishers’ knowledge in fisheries
science and management. Edited by Coastal Management Sourcebooks - UNESCO
Publishing: Paris
Hallam, E. and T. Ingold (Eds.) 2007. Creativity and cultural improvisation. Berg:
Oxford
Hamblin, P., and P. E. Carmack. 1978. River-induced currents in a fjord lake. Journal of
Geophysical Research. 83: 885-899.
Harper, K. M. 2001. Introduction: The environment as master narrative: discourse and
identity in environmental problems. Anthropological Quarterly 74.3
Heatherington, T. 2005. ’As if someone dear to me had died’: Intimate landscapes,
political subjectivity and the problem of a park in Sardinia In Milton, K. and M. Svasek.
(Eds.) Mixed emotions – Anthropological studies of feeling. Berg: Oxford
Hebbert, B., J. Patterson, I. Loh, and J. Imberger. 1979. Collie River underflow into the
Wellington Reservoir. Journal of the Hydraulics Division - ASCE 105: 533-545.
Helmreich, S. 2011 Nature/Culture/Seawater. American Anthropologist 113(1):132–144
Hillmer, I. A. 2007. Scales of interactions between physical processes, primary
producers and nutrients in aquatic ecosystems. PhD Thesis Ph.D - University of
Western Australia, Centre for Water Research
Hodges, B. R., J. Imberger, A. Saggio, and K. B. Winters. 2000. Modeling basin-scale
internal waves in a stratified lake. Limnology and Oceanography 45:1603–1620.
Horton, P., B. Schaefli, A. Mezghani, B. Hingray and A. Musy. 2006. Assessment of
climate-change impacts on alpine discharge regimes with climate model uncertainty.
Hydrological Processes 20:2091-2109
Bibliography
202
Huitema, D., E. Mostert, W. Egas, S. Moellenkamp, C. Pahl-Wostl and R. Yalcin. 2009.
Adaptive water governance: assessing the institutional prescriptions of adaptive (co-)
management from a governance perspective and defining a research agenda. Ecology
and Society 14(1):26. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol14/iss1/art26/
Huitema, D., C. Cornelisse and B. Ottow. 2010. Is the jury still out? Toward greater
insight in policy learning in participatory decision processes—the case of Dutch
citizens' juries on water management in the Rhine Basin. Ecology and Society 15(1):16.
[online] URL: http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol15/iss1/art16/
Huntington, H. P. 2000. Using traditional ecological knowledge in science: Methods
and applications. Ecological Applications 10(5):1270-1274 [online]
http://www.jstor.org/stable/2641282
Huss, M., S. Usselmann, D. Farinotti and A. Bauder. 2009. Glacier mass balance in the
south-eastern Swiss Alps since 1900 and perspectives for the future. Erdkunde
64(2):119-140
Imberger, J., and J. C. Patterson. 1990. Physical limnology. Advances in applied
mechanics. 27:303-473
Inglis, J. T. (Ed.) 1993. Traditional ecological knowledge: concepts and cases.
International program on traditional ecological knowledge. Canadian museum of
Nature.
Ingold, T. 2008. Anthropology is not ethnography. Proceedings of the British Academy 154:69-92
Ingold, T. 2000 The perception of the environment: essays on livelihood, dwelling and
skill. Routledge: London
Ingold, T. 2010 Footprints through the weather-world: Walking, breathing, knowing.
Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute (N.S.), S121-S139
Ingold, T. 2011 Being Alive. Routledge: London
Bibliography
203
Ingold, T., and E. Hallam. 2011. Creativity and cultural improvisation: an introduction.
In Hallam, E. and T. Ingold (Eds.) 2007. Creativity and cultural improvisation. Berg:
Oxford
Ingold, T. and T. Kurttila. 2000 Perceiving the environment in Finnish Lapland. Body
and Society 6(3-4):183-196
Irvin, R. A. and J. Stansbury. 2004. Citizen participation in decision making: Is it worth
the effort? Public Administration Review 64(1):55
Istituto geografico de Agostini, 1983. Nautical map of Lake Como (Lario), 2nd ed.
Novara.
Italian national statistical institute (Istat). 2006; 2009. [online] URL:
http://demo.istat.it/pop2009/index_e.html
Johannes, R. E., Freeman, M. M. R. and R. J. Hamilton. 2000. Ignore fishers'
knowledge and miss the boat. Fish and Fisheries. 1(3):257-271
Johnson, C., E. Penning-Rowsell and D. Parker. 2007. Natural and imposed injustices:
the challenges in implementing ‘fair’ flood risk management policy in England. The
Geographical Journal. 173(4):374–390
Jolly, L. and L. Kavanagh. 2009. Working out and working in critical interdisciplinarity.
20th Australasian Association for Engineering Education Conference University of
Adelaide, 6-9 December 2009:709-714
Killworth, D. P., and E. C. Carmack. 1979. A filling box model of river dominated
lakes. Limnology and Oceanography 24: 201-217.
Maxworthy, T. 1997. Convection into domains with open boundaries. Annual Review of
Fluid Mechanics. 29: 327-371.
Knudsen, S. 2008 Ethical know-how and traditional ecological knowledge in small
scale fisheries on the eastern Black Sea coast of Turkey. Human Ecology 36:29–41
Bibliography
204
Knuutila, T. 2005 Models as epistemic artifacts: towards a non-representationalist
account of scientific representation. PhD thesis - University of Helsinki, Department of
Philosophy
Kristiana, R. 2010. Sustainability assessment in water management: the application and
development of the index of sustainable functionality on various water resources, PhD
Thesis - University of Western Australia, Centre for Water Research
Kuper, A. 2003. The return of the native. Current Anthropology 44, 389-402.
Laborde, S., Antenucci, J. P., Copetti, D. and J. Imberger. 2010. Inflow intrusions at
multiple scales in a large temperate lake. Limnology and Oceanography 55(3):1301–
1312
La Provincia di Como. 2009-2010. [online] URL: http://www.laprovinciadicomo.it/
Latour, B. 1990. Drawing things together. In Lynch, M. and Woolgar, S. (Eds),
Representation in scientific practice, MIT Press: Cambridge, Mass.
Latour, B. 2005 [1987] La science en action. Introduction à la sociologie des sciences,
La Découverte. Sciences humaines et sociales
Latour, B. and S. Woolgar. 1986 [1979]. Laboratory Life: the construction of scientific
facts. Princeton University Press, c1986: Princeton, N.J
Lauer, M. and S. Aswani 2009 Indigenous ecological knowledge as situated practices:
Understanding fishers’ knowledge in the western Solomon Islands. American
Anthropologist 111 (3):317–329
Lave, J. 1988 Cognition in practice: mind, mathematics, and culture in everyday life.
Cambridge University Press
Lawrence, R. J. and C. Després. 2004. Introduction: Futures of transdisciplinarity
Futures 36:397–405
Lebel, L., T. Grothmann and B. Siebenhuner. 2010. The role of social learning in
adaptiveness: insights from water management. International Environmental
Agreements: Politics, Law and Economics 10:333–353
Bibliography
205
Lewicka, M. 2011. Place attachment: How far have we come in the last 40 years?
Journal of Environmental Psychology 31(3):207-230
Lynch. 2010. Sustainable natural resource management. Cambridge University Press
Mannarini, T., M. Roccato, A. Fedi and A. Rovere. 2009. Six factors fostering protest:
predicting participation in locally unwanted land use movements. Political psychology
30:985-918
Manzo, L. C. and D. D. Perkins. 2006. Finding common ground: The importance of
place attachment to community participation and planning. Journal of Planning
Literature 20:335
Massarutto, A., A. de Carli, C. Longhi and M. Scarpari. 2003. Public participation in
river basin management planning in Italy: an unconventional marriage of top-down
planning and corporative politics. Report of workpackage 4 of the HarmoniCOP
project. [online] URL: http://www.harmonicop.uni-
osnabrueck.de/_files/_down/Italy.pdf
Maxworthy, T. 1997. Convection into domains with open boundaries. Annual Review of
Fluid Mechanics. 29: 327-371.
Maxworthy, T., J. Leilich, J. E. Simpson, and E. H. Meiburg. 2002. The propagation of
a gravity current into a linearly stratified fluid. Journal of Fluid Mechanics. 453: 371-
394.
McDaniels, T. L., R. S. Gregory and D. Fields. 1999. Democratizing risk management:
Successful public involvement in local water management decisions. Risk Analysis
19(3)
McLain, R. J. and R. G.Lee. 1996. Adaptive management: Promises and pitfalls.
Environmental Management. 20(4):437-448
Medema, W., B. S. McIntosh and P. J. Jeffrey. 2008. From premise to practice: A
critical assessment of integrated water resources management and adaptive management
approaches in the water sector. Ecology and Society 13(2):29. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol13/iss2/art29/
Bibliography
206
Mercier, H. and D. Sperber 2011. Why do humans reason? Arguments for an
argumentative theory. Behavioral and brain sciences 34:57–111
Milton, K. 2005. Meanings, feelings and human ecology In Milton, K. and M. Svasek.
(Eds.) Mixed emotions – Anthropological studies of feeling. Berg: Oxford
Mitchell, M. Y., J. E. Force and M. S. Carroll. 1993. Forest places of the heart:
incorporating social places into public management. Journal of Forestry 91(4):32-37
Moisello, U. and F. Vullo. 2011. I massimi annuali di portata dell’Adda a Lecco in
diversi regimi di deflusso. Consorzio dell’Adda - Pubblicazione n. 13 [Italian]
Mol, A. 2002. The body multiple: ontology in medical practice. Duke University Press
Monti, R. 1924. La limnologia del Lario in relazione al ripopolamento delle acque ed
alla pesca. Studi fati sotto la direzione della Prof. Rina Monti. Ministero dell’economia
nazionale. tipografia coop. ‘Luigi Luzzatti’: Roma [Italian]
Monti, S. 1900. Inondazioni del lago di Como dal 1431 al 1765 e provvedimenti per
porvi riparo (Archivio di città). Como, Società storica Comense, 1900:128-172.
[Italian]
Morán, E. F. 2008. Human adaptability: an introduction to ecological anthropology –
3rd Ed. Westview Press: Boulder, CO
Moran-Ellis, J., V. Alexander, A. Cronin, M. Dickenson, J. Fielding, J. Sleney H.
Thomas. 2006. Triangulation and integration: processes, claims and implications.
Qualitative Research 6(1):45–59
Morillo, S., J. Imberger, J. P. Antenucci, and D. Copetti. 2009. Using impellers to
distribute local nutrient loadings in a stratified lake: Lake Como, Italy. J. Hydraulic
Engineering 135: 564-574.
Morillo, S., J. Imberger, J. P. Antenucci, and P. F. Woods. 2008. Influence of wind and
lake morphometry on the interaction between two rivers entering a stratified lake.
Journal of Hydraulic Engineering 134: 1579-1589.
Bibliography
207
Nader, L. (Ed.) 1996. Naked science: anthropological inquiry into boundaries, power,
and knowledge. Routledge: New York
Nunes Correia, F., M. Fordham, M. da Graca Saaiva and F. Bernardo. 1998. Flood
hazard assessment and management: interface with the public. Water Resources
Management 12:209–227:
O'Connell, J. 1993. Metrology: The creation of universality by the circulation of
particulars. Social Studies of Science. 23 (1): 129-173
OECD. 1972. Interdisciplinarity: problems of teaching and research in universities,
OECD: Paris
Okely, P. N. 2010. Interplay of lake motions and processes affecting horizontal
transport in a range of water bodies. PhD Thesis - University of Western Australia,
Centre for Water Research
Orlove, B. S. 1991 Mapping reeds and reading maps: The politics of representation in
Lake Titicaca. American Ethnologist 18(1):3-38
Orlove, B. and S. C. Caton. 2010. Water sustainability: Anthropological approaches and
prospects. Annual Review of Anthropology 39:401–15
Ostrovsky, I., Yacobi, Y. Z., Walline, P. and I. Kalikhman. 1996. Seiche-induced
mixing: Its impact on lake productivity. Limnology and Oceanography 41(2):323-332
Oxford English Dictionary [OED]. 2011. [online] URL: http://www.oed.com
Pahl-Wostl, C. 2007. The implications of complexity for integrated resources
management. Environmental Modelling & Software 22(5):561-569
Pahl-Wostl, C., J. Sendzimir, P. Jeffrey, J. Aerts, G. Berkamp and K. Cross. 2007.
Managing change toward adaptive water management through social learning. Ecology
and Society 12(2):30. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol12/iss2/art30/
Bibliography
208
Pahl-Wostl, C., J. Sendzimir and P. Jeffrey. 2009. Resources management in transition.
Ecology and Society 14(1):46. [online] URL:
http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol14/iss1/art46/
Pálsson, G. 1994 Enskilment at Sea. Man. 29 (4):901-927
Pensa, P. 1981. Noi gente del Lario. Pietro Cairoli Ed.: Como [Italian]
Pickering, A. (Ed.) 1992. Science as Practice and Culture. Chicago University Press:
Chicago
Pirovano, M. 1996. Pescatori di lago. Storia, lavoro, cultura sui laghi della Brianza e sul
Lario. Ricerche di etnografia e storia , Nr. 5: Cattaneo [Italian]
Pirovano, M. 2003. Vita da pescatori sulla costa sud-occidentale del Lario. Tesori di
Lombardia – Bellavite [Italian]
Poggi, C. and C. Cantù, 2000. Como e le piene più famose del lago. Pfifferi Ed., E.P.I:
Como [Italian]
Polanyi, M. 1969 Knowing and Being. University of Chicago Press: Chicago
Poletta, F. and J. M. Jasper. 2001. Collective identity and social movements. Annual
Review of Sociology 27:283-305
Raymond, C. M., I. Fazey, M. S. Reed, L. C. Stringer, G. M. Robinson and A. C. Evely.
2010. Integrating local and scientific knowledge for environmental management.
Journal of Environmental Management 91:1766-1777
Robertson, H. A. and T. K. McGee. 2003. Applying local knowledge: the contribution
of oral history to wetland rehabilitation at Kanyapella Basin, Australia. Journal of
Environmental Management 69:275-287.
Robinson J. 2008. Being undisciplined: Transgressions and intersections in academia
and beyond. Futures 40:70–86
Bibliography
209
Roth, W-M. Bowen, G. M., and D. Masciotra. 2002. From thing to sign and ''natural
object'': Toward a genetic phenomenology of graph interpretation. Science Technology
Human Values 27:327
Rueda, F. J., and S. G. Schladow. 2003. Dynamics of a large polymictic lake. II:
Numerical simulations. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering. 129: 92-101.
Russell, B. 1948. Human knowledge – its scope and limits. Simon and Schuster: New
York
Rydin, Y. and M. Pennington. 2000. Public participation and local environmental
planning: the collective action problem and the potential of social capital. Local
environment 5(2):153-169
Scannell, L. and R. Gifford. 2010. Defining place attachment: A tripartite organizing
framework. Journal of Environmental Psychology 30(1):1-10
Selman, P., C. Carter, A. Lawrence and C. Morgan 2010. Re-connecting with a
neglected river through imaginative engagement. Ecology and Society 15(3):18. [online]
URL: http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol15/iss3/art18/
Serruya, S. 1974. The mixing patterns of the Jordan River in Lake Kinneret. Limnology
and Oceanography 19: 175-181.
Shelley, P. B. 1882 Select letters of Percy Bysshe Shelley. Edited with an introduction
by Richard Garnett – Kegan Paul, Trench & Co: London
Shimizu, K. 2009. Application of modal analysis to strongly stratified lakes. PhD Thesis
- University of Western Australia, Centre for Water Research
Shimizu T, Takagi T, Korte, H., Hiraishi T, Yamamoto K. 2005. Application of NaLA,
a fishing net configuration and loading analysis system, to drift gill nets. Fisheries
Research 76:67–80
Simpson, J. E. 1987. Gravity currents in the environment and the laboratory. Wiley.
Bibliography
210
Stedman, R. C. 2002. Toward a social psychology of place: predicting behavior from
place-based cognitions, attitude, and identity. Environment and Behavior
34:561
Stendhal. 1839. La Chartreuse de Parme, tome premier. Société belge de librairie -
Hauman et Cie: Bruxelles [French]
Stevens, C. L., and G. Lawrence. 1997. Estimation of wind forced internal seiche
amplitudes in lakes and reservoirs, with data from British Columbia, Canada. Aquatic
Science 59: 115-134.
Strang, V. 2004. The meaning of water Berg: Oxford
Strang, V. 2009. Integrating the social and natural sciences in environmental research: a
discussion paper. Environment Development and Sustainability 11:1–18
Strang, V. 2009. Gardening the world - Agency, identity, and the ownership of water.
Berghahn Books: New York
Strathern, M. 2007. Experiments in interdisciplinarity. Social Anthropology 13(1):75-90
Swanson, F. J., C. Goodrich and K. D. Moore. 2008. Bridging boundaries: scientists,
creative writers, and the long view of the forest. Frontiers in Ecology and the
Environment 6(9):499–504
Thompson, R. and J. Imberger. 1980. Response of a numerical model of a stratified lake
to wind stress. Proc. 2nd Int. Symp. on Stratified Flow, Trondheim, Norway, 562-570.
Tompkins, E. L. and W. N. Adger. 2004. Does adaptive management of natural
resources enhance resilience to climate change? Ecology and Society 9(2):10 [online]
URL: http://www.ecologyandsociety.org/vol9/iss2/art10
Toussaint, S. 2005. Building an epistemological bridge: Coeval integrated practice in
Studies of human/environmental relationships, Sustainable communities, sustainable
environments: potential dialogues between anthropologists, scientists and managers 21:
19-15: Melbourne
Bibliography
211
Toussaint, S. 2008 Kimberley friction: Complex attachments to water places in northern
Australia. Oceania 78:46-61
Tsing, A. 2005. Friction: An ethnography of global connection. Princeton University
Press: Princeton
Tuan, Y-F. 1974. Topophilia: a study of environmental perception, attitudes, and
values. Prentice-Hall, Englewood Cliffs, NJ
Tuan, Y-F. 1977. Space and place: the perspective of experience. University of
Minnesota Press: Minneapolis
Tuan, Y-F. 1995 [1993]. Passing strange and wonderful: aesthetics, nature, and culture
Kodansha International: New York
Turati, P. and A. Gentile. 1858. Como ed il suo lago – Illustrazione storica, geografica
e poetica del Lario e circostanti paesi. Tipografia Giorgetti: Como [Italian]
Turnbull, D. 2003 [2000] Masons, tricksters and cartographers: comparative studies in
the sociology of scientific and indigenous knowledge. Routledge: London
Turnbull, D. 2005. Multiplicity, criticism and knowing what to do next: way-finding in
a transmodern world. Response to Meera Nanda’s Prophets facing backwards. Social
Epistemology 19(1):19–32
Twigger-Ross, C. L. and D. Uzzell. 1996. Place and identity processes. Journal of
Environmental Psychology, 16:205–220
UN-Habitat. 2010. State of the World cities 2010/2011. [online] URL:
http://www.unhabitat.org/documents/SOWC10/R7.pdf
United Nations. 1992. Rio declaration on environment and development. United
Nations Conference on Environment and Development, Rio de Janeiro 3-14 June 1992
Varela, F. J., E. T. Thompson and E. Rosch. 1991 The Embodied Mind. MIT Press:
Cambridge, MA
Bibliography
212
Vezzoli L., and D. Facchinetti. 2006. Limnogeology of Lake Como, in Centro Volta
Como. Rehabilitation of the water quality in Lake Como. Gruppo di Lavoro Lago di
Como. PLINIUS project. [Italian]
Vis et al. 2003. Resilience strategies for flood risk management in the Netherlands.
International. Journal of River Basin Management 1(1):33–40
Wainwright, J. and M. Mulligan (Eds.) 2004 Environmental modelling: finding
simplicity in complexity. Wiley & Sons: England
Webler, T. and S. P. Tuler. 2010. Getting the engineering right is not always enough:
Researching the human dimensions of the new energy technologies. Energy Policy
38(6) 2690-2691
West, P. 2005. Translation, value, and space: Theorising an ethnographic and engaged
environmental anthropology. American Anthropologist 107(4):632–642
Williams, D-M. 2000 Representations of nature on the Mongolian steppe: An
investigation of scientific knowledge construction. American Anthropologist
102(3):503-519
Willmott, C. J. 1982. Some comments on the evaluation of model performance. Bulletin
of the American Meteorological Society 63:1309-1313
Bibliography
213
Appendix A (Chapter 4)
Coding frame used to analyze textual items (letters and online comments)
Category Theme Emotion Anger Sadness Surprise Shame Relationship to place Physical landscape, aesthetics Cultural/personal meaning of the lake and/or lakeshore Cultural/personal meaning of the city Social ‘Us’, Comaschi [Como residents] Collective support and efficacy of the protest Social continuity: reference to past and/or future
generations Accountability Naming responsible people, calling for sanctions Concerns with implementation process (political)
Legitimacy Economic implications Transparency of political process Critical awareness of lack of citizen’s interest at the outset
Action Stimulation Sharing of information Organization of events
Appendices
214
Appendix B (Chapter 4)
Quotes extracted from textual data and translated into English
1. In the presentation it was all-beautiful, the virtual pictures are still there, how beautiful! A shame they are only virtual (…). Please, give us the floods back and resign right away: I am one who voted for you. (Letter published on 25/09/09)
2. But, how could they do such a thing to the living heart of our beloved city (…)? I almost have tears in my eyes. (Letter published on 5/10/09)
3. My beautiful lake, to which I am very much attached, and to which I had even
dedicated years ago a poem, in dialect to better express my deep feelings for it, cannot disappear this way (Letter published on 27/09/09)
4. No one can steal the lake... Leave us at least this little bit of nature that remains to be seen and admired! (Letter published on 25/09/09)
5. When I was a little boy on Saturday afternoons, my parents used to take me to the lakeshore to stroll and admire our lake. Then I grew up and I used to go with my friends, with my girlfriend. Now I am married, I went for so many walks there with my wife and each time we would stop on a bench to admire the lake! Now I have a child and I would like to be able to take her there, too, to admire the lake. Don’t cancel the lake from us, please don’t do it. It is beautiful to see it in the morning when I go to work and to greet it at night before going back home. It is part of my life. (Letter published on 30/09/09)
6. I have lived on milk and lake since my childhood that is since 75 years. I remember my dad who, every night after dinner, regardless of the weather and the season used to go out to the square to see his lake. When he came back, we used to ask him, for a joke: ‘Dad, is the lake still there?’ And his answer was: ‘It is there and it is always more beautiful’. I think that now he would be turning in his grave. (Letter published on 1 Oct. 2009)
7. I would like for tomorrow’s children to be able to stroll on the lakeshore with grandparents or parents, and stop enchanted throwing bread to the ducks and admiring the arrival of the swans, like we all did… (…) I would like for the lake
Appendices
215
to remain everything it has been for us, grown-up Comaschi. (…) This wall prevents all of this! (Comment posted on 24/09/09, accessed on 14 Apr 2010)
8. How was it possible to design and build this horror? But those who have the power to govern are Italians? Or extraterrestrial aliens? (Letter published on 01/10/09)
9. If the city lost the view of the Lario, it would lose itself (Letter published on 25 Sept. 2009)
10. Como cannot be apart from the lake. Como is ‘the lake’. (Letter published on 05/10/09)
11. It’s as if in Milan they decided to cover all the duomo and hide it from people’s view… But are we joking? It’s like taking off the soul of the city! (Letter published on 26/09/09)
12. The offense to the environment is the wall in construction. The lake, the lakeshore and the old town are a continuous whole: they are three inseparable realities in osmosis. The fracture caused by the wall breaks an equilibrium embedded in the culture of Como that lives serenely its panorama. (Architect, letter published on 30/09/09)
13. In Como fortunately, it is not so frequent to end up with the high waters, it is not necessary to ‘secure’ the city permanently, Como already has its walls, of another epoch, function and charm. (letter published on 02/10/09, [reference to the historical walls surrounding the old part of town])
14. Dismantlement of this wall of shame, which is useless! Almost surely we won’t get any more floods, considering the climatic situation and the [lake levels managing body] (Letter published on 29/09/09)
15. Considering also that the flood events, as years go by, become less and less intense, maybe also because the gates in Lecco/Olginate are being better managed, I wonder in the end why this useless ‘wall’ has been built. (Letter published on 29/09/09)
16. How often has the lake been flooding? Every 3/4/5 years? And how much did it cost considering that everything is always covered by the insurances? (Letter published on 26/09/09)
17. Between walls, barriers and cement casts a go-go, now our lake has been caged and closed like a vulgar hydroelectric reservoir. (…) a project that has closed
Appendices
216
the lake but also the doors to all sensitivity and culture. (Letter published on 27/09/09)
18. The beauty and the romanticism of the lake on the square well surpassed the (few and well compensated) [flood] damage to the shore owners: besides, the flooding lake only took what was already its: Piazza Cavour used to be the port of Como, without walls, without roads, without benches, without barriers, without brigands, but with a splendid city at its back. (Letter published on 26/09/09)
19. I prefer a prospective week of lake flooding than a permanent cancellation of the landscape. (Comment posted on 24/09/09, accessed on 14/4/10)
20. There may be nothing left to do for us but cry by the wall, by our own wailing wall, trying to remember the glories of the past. (Letter published on 26/09/09)
21. But… I was born with the view to the lake and I will have to die in front of a wall… but you are crazy?! (Letter published on 27/09/09)
22. My beautiful lake, to which I am very much attached, and to which I had even
dedicated years ago a poem, in dialect to better express my deep feelings for it, cannot disappear this way (Letter published on 27/09/09)
23. (…) A disaster from the cultural and emotional perspectives for who really cares for the lake. I feel more pain than indignation. (Letter published on 29/09/09)
24. Give us back the fabulous lakeshore of Como, which in difficult times like these, only with a little glimpse while driving past, brightens our mood! (Letter published on 26/09/09)
25. I am German and I have known the lake of Como for 20 years (...) To me and all of them [family and friends, from Italy and elsewhere] the lake has always had this strange effect: as soon as I arrive here I relax, I feel great, I breathe deeply and I forget the daily stress. This is due to a landscape of extraordinary beauty (Letter published on 4/10/09)